US20020044331A1 - Busbars for electrically powered cells - Google Patents

Busbars for electrically powered cells Download PDF

Info

Publication number
US20020044331A1
US20020044331A1 US09/956,341 US95634101A US2002044331A1 US 20020044331 A1 US20020044331 A1 US 20020044331A1 US 95634101 A US95634101 A US 95634101A US 2002044331 A1 US2002044331 A1 US 2002044331A1
Authority
US
United States
Prior art keywords
substrate
edge
busbar
conductive
perimeter
Prior art date
Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
Granted
Application number
US09/956,341
Other versions
US6449082B1 (en
Inventor
Anoop Agrawal
Juan Tonazzi
Robert LeCompte
John Cronin
Steve Kennedy
Kevin McCarthy
Matthew Denesuk
Gimtong Teowee
Current Assignee (The listed assignees may be inaccurate. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of the list.)
Individual
Original Assignee
Individual
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by Individual filed Critical Individual
Priority to US09/956,341 priority Critical patent/US6449082B1/en
Publication of US20020044331A1 publication Critical patent/US20020044331A1/en
Application granted granted Critical
Publication of US6449082B1 publication Critical patent/US6449082B1/en
Anticipated expiration legal-status Critical
Expired - Fee Related legal-status Critical Current

Links

Images

Classifications

    • HELECTRICITY
    • H01ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
    • H01MPROCESSES OR MEANS, e.g. BATTERIES, FOR THE DIRECT CONVERSION OF CHEMICAL ENERGY INTO ELECTRICAL ENERGY
    • H01M14/00Electrochemical current or voltage generators not provided for in groups H01M6/00 - H01M12/00; Manufacture thereof
    • H01M14/005Photoelectrochemical storage cells
    • GPHYSICS
    • G02OPTICS
    • G02FOPTICAL DEVICES OR ARRANGEMENTS FOR THE CONTROL OF LIGHT BY MODIFICATION OF THE OPTICAL PROPERTIES OF THE MEDIA OF THE ELEMENTS INVOLVED THEREIN; NON-LINEAR OPTICS; FREQUENCY-CHANGING OF LIGHT; OPTICAL LOGIC ELEMENTS; OPTICAL ANALOGUE/DIGITAL CONVERTERS
    • G02F1/00Devices or arrangements for the control of the intensity, colour, phase, polarisation or direction of light arriving from an independent light source, e.g. switching, gating or modulating; Non-linear optics
    • G02F1/01Devices or arrangements for the control of the intensity, colour, phase, polarisation or direction of light arriving from an independent light source, e.g. switching, gating or modulating; Non-linear optics for the control of the intensity, phase, polarisation or colour 
    • G02F1/15Devices or arrangements for the control of the intensity, colour, phase, polarisation or direction of light arriving from an independent light source, e.g. switching, gating or modulating; Non-linear optics for the control of the intensity, phase, polarisation or colour  based on an electrochromic effect
    • G02F1/153Constructional details
    • G02F1/155Electrodes
    • HELECTRICITY
    • H01ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
    • H01RELECTRICALLY-CONDUCTIVE CONNECTIONS; STRUCTURAL ASSOCIATIONS OF A PLURALITY OF MUTUALLY-INSULATED ELECTRICAL CONNECTING ELEMENTS; COUPLING DEVICES; CURRENT COLLECTORS
    • H01R12/00Structural associations of a plurality of mutually-insulated electrical connecting elements, specially adapted for printed circuits, e.g. printed circuit boards [PCB], flat or ribbon cables, or like generally planar structures, e.g. terminal strips, terminal blocks; Coupling devices specially adapted for printed circuits, flat or ribbon cables, or like generally planar structures; Terminals specially adapted for contact with, or insertion into, printed circuits, flat or ribbon cables, or like generally planar structures
    • H01R12/70Coupling devices
    • H01R12/7076Coupling devices for connection between PCB and component, e.g. display
    • HELECTRICITY
    • H05ELECTRIC TECHNIQUES NOT OTHERWISE PROVIDED FOR
    • H05KPRINTED CIRCUITS; CASINGS OR CONSTRUCTIONAL DETAILS OF ELECTRIC APPARATUS; MANUFACTURE OF ASSEMBLAGES OF ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS
    • H05K3/00Apparatus or processes for manufacturing printed circuits
    • H05K3/40Forming printed elements for providing electric connections to or between printed circuits
    • H05K3/403Edge contacts; Windows or holes in the substrate having plural connections on the walls thereof

Definitions

  • This invention relates to busbars utilized in electrically powered cells.
  • this invention relates to edge and internal busbars utilized in electrochromic devices.
  • This invention also relates to edge and internal busbars that can be utilized in other electrically powered cells such as electroluminescent and photochromic devices, thin-film batteries, and other cells that use geometries similar to the electrochromic devices described herein.
  • this invention relates to control circuits and methods to control the coloration of such electrochromic devices through an intermittent application of power.
  • Electrochromic (EC) devices are devices in which a change in an electrical signal applied to the EC device results in a change in an optical property of the EC device.
  • the optical property is optical transmittance, although other properties can be affected such as, for example, optical spectral distribution or polarization.
  • Electrochromic devices can be used for many applications, such as rear view automotive mirrors, windows, sunroofs, shades or visors for automotive and mass transportation applications, architectural windows, skylights, displays, light filters and screens for light pipes, displays, and other electro-optical devices.
  • Chromogenic devices As used herein, is employed as commonly known in the art. Examples of these chromogenic devices include electrochromic devices, photochromic devices, liquid crystal devices, user-controllable-photochromic devices, polymer-dispersed-liquid-crystal devices, and suspended particle devices.
  • Electrochromic panels are also discussed by Sapers, S. P., et al. in “Monolithic Solid-State Electrochromic Coatings for Window Applications”, Proceedings of the Society of Vacuum Coaters Conference (1996), incorporated herein by reference, with regard to devices of the type shown in FIG. 1E. Devices comparable to that shown in FIG. 1E, and having photovoltaic layers for self-biasing operation are also described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,377,037.
  • liquid crystal devices such as those described by N. Basturk and J. Grupp in “Liquid Crystal Guest-Host Devices and Their Use as Light Shutters”, Large Area Chromogenics: Materials & Devices for Transmittance Control, Optical Engineering Press, Bellingham, Wash. (1989), incorporated herein by reference.
  • UPC User-controllable-photochromic devices
  • PDLC Polymer-dispersed-liquid-crystal
  • FIGS. 1A through 1E depict typical examples of known electrochromic devices, while FIG. 1F shows another known type of chromogenic device.
  • FIG. 1A depicts a layered EC device which includes a substrate 101 , transparent conductor 103 , electrochromic (redox) medium 105 , transparent conductor 103 ′ and substrate 101 ′.
  • redox electrochromic
  • FIG. 1B illustrates a layered EC device which includes a substrate 101 , transparent conductor 103 , EC layer 107 , electrolyte (redox medium) 109 , transparent conductor 103 ′ and substrate 101 ′.
  • FIG. 1C shows another layered EC device having a substrate 101 , transparent conductor 103 , EC layer 107 , ion-selective transport layer 111 , electrolyte (redox medium) 109 , transparent conductor 103 ′ and substrate
  • FIG. 1D Still another such EC device is shown in FIG. 1D.
  • This device includes a substrate 101 , transparent conductor 103 , EC layer 107 , electrolyte 113 , counterelectrode 115 , transparent conductor 103 ′ and substrate 101 ′.
  • FIG. 1E shows an EC device having a substrate 101 , transparent conductor 103 , EC layer 107 , electrolyte (ion-conductive layer) 117 , counterelectrode 115 and transparent conductor 103 ′.
  • FIG. 1F A typical liquid crystal or PDLC device is shown in FIG. 1F.
  • This device includes a substrate 201 , transparent conductor 203 , liquid crystal or PDLC medium 205 , transparent conductor 203 ′ and substrate 201 ′.
  • an electrochromic (EC) device In general, it is important to distribute the voltage to an electrochromic (EC) device uniformly in order to (i) maintain the uniformity of the coloration and bleaching of the EC device during changes between such states of coloration and bleaching, (ii) to improve uniformity in such colored and bleached states, and finally (iii) to enhance the kinetics of coloration and bleaching.
  • EC electrochromic
  • An applied voltage is commonly distributed at the periphery of EC devices through the use of an edge busbar which distributes an applied voltage to a surface conductor electrode.
  • the applied voltage causes a response in a particular responsive property of an EC device. Consequently, spatial or temporal differences in the applied voltage will cause spatial or temporal differences in the responsive property.
  • Ohmic losses along an edge busbar can therefore critically affect the even distribution of voltage, leading to undesirable non-uniformities in the coloration and bleaching of an EC device.
  • EC devices often employ thin film transparent conductors such as indium tin oxide (ITO) and doped tin oxides (DTO) for the surface conductor electrode.
  • ITO indium tin oxide
  • DTO doped tin oxides
  • Such thin film transparent conductors are also used in a wide range of applications in other areas such as displays, solar cells, and liquid crystal devices. If the magnitude of the electrical currents in such devices is large, there can be a considerable electrical potential drop across the transparent conductor. Similar to the effect of voltage variations along an edge busbar, variations of voltage in thin film transparent conductors can also lead to spatial inhomogeneities in the device behavior as well as to slower overall device kinetics. Such effects become increasingly noticeable and problematic with increasing device area.
  • electrochromic devices are current consuming devices. Accordingly, it is advantageous for the transparent conductors, i.e., the surface electrodes, to be very conductive. For applications such as large area EC panels, where current consumption is large, it is particularly important that the transparent conductors possess high effective conductivities.
  • EC devices can be fabricated on one substrate as described in U.S. Pat. No. 4,712,879; J. Gordon H. Matthew et. al., Proc. of 3 d Svmposium on Electrochromic Materials, The Electrochemical Society, Proc. Volume 96-24, Pennington, N.J., 1997, p. 311; and Badding, M. E., et al., Proc. of 3 d Symposium on Electrochromic Materials, The Electrochemical Society, Proc. Volume 96-24, Pennington, N.J., 1997, p. 369, each incorporated herein by reference.
  • Electrochromic devices can also be made using two substrates as described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 4,761,061, 4,768,865, 4,902,108, 5,142,407, 5,231,531, 5,472,643, and U.S. patent application Ser. No. 09/155,601, filed Aug. 9, 1997, each incorporated herein by reference.
  • Spring clips 2221 and 2222 , or 3331 and 3332 , of a conductive material such as a copper sheet or a beryllium copper coated with tin are clipped to the two staggered edges of substrates 2223 and 2224 , or 3333 and 3334 , in order to provide an electrical connection to substrates 2223 and 2224 , or 3333 and 3334 .
  • the two substrates must be offset, or staggered, from each other in order to expose surfaces 2225 and 3335 for the attachment of clips 2221 and 2222 , or 3331 and 3332 .
  • the surfaces 2225 and 3335 are minimized in order to maximize the optical throughput area of the device—that is, to maximize the overlapping area of the two substrates. Accordingly, the prior art provides electrical connections at less than one half of the perimeter of each substrate.
  • the resistance of a typical wire clip used in commercial automotive mirrors that are about 12 inches (30 cm) in length is about 0.29.
  • the conductivity associated with the clip depends on the intrinsic conductivity of the material, the geometric parameters of the clip (such as thickness, width and the length of the strip), and on the relevant contact resistance.
  • Table 1 shows the current consumption of the devices with two different active areas: (1) 6 inches by 6 inches (15 cm ⁇ 15 cm) and (2) 12 inches by 12 inches (30 cm ⁇ 30 cm). TABLE 1 Colored (steady Device Initial current state) current type/Size consumption consumption Auto Mirror, 0.7 A 0.2 A 6 inch (15 cm) Thin film 0.5 A 0.2 mA window, 6 inch (15 cm) Auto Mirror, 2.8 A 0.8 A 12 inch (30 cm) Thin film 1.9 A 0.9 mA window, 12 inch (30 cm)
  • Table 2 shows the resistance characteristics of several materials and the resistance associated with a tape with a dimension of 1 meter in length, 2 mm in width and 0.1 mm in thickness. Table 2 also shows the resistance drop in these tapes when they carry 0.1, 1 and 10 A of current. TABLE 2 Data for one m long tape with a width of 2 mm and a thickness of Resist- 0.1 mm ivity Resis- Voltage Voltage at 25° C.
  • the typical gap between the substrates is in the range of from 10 to 1000 micrometers.
  • busbars be applied to as much of the device perimeter as possible.
  • One prior art approach for a rectangular device as shown in FIG. 4 is to offset substrates 3301 and 3302 simultaneously around two edges of a corner to provide two exposed L-shaped surfaces 3304 . Then, busbars 3303 are attached in a conventional way.
  • busbars 5503 are applied on opposite edges of exposed surface pairs 5504 by employing the geometry as shown in FIG. 5 where the rectangular substrates 5501 and 5502 are pivoted from each other so that the long dimension of each rectangular substrate is parallel to the short dimension of the other rectangular substrate.
  • substantially perimeter means more than half of the perimeter of a substrate which is covered by a continuous busbar. For larger devices such as those bigger than about 6 inches (15 cm) in width and length, it is especially desirable to put the busbars all around the device, in a manner which covers a substantial perimeter of each substrate in order to provide the applied signal to the entire chromogenic panel evenly.
  • ITO indium tin oxide
  • DTO doped tin oxide
  • Values for the sheet resistance of commercially available transparent conductors such as ITO and DTO are typically greater than about 5 ⁇ /sq (the units are also commonly written as ⁇ / ⁇ ) to about 15 ⁇ /sq.
  • Lower sheet resistances may be obtained by increasing the thickness of the transparent conductor, but this adversely affects the optical properties (e.g., increased haziness and/or diminished transmissivity) and also adds appreciably to the cost. It is desirable to form substrates which possess appreciably lower effective sheet resistance (can be less than 1 ⁇ /sq) at a cost that is attractive for applications such as those described above.
  • Preferred line widths were 20 micrometers with line spacings of 500 micrometers and line heights of 0.2 to 3 micrometers.
  • the grid is then coated by a metal oxide (e.g., 1000 ⁇ of ITO).
  • the invention relates to displays in which high resolution processing equipment must be used for depositing the grid pattern.
  • the cost is high, particularly if large substrates such as 6 inch ⁇ 6 inch (15 cm ⁇ 15 cm) or bigger are required because maintaining high precision in such a fine grid pattern over increasing areas is costly.
  • these substrates must be over-coated with ITO, they are unable to use more cost effective, mass produced transparent conductors, such as mass produced ITO or inexpensive DTO deposited onto glass sheets in a float line.
  • U.S. Pat. No. 4,768,865 incorporated herein by reference, describes the use of a free-standing metallic grid as one of the transparent conductors.
  • the metal grid participates directly in the electrochemical reaction in the EC cell.
  • U.S. Pat. No. 5,724,176 describes the use of a counterelectrode for a smart window that contains a transparent substrate and a linear electrically conductive material formed on a surface of the transparent substrate.
  • a layer of an electrochromic material is formed on the window's surface, and a layer of an electrolyte is arranged between the counterelectrode and the electrochromic electrode and in contact with the layer of the electrochromic material.
  • Various patterns are described for the placement of the linear electrically conductive material.
  • U.S. Pat. No. 5,066,111 incorporated herein by reference, describes laminated EC devices.
  • a metal grid on a glass substrate is employed as one electrode and a longitudinal set of busbars, preferably composed of a metal foil such as copper, or an electroconductive ceramic frit deposited on glass or on the surface of an electro-conductive film, is employed as the other electrode.
  • the electrochromic film is deposited over the second electrode.
  • the metal foil or frit conductors of the U.S. Pat. No. 5,066,111 invention are always in direct contact with either the electrochromic coating or the electrolyte. However, such direct contact can decrease the device lifetime because of reaction between the coating and the electrolyte or electrochromic coating.
  • TCC transparent conductive coating
  • the TCC is usually deposited in a thickness of less than 0.3 micrometers.
  • tapes or underlying frits, etc. are typically in thicknesses of 10 to 1000 times the thickness of TCC.
  • vacuum methods that are typically used to coat TCC have difficulty getting a conforming coating that adequately covers the edges.
  • the reference does not address the relationship of the busbar thickness and width to the device size.
  • POLYCHROMICTM solid films are described in European Patent Publication No. EP 0 612 826 A1, incorporated herein by reference.
  • the reference describes how polychromic solid films may be used in electrochromic devices, particularly glazings and mirrors, whose functional surface is substantially planar or flat or that are curved with a convex curvature, a compound curvature, a multi-radius curvature, a spherical curvature, an aspheric curvature, or combinations of such curvature.
  • a demarcation means such as a silk-screened or otherwise applied line of black epoxy, may be used to separate the more curved, outboard blind-spot region from the less curved, inboard region of such electrochromic mirrors.
  • the demarcation means may also include an etching of a deletion line or an otherwise established break in the electrical continuity of the transparent conductors used in such mirrors so that either one or both regions may be individually or mutually addressed.
  • this deletion line may itself be colored black.
  • the outboard, more curved region may operate independently from the inboard, less curved region to provide an electrochromic mirror that operates in a segmented arrangement.
  • EP 0 612 826 A1 upon the introduction of an applied potential, either of such regions may color to a dimmed intermediate reflectance level, independent of the other region, or, if desired, both regions may operate together in tandem.
  • An insulating demarcation means such as demarcation lines, dots and/or spots, may be placed within electrochromic devices, such as mirrors, glazings, optically attenuating contrast filters and the like, to assist in setting out the interpane distance of the device and to enhance overall performance, in particular the uniformity of coloration across large area devices.
  • Such insulating demarcation means constructed from, for example, epoxy coupled with glass space beads, plastic tape or die cut from plastic tape, may be placed onto the conductive surface of one or more substrates by silk-screening or other suitable technique prior to assembling the device.
  • the insulating demarcation means may be geometrically positioned across the panel, such as in a series of parallel, uniformly spaced-apart lines, and may be clear, opaque, tinted, or colorless, and appropriate combinations thereof, so as to appeal to the automotive stylist.
  • a demarcation means may be used that is conductive as well, provided that it is of a smaller thickness than the interpane distance and/or a layer of an insulating material, such as a non-conductive epoxy, urethane or acrylic, is applied thereover so as to prevent conductive surfaces from contacting one another and thus short-circuiting the electrochromic assembly.
  • conductive demarcation means include conductive frits, such as silver frits like the #7713 silver conductive frit available commercially from E.I. du Pont de Nemours and Co., Wilmington, Del., conductive paint or ink and/or metal films.
  • conductive demarcation means such as a line of the #7713 silver conductive frit, having a width of about 0.09375′′ (0.238 cm) and a thickness of about 50 ⁇ m, placed on the conductive surface of one of the substrates of the electrochromic device may provide the added benefit of enhancing electrochromic performance by reducing busbar-to-busbar overall resistance and thus enhancing uniformity of coloration, as well as rapidity of response, particularly over large area devices.
  • the non-conductive layers are applied in a way which does not prevent the underlying frit lines from making contact with the electrolyte or electrochromic layers. Thus, this frit may potentially react, especially when coloring and bleaching potentials are applied.
  • electrochromic (EC) devices are used to reversibly vary the light transmission or reflection by application of an electrical voltage.
  • Applications of electrochromic devices include windows for architectural use (windows, interior partitions, skylights, light pipes), windows in transportation (automobiles, trucks, planes, trains, boats, etc.), eye-wear, and displays (including large area signage).
  • Electrochromic windows in buildings can provide higher energy efficiency as compared to static transmission windows, while increasing the user comfort by controlling illumination and reducing glare.
  • the same benefits can accrue for transportation uses where the user comfort is enhanced by reducing solar heat and glare during the day, while reducing the cooling load on the air-conditioner.
  • the EC device can be required to be kept in a certain desired state of transmission for long periods of time. For example, a window may be kept in a darkened or bleached state for many hours of the day and may even be kept in this state for many days.
  • Electrochromic devices which will benefit from this invention are well known in the art. For example, these are described in U.S. patent application Nos. 09/155,601 and 08/699,940, filed Apr. 9, 1997 and Aug. 20, 1996, respectively.
  • the EC devices can be kept colored for a finite period of time when the coloring potential is removed, i.e., the color of the device will change towards its natural state over a period of time. This change could occur over a wide range of time intervals, from fast over several seconds or minutes, to as slow as extending up to many days, depending on the device.
  • a device where this change is fast is said to have short “memory” and one where the change is slow is said to possess long “memory”.
  • U.S. patent application No. 09/155,601 discloses devices with long memories and compares them with devices that have short memories.
  • U.S. Pat. No. 4,298,970 (to Saegusa), incorporated herein by reference, describes a technique for utilizing an intermittent technique to drive EC displays with memory.
  • the patent only describes bimodal displays which have only two states, i.e., colored and bleached states and does not discuss devices which need continuously variable light transmission across a continuum of transmissive states.
  • U.S. Pat. No. 5,365,365 incorporated herein by reference, describes an electrochromic system for controlling the color state by determining the charge needed to obtain a set color from the discharge potential of the system and the coloration set-point.
  • An integrator measures the charge passing through the system and compares it to the charge to be transferred, which is measured by a differential amplifier which compares a discharge potential measured by a capacitor with a selected color set-point.
  • U.S. Pat. No. 5,231,531 incorporated herein by reference, describes an electrochromic system in which a voltage generator is connected to electrically conductive films by an electrical control circuit.
  • the voltage generator receives a set-point from a control unit and generates a potential differences as a function of the temperature of the electrolyte.
  • This invention is related to edge and internal busbars that lower the overall effective resistance of electrical devices, particularly EC devices, thereby enabling large devices to maintain desirable electrical properties.
  • the present invention describes the benefits of applying the busbars of the present invention to a substantial perimeter of an EC device, as well as the materials and processes to accomplish this.
  • the contact points with the conductive coatings constituting the EC devices may be less than half of the perimeter, but the busbar of the present invention runs continuously for more than half of the device perimeter.
  • the term “busbar” refers to a conducting medium that provides a substantially uniform voltage to all those points on the device perimeter that are connected to the busbar.
  • the busbar should be capable of carrying substantial current with a voltage drop of preferably less than ⁇ fraction (1/10) ⁇ th of the applied voltage, or a voltage drop less than that which causes a perceptible change in the kinetics of the device (rate of coloration and bleach) or in the depth of coloration.
  • the voltage drop should be less than that voltage drop which would cause a perceptible change in the kinetics or coloration properties of the device. Thus, for some particular devices, higher voltage drops can be accommodated so long as such perceptible changes do not occur. Generally, however, such voltage drops are less than ⁇ fraction (1/10) ⁇ th of the applied voltage.
  • the conductance of the edge busbar conductor is dependent on the cross-section, length and the intrinsic conductivity of the busbar material. Since the gap between the two substrates for a EC cell is limited, the thickness of the busbar conductors must be within the limitations imposed by the cell's size. To maximize the EC device viewing area, the width of the conductor in the prior art is limited as shown in FIGS. 4 and 5, where the width is limited to the exposed areas 3304 and 5504 . Typically, this width is less than 25 mm, preferably less than 10 mm, in order to maximize effective cell area. At times, this width can be on the order of less than 2 mm. Further, for a device made by substrates that are exactly stacked on one another and separated by a gap of 100 micrometers, the thickness of the conductor on each substrate located between the two substrates is typically limited to less than 50 micrometers.
  • the present invention teaches the use of materials and processes to deposit busbars on a substantial portion of the device perimeter while overcoming the geometric constraints described above.
  • a copper conductor which is 35 micrometers thick and 3 mm wide exhibits a resistance drop of 0.16 ⁇ per meter. Accordingly, for a device that is one meter square, a continuous conductor around the device periphery will exhibit a drop of 0.32 ⁇ from one diagonal edge to the other. For a device that will carry a current as low as even one ampere, the drop of 0.32 V at an applied potential of about 1.5 V is significant. This can result in non-uniform coloration, slow kinetics, etc. In such devices, it is preferable to maintain the potential drop below ⁇ fraction (1/10) ⁇ th of the applied voltage or below any voltage that will cause a perceptible change in the color uniformity of the device or a decrease in the kinetics.
  • the potential drop in the busbar is kept within the limits described above during both the switching period and also when the steady state is reached. If other materials from Table 2 are used instead of copper, except for silver, the resistance drop will be even higher for the same busbar dimensions. Thus the geometry of the busbar (such as thickness and width) of the tape will have to be increased for best performance.
  • An object of the present invention is to overcome the prior art constraints on edge busbar effective resistance arising from the geometrical limitations of busbar length, width, and thickness.
  • the present invention uses specific geometry, materials and processes to form the edge busbars.
  • This invention overcomes these geometrical limitations by forming a conductive path from the electrode on a front side of a substrate to the edges of the substrate and then extending this conductive path on to the back of the substrate.
  • highly conductive paths such as reinforcing conductors may be employed to lower the busbar resistance.
  • the conductive path from the front of the substrates to the back could be the continuation of the same material which is used for the transparent conductor, such as indium tin oxide, or can be fabricated from a different material, so long as dimension and conductivity requirements are met.
  • the conductivity must be effective to prevent a potential drop of 10% or a potential drop that would detrimentally affect the performance of the EC panel, while the dimensions must be effective to allow the substrates to maintain a close proximity to each other.
  • the present invention provides an edge busbar for an electrical device, wherein the edge busbar comprises at least one electrically conductive connector portion effective to form an electrically conductive path from a surface of the electrical device, wrapping around a portion of an edge, to an opposite surface of the electrical device, and an electrically conductive perimeter portion in electrical contact with the connector portion, wherein the perimeter portion is peripherally on a substantial perimeter of the electrical device.
  • the connector portion of the edge busbar of the present invention can be continuous peripherally on a substantial perimeter of the electrical device, can be continuous peripherally on an entire perimeter of the electrical device, or can be composed of a plurality of connector portions. That is, the connector portion can wrap completely around an entire perimeter edge of the electrical device, can wrap completely around a substantial perimeter portion of the perimeter of the electrical device, or it can be a series of smaller portions that each wrap around smaller portions of the perimeter of the electrical device. Regardless, there is a perimeter portion of the edge busbar of the present invention which is peripherally on a substantial perimeter of the electrical device and connects to the various connector portion(s) of the present invention.
  • the front of a substrate is generally defined as the surface having the conductive electrode layer thereon.
  • the front of a substrate is the surface facing the other substrate.
  • the front of a substrate is the surface facing the EC stack.
  • the layer of transparent conductive material is on the front of a substrate.
  • the edge busbar itself can have an important affect on the performance of the EC device. Accordingly, it is an object of the present invention to minimize the contribution of the edge busbars towards slowing the EC device kinetics.
  • the edge busbars of the present invention may also assist in promoting a spatially uniform rate of color change during coloring and bleaching cycles.
  • an edge busbar includes a connector portion that has a separation or separating portion.
  • the connector portion at each side of the separation is electrically connected by the conductive electrode coating layer of the electrical device.
  • the separation is relatively small between the connector portions on each side of the separation, so that there is negligible resistance across the break.
  • the separation is electrically bridged by the conductive electrode coating layer. This allows the connector portion to be effectively continuous peripherally about the entire perimeter of the electrical device even though separations exist in the connector portion. Advantages to this configuration include ease of manufacture and reduced complexity of design.
  • Busbars of the present invention can be advantageously used in pairs.
  • Another embodiment of the present invention provides an edge busbar pair for an electrical device, each edge busbar comprising a connector portion and a perimeter portion, wherein each connector portion is effective to form an electrically conductive path from a front surface of a substrate, wrapping around a portion of an edge of the substrate, to an opposite back surface of the substrate.
  • the perimeter portions being in electrical contact with its respective connector portion, and wherein each perimeter portion is peripherally on a substantial perimeter of each respective substrate, and wherein the front surfaces of each substrate face each other with each substantial perimeter proximate to and substantially opposite to the other substantial perimeter.
  • each edge busbar of an edge busbar pair can be continuous peripherally on a substantial perimeter of its substrate, can be continuous peripherally on an entire perimeter of its substrate, or can be composed of a plurality of connector portions. It is advantageous for each edge busbar to be composed of a plurality of connector portions. It is particularly advantageous for each connector portion of each edge busbar to be in an alternating relation with connector portions of the other edge busbar. As shown later, when the connector portions are in such alternating relation, the thickness of the busbar material can be thicker than one half of the total gap distance between the substrates and yet still not cause an electrical short. Further, a sealant and/or an insulator can be added to assure against any shorting. Nonetheless, as explained earlier, thicker busbar material is desirable in order to maximize conductivity.
  • the present invention can be implemented for single substrate devices or dual substrate devices.
  • the edge busbars of the present invention can be used singly as needed advantageously (as contrasted with the prior art).
  • single substrate devices can nonetheless require a pair of edge busbars because such devices, as described earlier and as known in the art, often are made by forming an EC stack onto a substrate.
  • the EC stack requires a pair conductive electrodes as well as the substrate. Accordingly, both conductive electrodes have electrical signals applied to them which would benefit from the advantages of the edge busbars of the present invention.
  • an edge busbar is used having a portion that can be fabricated of any convenient material with an effective maximum thickness that can be inserted in the cell gap without shorting from touching with the other busbar or with the opposing conductive substrate.
  • the edge busbar of the present invention provides sufficient conductivity such that a negligible voltage drop (preferably less than one tenth of the applied voltage) occurs in the edge busbar.
  • the edge busbar of the present invention covers a substantial portion of the device perimeter and can include the internal busbars of the present invention.
  • the present invention also relates to the construction of substrates, especially transparent conducting substrates, which possess relatively large effective conductivities by the inclusion of internal busbars.
  • the present invention further relates to the use of the aforementioned substrates to construct affordable large area EC devices that can be used for architectural applications, (e.g. windows, partitions, skylights, diffuser panels, light pipes, etc.), automotive (windows, sunroofs, etc.) or other transportation (windows for planes, trains, buses, boats, etc.) applications, or signage applications (including large area displays such as those used at stock exchanges, airports and other such facilities).
  • architectural applications e.g. windows, partitions, skylights, diffuser panels, light pipes, etc.
  • automotive windshields, sunroofs, etc.
  • other transportation windshields for planes, trains, buses, boats, etc.
  • signage applications including large area displays such as those used at stock exchanges, airports and other such facilities.
  • the present invention also provides substrates which possess appreciably lower effective sheet resistances (can be less than 1 ⁇ /sq or ⁇ / ⁇ ) at a cost that is attractive for applications such as those described above.
  • the present invention teaches means for lowering the sheet resistance of thin film transparent electrically conducting assemblies for use in chromogenic devices, particularly electrochromic (EC) devices.
  • EC electrochromic
  • the present invention permits the manufacture of EC devices which possess significantly improved kinetics with regard to coloration and/or bleaching, even for devices which possess relatively large active areas.
  • the present invention also results in devices which possess considerably improved coloration and bleaching uniformity.
  • Electrodes 6602 may be comprised of any of a variety of electronic conducting materials. Because EC devices are generally used to modulate light, however, at least one of the ECE 6602 should possess reasonable transparency at the wavelengths of interest (mirrors and many displays, e.g., typically possess only one transparent ECE; and window-type devices typically possess two transparent ECE's). The present invention provides improved effective conductivity of transparent ECE's in a manner readily integrated into the device structure.
  • the present invention forms internal busbars by providing strips of highly conductive material electrically connected to interior portions of a transparent ECE.
  • the internal busbars add regions of increased conductivity into a transparent ECE, thereby lowering the overall effective resistance of the transparent ECE. Such lowered overall resistance leads to large device advantages.
  • the internal busbars of the present invention have increased conductivity compared to the transparent ECE when measured along the longitudinal direction of the conductive strips of the present invention. That is, in a top view of the transparent ECE with an internal busbar strip, when one compares a section of the conductive strip having a length L and a width W with a section of the transparent ECE also having the dimensions of W ⁇ L, the conductivity of the W ⁇ L section of the internal busbar will be higher than the conductance of the W ⁇ L section of the transparent ECE, along either dimension L or W.
  • the conductivity of the conductive strip will be greater than about 2 times the conductivity of the transparent ECE, more preferably greater than about 10 times.
  • the internal busbars of the present invention achieves such higher conductance by several ways.
  • materials having inherently higher conductivities are used for the busbars.
  • the busbar strips are made thicker than the surrounding transparent ECE. Such thicker strips can be embedded below the transparent ECE and/or into the underlying substrate. It is important that these two—that is, the internal busbars and the transparent ECE—are in electrical contact with each other (continuous or spatially intermittent).
  • the internal busbar strips are formed on a different surface from that surface which has the transparent ECE.
  • Strip connecting portions connect interior portions of the transparent ECE or device with segments of the internal busbar strip. Such strip connecting portions can extend through the substrate.
  • the internal busbars of this embodiment are nonetheless “internal” because they connect to regions of the transparent ECE away from the periphery.
  • the present invention also is directed to circuitry which uses low power.
  • Another object of the present invention are circuits which apply intermittent coloration power to EC devices in order to maintain or control the EC devices' coloration while compensating for the EC devices' inherent coloration decay without needing a constant application of coloration power.
  • FIGS. 1A, 1B, 1 C, 1 D, 1 E, and 1 F are side cross-sectional views of a number of different prior art electrochromic, liquid crystal, PDLC, and photochromic devices suitable for use in the present invention.
  • FIG. 2 is a perspective view of a prior art arrangement of edge busbars clips on two substrates.
  • FIG. 3A is an perspective exploded view of a prior art arrangement of edge busbar clips on two substrates.
  • FIG. 3B is a sectional view of a prior art arrangement of edge busbar clips on two substrates.
  • FIG. 4 is a perspective view of a prior art arrangement of edge busbars clips on two substrates.
  • FIG. 5 is a perspective view of a prior art arrangement of edge busbars clips on two substrates.
  • FIG. 6 is a schematic side view of an EC device.
  • FIG. 7A is a schematic sectional view of an EC device having edge busbars of the present invention.
  • FIG. 7B is a schematic sectional view of an EC device having edge busbars and conductive paths of the present invention.
  • FIG. 8A is a perspective view of an EC device with a substrate having edge busbars of the present invention.
  • FIG. 8B is a schematic top plan view of a substrate having a continuous conductive path of the present invention.
  • FIG. 8C is a schematic top plan view of a substrate having strip conductive paths of the present invention.
  • FIG. 9A is a schematic side view of a pair of edge busbars of the present invention.
  • FIG. 9B is a schematic side view of an adhesive multilayer strip for the fabrication of an edge busbar of the present invention.
  • FIG. 9C is a plan view of an adhesive multilayer strip for the fabrication of an edge busbar of the present invention.
  • FIG. 9D is a perspective partial view of a pair of edge busbars of the present invention at a corner.
  • FIG. 10 is a schematic cross sectional view of a pair of edge busbars of the present invention.
  • FIG. 11A is a side view of a prior art stacked substrate arrangement.
  • FIG. 11B is a top view of a prior art stacked substrate arrangement.
  • FIG. 12 is a schematic side sectional partial view of a prior art stacked substrate arrangement.
  • FIG. 13 is a perspective view of a single substrate with a bottom conductor applied according to an embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 14 is top view of a single substrate with a top conductor applied according to an embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 15A is a schematic sectional side view of a single substrate with a top and bottom conductors applied according to an embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 15B is a schematic sectional side view of a single substrate with a top and bottom conductors applied according to an embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 15C is a schematic sectional side detail view of a substrate with a bottom conductor and signal connections according to an embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 16A is a schematic sectional side view of a single substrate with embedded edge busbars according to an embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 16B is a schematic sectional side view of a single substrate with embedded edge busbars according to an embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 17A is a top view of a substrate with a continuous conductor busbar according to an embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 17B is a perspective view of a substrate with a continuous conductor busbar according to an embodiment of the present invention at an intermediate fabrication step.
  • FIG. 18 is a graph of the light transmittance vs. time for different busbar configurations according to the present invention.
  • FIG. 19A is a schematic sectional view of a stacked circular substrate arrangement according to an embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 19B is a top view of a stacked circular substrate arrangement according to an embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 20A is a schematic perspective view of a coated substrate with internal busbars formed on the surface according to an embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 20B is a schematic perspective view of a coated substrate with two sets of internal busbars formed on the surface according to an embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 21 is a schematic cross sectional view of a process to form embedded internal busbars on a substrate according to an embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 22 is a schematic plan view of a device with internal busbars having different widths according to an embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 23 is a schematic cross sectional side view of a device with internal busbars having a transverse axis parallel to a sight line that is at an angle to the surface normal according to an embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 24 is a schematic cross sectional diagram of a device according to an embodiment of the present invention having internal busbars that cause a property change when a signal is applied between them, a different property change when a signal is applied along each busbar equally, and changes in both properties when a difference occurs in the signals applied to each busbar according to an embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 25A is a schematic plan view of a group of internal busbars addressable as a group according to an embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 25B is a schematic plan view of a group of internal busbars individually addressable according to an embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 26A is a schematic plan view of two groups of internal busbars arranged at an angle to each other according to an embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 26B is a schematic plan view of a group of internal busbars arranged substantially parallel to each other according to an embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 26C is a schematic plan view of a spiral internal busbar according to an embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 27A is a schematic plan view of a group of internal busbars connected to the conductive layer by conductive posts according to an embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 27B is a schematic side sectional view of a group of internal busbars connected to the conductive layer by conductive posts according to an embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 28 is a schematic perspective exploded view of a group of internal busbars connected to the conductive layer by conductive posts according to an embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 29 is a schematic side sectional close up view of an internal busbar connected to the conductive layer by a conductive post according to an embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 30 is a graph of the transmissivity v. elapsed time for EC cells of different sizes without internal busbars or edge busbars.
  • FIG. 31A is a schematic plan view of a set of internal busbars disposed on a substrate according to an embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 31B is a schematic sectional view of a set of internal busbars disposed between two substrates according to an embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 31C is a schematic sectional view of a set of internal busbars disposed between two substrates according to an embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 32A is a schematic sectional view of an electrically reinforced edge busbar according to an embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 32B is a schematic sectional view of an electrically reinforced edge busbar according to an embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 32C is a schematic sectional view of an electrically reinforced edge busbar according to an embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 32D is a schematic sectional view of an electrically reinforced edge busbar according to an embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 32E is a schematic sectional view of an electrically reinforced edge busbar according to an embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 33A is a plan view of an electrochromic cell according to an embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 33B is a cross-sectional side view of an electrochromic cell according to an embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 34A is a graph of the coloration kinetics of a 6′′ by 3′′ (15 cm ⁇ 7.5 cm) electrochromic window with internal busbars according to an embodiment of the present invention, and of a comparison electrochromic window without internal busbars.
  • FIG. 34B is a graph of the current/time behavior of a 6′′ by 3′′ (15 cm ⁇ 7.5 cm) electrochromic window with internal busbars according to an embodiment of the present invention, and of a comparison electrochromic window without internal busbars.
  • FIG. 35 is a graph of light transmission (T) and applied voltage (V) as a function of time (t) according to an embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 36A is a circuit diagram of an embodiment of the present invention that includes a thermistor.
  • FIG. 36B is a circuit diagram of an embodiment of the present invention that includes a micro-controller.
  • FIG. 37A is a circuit diagram of a switching regulator circuit according to an embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 37B is a circuit diagram of a switching regulator circuit according to an embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 37C is a circuit diagram of a switching regulator circuit according to an embodiment of the present invention yielding a very low quiescent current.
  • FIG. 38A is a circuit diagram of a switching regulator circuit according to an embodiment of the present invention having a resistor placed in series with the power supply output and EC cell.
  • FIG. 38B describes the various shapes that the voltage vs. time curve can follow depending on the parameters of the control circuit of the present invention that controls an EC cell and compared to the prior art continuous step shape and the prior art linear ramp shape.
  • FIG. 38C describes the various shapes that the voltage vs. time curves can follow depending on the circuit resistance parameters.
  • FIG. 39 is a circuit diagram illustrating the incorporation of an op amp and thermistor in a circuit for regulating the voltage supplied to an EC cell.
  • FIG. 40 is a circuit diagram illustrating the use of a thermistor in a circuit to vary the output voltage with temperature.
  • FIG. 41 is a circuit diagram illustrating the use of a thermistor in a comparator circuit.
  • FIG. 42 is a circuit diagram illustrating the use of a thermistor in a comparator circuit.
  • FIG. 43 is a circuit diagram illustrating the use of an adjustable voltage power supply with an EC device.
  • FIG. 44 is a circuit diagram illustrating the use of a sensing resistor in series with the power output to limit the maximum current flowing in the circuit.
  • FIG. 45 illustrates an electric circuit attached to an EC cell having switches that may be used to determine t 1 or t 1 by mesuring the voltage at the EC cell V cell and comparing the value with V c or V B.
  • a conductive path is formed from the electrodes to the edges of the substrate. Preferably, this path is extended on to the back of the substrate as shown in FIGS. 7A and 7B (the details of other coatings employed in the device have been omitted).
  • Two substrates 701 and 702 are shown attached to each other at close proximity by cell adhesive 703 .
  • highly conductive paths are employed to lower the busbar resistance.
  • FIG. 7A shows an edge busbar 704 of the present invention which wraps around the edge of the substrate to provide highly conductive paths on three sides of the edge.
  • FIG. 7B shows a conductive path 706 of the present invention to which is attached a highly conductive perimeter portion 705 .
  • the conductive path 706 from the front of the substrates to the back could be the continuation of the same material which is used for the transparent conductor on the substrate, such as indium tin oxide, or can be fabricated from a different material.
  • the conductive path is formed on the back of the substrates, the geometrical limitations on the thickness and the width of the busbar conductor are relieved substantially because the perimeter portion can cover a larger area without concerns about thickness.
  • the busbar of the present invention includes the conductive path and the perimeter portion.
  • Conductive path 706 forms an electrical connection from the front to the back. Therefore, the paths can be called connector portions.
  • These electrical connector portions can be made using conductive adhesives, silver frits (e.g., available from Dupont Electronic Materials, Research Triangle Park, N.C. or FX 33-246 available from Ferro Inc. of Santa Barbra, Calif.), solder materials, physical vapor deposition, chemical vapor deposition, electroless deposition of metals, metallo-organics (e.g., available from Engelhard Electronic Materials, N.J.) and conductive tapes.
  • the conductivity of these connector portions need not be as high as the perimeter portions that connect to these connector portions because the connector portions only have to carry the current over a short distance, hence their actual effective resistance is low.
  • FIG. 8A shows two substrates 801 and 802 , separated for clarity. Substrate 802 is shown with a continuous conductive path 803 .
  • FIG. 8B shows substrate 802 , continuous conductive path 803 , and an adhesive 804 .
  • FIG. 8C shows a substrate 802 ′, strip conductive paths 803 ′, and adhesive 804 .
  • perimeter portion 805 connects strip conductive paths 803 ′. Perimeter portion 805 extends to a back perimeter region (not shown).
  • the connector portion of the present invention is used in the strip form as shown in FIG. 8C, the connector portion strips on the bottom and on the top substrates may be offset from each other, may be stacked on top of each other, or may have no particularly set geometric relationship.
  • the thicknesses may be increased almost to the point where they occupy the entire gap between the substrates without shorting.
  • Such connector portion strips are offset effective to allow an insulating distance between a particular connector portion strip and any neighboring connector portion strips connected to an opposite substrate, as well as between the particular connector portion strip and the opposite substrate.
  • the insulating distance can include insulating material.
  • the insulating material can also be preformed on the conductive strips.
  • the connector portion strips from one substrate are in an alternating relationship to the connector portion strips of the other substrate.
  • the perimeter portion materials could be selected from the same list of materials as the connector portions. However, to enhance their conductance, materials with high conductivity could be selected and/or the geometry (i.e., increased thickness, width, perimeter portions etc.) may be different from the connector portions.
  • Thick metallic strips and wires may also be used as perimeter portions.
  • the conductive path of the connector portions of the present invention overcomes the prior art's dependence on the busbars' specific conductivity because the present invention provides a broad area of conductance to which the connector portion is attached.
  • the devices are preferably assembled (e.g., by bonding together two substrates) after the connector portion strips or front to back connections are attached to each of the substrates. If counterelectrode coatings are required in the EC device, such strip connector portions can be formed or positioned before or after these coatings are deposited. Further, the part of the connector portion strips on the back of the substrates can be joined or reinforced (such as with conductive copper tapes) with highly conducting medium either before or after the device assembly.
  • the adhesive in the copper tapes may be pressure sensitive adhesive (PSA), or may be curable later into a thermosetting material by the application of pressure, heat, radiation, moisture, or more than one of these methods.
  • PSA pressure sensitive adhesive
  • the edge busbars of this invention can be augmented (“reinforced”) in conductivity. That is, the electrical conductivity is augmented or reinforced in order to increase the busbar electrical conductivity, by such methods as (i) by wrapping a continuous connector from the front to the back of the substrate, thus providing a wider conductor resulting in higher electrical conductivity, (ii) by attaching the connector to a conductive wire, foil, or tape positioned on the back of the substrate so that the connector's conductivity can be augmented by the conductance of the wire, foil, solder, frit, or tape, and (iii) attaching a wire or conductor on the edge of the substrate to electrically contact the connector in order to augment the conductance of the connector.
  • a preferred method to form the edge busbar is to use a conductive tape with a conductive adhesive layer that conducts through the adhesive layer thickness.
  • FIG. 9B shows a conductive tape 909 having a conductor 911 , a conducting adhesive layer 912 and an optional insulating layer 910 .
  • a continuous strip of such a tape is shown in FIG. 9C.
  • Tape 909 includes the continuous conductor or perimeter portion 913 , and fingers or connector portions 914 that will form the contact with the transparent conductor on the front side of the substrate.
  • the front side refers to the substrate side that faces the other substrate of an EC device, while the back of a substrate refers to the side, opposite to the front side, that faces away or is farther away from the other substrate.
  • Tape 909 connects the front of the substrate (facing inward) by way of connector portions 914 to perimeter portion 913 at the back of the substrate.
  • An edge portion 915 of connector portion 914 lies on the edge of the substrate.
  • perimeter portion 913 and strip connector portion 914 could be integrally connected, i.e., one piece of tape of the perimeter portion is preferably aligned with the bottom edge of the substrate, or is on the backside of the substrate.
  • the flat side is folded and adhered to the substrate back.
  • the tape in the corner could be folded over the back side to form a crease without effecting the connector portions at the front side. Since there is effectively no limitation on the gap or tape thickness on the back side (or the outside) of the device, the procedure of the present invention can be used without affecting the separation distance of the substrates.
  • the tape can be cut and the tape strips running at an angle to each other can be folded on top of each other on the corners.
  • the corners may also be bridged by a piece of another tape, wire, solder, etc., to keep preferably one continuous electrical path forming a perimeter portion for each substrate.
  • the tape or the strip on the back can be made more conductive by reinforcing the tape with a more conductive medium, e.g., more tape, wire, metallic strip, etc. Accordingly, the perimeter portion can be multilayered or made from a number of components.
  • the use of the above shape of the tape avoids any kinds of creases or kinks on the front surface.
  • Such kinks can develop as the tape traverses over the corners of the substrate. It is readily understood that as an edge bends to form a curve or to form a corner, an inner path which is a certain distance from the outer edge will trace a different distance from the outer edge. In the case of a convex curve, the inner path will be shorter. Accordingly, a non-stretching material will tend to crease or kink to try to accommodate the excess material on such an inner path.
  • the recesses between each connector portion prevents accumulation of excess material on the front side between the substrates.
  • the above description shows a tape that is easily and advantageously used for applications where a pair of edge busbars can be placed correspondingly opposite each other on two substrates without physical interference or electrical shorting because of the innovative geometry of the edge busbar pairs of the present invention.
  • Such geometry innovatively allows the pair of edge busbars to nest together in an alternating relation.
  • Such geometry further innovatively allows each of the pair of edge busbars to be thicker than half the gap separating the substrates on which they cover, thereby increasing the edge busbar conductivity without shorting to each other.
  • Such geometry also allows edge busbars to wrap around corners without interfering busbar material in between the substrate separation gap.
  • the tape shown in FIG. 9C can optionally have an additional row of strip connector portions 914 (not shown) on the side of perimeter portion 913 opposite the side with the row of strip connector portions 914 shown.
  • perimeter portion 913 is affixed to the edge of the substrate and the each opposite rows of strip connector portions 914 are affixed to respective opposite surfaces of the substrate.
  • the geometry of the tapes described above can be similarly employed for substrates with circular, elliptical, or any other regular or irregular shapes.
  • the width of the strip connector fingers and the spacing between them should be such so that no noticeable kink is introduced on the front side of the substrate for the reasons described above.
  • the electrical connections to the device are made from the perimeter portion on the back of the substrate by using more conductive tape, solder, adhesive, wires, etc., or preferably the tape described above may be provided in a pre-cut size and shape that has a connector or a connector attachment already assembled.
  • connector portion 914 of each tape 909 it is preferable for connector portion 914 of each tape 909 to be in an alternating relationship with the connector portions 914 of the other tape 909 to minimize the chances of shorting or of overlapping of fingers.
  • FIG. 9D a corner of substrate 901 and a corner of substrate 902 meet without any connector portions 914 at the corners.
  • the connector portions 914 remain in an alternating relationship to prevent any overlap of tape conductive material
  • tape 909 employed for this purpose can be coated or laminated with a nonconductive material insulating layer 910 on the side that is non-adhering. This will reduce the chances for shorting of the two substrates should the fingers inadvertently overlap or if there is a malfunction, for example, when one of the strip fingers lifts off the surface.
  • highly conductive busbars are made by wrapping the connector from the substrate front to the substrate edges and then reinforcing the edge portion with a highly conductive material.
  • the connectors are shown as 3205 and 3205 ′′ and the reinforcements as 3203 and 3203 ′′′ forming the busbars 3202 and 3202 ′′′.
  • the reinforcement can be any convenient shape such as a cylindrical wire, as shown for example. Another shape is a flattened wire. In this example the conductor is shown significantly thicker at the edges than its thickness on the front of the substrate. In FIG. 32D, the reinforcement is located in a precut groove on the edges of the substrate.
  • FIG. 32E shows highly conductive reinforced busbars having the reinforcement in a groove with the conductive connector wrapping from the front of the substrate around the edge to the opposite side of the substrate.
  • the busbars can be made by any convenient method such as, for example, by feeding the reinforcing wire and solder (as connector) so that both can be put in place simultaneously.
  • Another method could be where the wire is pre-attached, e.g., by wrapping and then mechanically tightening around the perimeter of the substrate. The solder is then deposited on the front and the edge thus electrically attaching the reinforcement with the connector.
  • FIG. 32A can be modified as shown in FIGS. 32B and 32C where the connector wraps around from the front to the back.
  • the conductor shown in FIG. 32D can be extended by having a wrap around connector (as shown in FIG. 32E).
  • the wire may be placed in a groove on the edge (as shown in FIG. 32D) or in a groove made in the back of the substrate close to the perimeter edge (not shown).
  • the connector may be deposited by using a soldering iron, with its tip shaped so that the solder can be melted and simultaneously deposited on two adjacent surfaces (as shown in FIG. 32A) or on three adjacent edges (as shown in FIG. 32B).
  • a conducting adhesive may also be applied.
  • the solder or adhesive may be applied from a bath of molten solder or uncured liquid adhesive by dipping the substrate edge in the bath and then moving the part (e.g., rotationally) effective to cover a substantial perimeter of the substrate.
  • edge sealant adhesive to fill in the remaining gap between the substrates and preferably extend to the substrates edges for improved reliability.
  • Substrates 1001 and 1002 are separated and attached to each other by cell adhesive 1003 .
  • Edge busbars 1005 including conductive paths that wrap around to the fronts of substrates 1001 and 1002 have an edge sealant 1004 filling the respective gaps between each opposite pairs of edge busbars.
  • any convenient non-conducting material can be used such as, for example, a curable formulation such as a caulking, a heat or radiation curable material, or a hot melt adhesive that cures later, or a non-curable formulation such as a hot-melt adhesive.
  • a curable formulation such as a caulking, a heat or radiation curable material, or a hot melt adhesive that cures later
  • a non-curable formulation such as a hot-melt adhesive.
  • Some examples of materials used in sealants are silicones, polysulfides, butyls, urethanes, epoxies, vinyls, polyolefins, polyamides and acrylics, etc.
  • Hot melt urethanes that cure later due to the diffusion of moisture may be preferred as a sealant because devices so made could be handled soon after fabrication and a non-flowable, non-sagging bond is obtained after curing.
  • One may preferably employ the cell adhesive 1003 to be the same as edge sealant 1004 .
  • This adhesive may have spacers so that the cell spacing is governed by the size of these spaces and the thickness of edge busbars 1005 . This avoids electrical shorts between the two substrates, due to busbar peel, moisture condensation or conductive impurity.
  • Highly conductive busbars may be deposited on single substrate devices in a number of ways to achieve substantial perimeter contact.
  • the busbars for an EC device do not cover a substantial perimeter of the device.
  • FIG. 12 taken from U.S. Pat. No. 5,187,607
  • a busbar is formed on the edges of the substrate.
  • the first transparent coating layer bottom conductor
  • This coating is either etched or deposited in such a way (e.g., by masking) that there is no electrical continuity between the two busbars.
  • the coatings which comprise the EC stack are substantially deposited on one of these sections.
  • the top conductor is deposited in such a way that it touches the second part of the bottom conductor and is electrically insulated from the first part of the bottom conductor by the EC stack.
  • none of the two busbars occupies a substantial perimeter of the device. Instead, the busbars run along the two edges similar to the prior art discussed previously.
  • busbars according to the present invention which are deposited on a substantial perimeter of an electric cell can be effectively employed for those devices that use thin coatings on one substrate.
  • a substrate 1101 has a transparent electrode 1102 on its front surface.
  • An EC stack 1104 is on the transparent conductor 1102 .
  • a bottom busbar 1103 is formed on the perimeter of the transparent conductor 1102 while a top busbar 1105 is formed on the perimeter of the top of the EC stack. Electric leads are connected to each busbar.
  • a bottom electrode 1402 is formed on substrate 1405 in a pattern with recesses 1301 at the edges of bottom electrode 1402 .
  • Bottom electrode 1402 can be formed by any convenient method such as, for example, by depositing the bottom electrode (e.g. made from ITO, doped tin oxide, doped zinc oxide, etc.) over an appropriate mask, or by etching through an appropriate mask after deposition.
  • the sheet resistance of the transparent conductors is less than about 30 ⁇ / ⁇ , more preferably less than about 15 ⁇ / ⁇ , and most preferably less than about 10 ⁇ / ⁇ .
  • the EC stack is then deposited along with the top electrode only onto the device area, and recesses 1301 in the electrode border area.
  • an insulating layer can be deposited.
  • one embodiment includes forming an EC stack 1406 on bottom electrode 1402 .
  • a top electrode 1401 is formed on EC stack 1406 .
  • An edge busbar 1404 connects to top electrode 1401
  • an edge busbar 1403 connects to bottom electrode 1402 .
  • Edge busbar 1404 comprises a perimeter portion 1404 C and a connector portion 1404 D.
  • Connector portion 1404 D includes a contacting portion 1404 A and an edge portion 1404 B.
  • Contacting portion 1404 A electrically contacts a surface of top electrode 1401 .
  • Edge busbar 1403 comprises a perimeter portion 1403 C and a connector portion 1403 D.
  • Connector portion 1403 D includes a contacting portion 1403 A and an edge portion 1403 B.
  • Contacting portion 1403 A electrically contacts a surface of bottom electrode 1402 .
  • Connector portion 1404 D and 1403 D are in alternating relationship on each side of EC device 1444 .
  • One method to form the continuous busbar on this device is to utilize a tape as shown in FIGS. 9B and 9C.
  • the first tape is placed around the periphery of the device with its fingers touching the bottom electrode in the connector border area.
  • the continuous body of the tape is folded and adhered to the back of the substrate.
  • the fingers of the tapes form the connector portions 1403 D and 1404 D.
  • the fingers of the second tape are then adhered on the top electrode (in the connector border area) and folded and adhered to the back of the substrate.
  • One of the tapes is wider, in order to protrude out.
  • Perimeter portion 1403 C extends beyond perimeter portion 1404 C to expose surface 1403 E. This allows connection to be made to both edge busbars 1403 and 1404 directly to any convenient point or points on perimeter portion 1404 C and to any convenient point or points on exposed perimeter portion 1403 E.
  • connection 1408 A and 1408 B are shown connecting to perimeter portions 1403 C and 1404 C, respectively while being insulated from perimeter portions 1404 C and 1403 C, respectively.
  • Connections 1408 A and 1408 B can be, for example, a conductive wire or tape connected to an exterior signal connector.
  • Connections 1408 A and 1408 B can be attached at only one corner (a smaller portion of the device perimeter), or at a longer portion of the device perimeter such as, for example, a substantial perimeter.
  • the edges of the EC device 1444 can be encapsulated, for example, by injection molding (e.g., using thermoplastic elastomers or plasticized polyvinyl chloride) or reaction injection mold (e.g., using polyurethane) with a resin that can be solidified to ensure the reliability of the connections. It may even be desirable to cover the entire device with another substrate (preferably a glass or a plastic sheet) for mechanical and environmental protection before edge encapsulation. This cover substrate may also incorporate UV blocking characteristics.
  • the edge encapsulation may be achieved such that a connector plug (which is internally connected to the busbars) is molded therein which can be easily disconnected from the power supply. This will allow EC panels to be quickly serviced and replaced in the field.
  • busbars 1602 may be embedded in the edge of a substrate 1601 or busbars 1603 may be embedded in the edge regions of substrate 1601 .
  • the appropriate region of the substrate is etched, ablated, or otherwise conveniently removed to form a recess.
  • a highly conductive material e.g., a metal
  • Planarization, to bring the substrate surface and the busbars substantially to a plane, may be necessary prior to the deposition of an additional layer or layers.
  • Such embedded busbars 1602 and 1603 can serve as perimeter portions with connector portions formed (not shown) by any convenient method such as, for example, wrapping tape around the edge to contact the back surface and the embedded busbar, depositing conductive material such as a frit or a coating around the edge from the embedded busbar to the back surface, or attaching a multitude of preformed conductive channels to the edge to contact the back surface and the embedded busbar.
  • the edge busbar of the present invention provides sufficient conductivity such that a negligible voltage drop (preferably less than one tenth of the applied voltage) occurs in the edge busbar.
  • the conductivity can be optionally reinforced by the addition of a supplemental conductor portion as part of the edge busbar of the present invention, as shown in FIGS. 32A, 32B, and 32 C.
  • an ultrasonic solder dispenses an appropriate soldering material on the edge of the substrate.
  • a highly conductive medium e.g. a wire, conductive tape or foil, etc.
  • both the solder and Whe wire or strip are dispensed simultaneously to form the edge busbar and the reinforcement at the same time.
  • the reinforcement bar can also be in the form of a closed loop with a perimeter slightly smaller than that of the substrate.
  • the reinforcement is expanded by heating and positioned around the edge making contact with the busbar.
  • it can be soldered to further improve electrical contact. This method is particularly appropriate in the case of cells having circular or oval substrates where the reinforcement can be made in the form of a ring and contracted, by cooling, uniformly around the substrate. Finally, a lead can be soldered to the reinforcement.
  • an edge busbar 3202 is formed on a peripheral surface and a substantial perimeter edge of a substrate 3201 .
  • Edge busbar 3202 includes a reinforcement portion 3203 which can be any convenient conductor such as, for example, wire, foil, or bead of solder. Reinforcement portion 3203 is shown as a circular cross-sectional wire attached to the side of the edge portion 3205 of edge busbar 3202 .
  • a connection 3204 provides an external electrical lead to edge busbar 3202 .
  • an edge busbar 3202 ′ is formed on opposing peripheral surfaces and a substantial perimeter edge of a substrate 3201 .
  • Edge busbar 3202 ′ includes a reinforcement portion 3203 ′ which is shown as a circular cross-sectional wire attached to the side of the edge portion 3205 ′ of edge busbar 3202 ′.
  • a connection 3204 ′ provides an external electrical lead to edge busbar 3202 ′.
  • an edge busbar 320211 is formed on opposing peripheral surfaces and a substantial perimeter edge of a substrate 3201 .
  • Edge busbar 3202 ′′ includes a reinforcement portion 3203 ′′ which is shown as a circular cross-sectional wire attached to one peripheral edge portion 3206 of edge busbar 3202 ′′.
  • a connection 3204 ′′ provides an external electrical lead to edge busbar 3202 ′′.
  • solder edge busbar 3302 is in electrical contact with one segment of a silver frit layer 3303 . Another segment of silver frit layer 3303 forms an internal busbar 3304 . Internal busbar 3304 is interior to the perimeter formed by a main epoxy seal 3305 .
  • solder edge busbar 3302 ′ and 3302 ′′ are in contact with segments of silver frit layers 3303 ′ and 3303 ′′.
  • a common epoxy seal 3305 ′ bounds internal busbars 3304 ′ and 330411 which are segments of silver frit layers 3303 ′ and 3303 ′′ respectively.
  • EC devices were made having two substrates, one employing a one half wave ITO (about 12 ohms/square) on glass substrate (from Donnelly Applied Films, Boulder, CO) and the other being a TEC 15 glass (from Libby Owens Ford (LOF), Toledo, Ohio). The nominal size of these was 6 inch by 6 inch (15 cm ⁇ 15 cm). The gap between the substrates was 210 micrometers. Busbars were formed using a copper tape with conductive adhesive. Three different configurations were made: (i) Comparative Example 1C was made in a configuration as shown in FIG. 2, where the edge busbar was on one edge of each substrate, (ii) Comparative Example 2C was made in a configuration as shown in FIG.
  • Example 1 was made in a configuration as shown in FIG. 7A and constructed by a method as shown in FIGS. 17A and 17B, where the edge busbars are on four edges of each substrate. Copper tape (with conductive pressure sensitive adhesive) was used to form the busbars. The thickness of the copper tape was 50 micrometers and a width of 3 mm.
  • the assembled cells were powered by connecting power to the busbars.
  • power was connected to one of the copper tabs 1703 sticking out from each of the substrates.
  • the tabs were not joined by a wire or a tape on the back. Since the distance between the adjacent copper strips was small, the potential drop in the intervening ITO was negligible for this device.
  • the busbars of Example 1 effectively formed a continuous electrical conductor around each substrate perimeter.
  • the continuous electrical conductor of Example 1 included the connector portions being effectively electrically continuous as well as the perimeter portions being effectively electrically continuous.
  • FIG. 18 shows the kinetic traces of each of the three devices when they were colored and bleached by applying identical step potentials.
  • Example 1 the cell with busbar on all four sides colors, was the fastest to color and colored the deepest (during the time shown in the graph), while Comparative Example 1C, the one with busbar only on one edge, was the slowest to color and also colored the least deep of the three devices.
  • An EC device 1910 was made using two TEC 15 transparent conductive substrates as shown in FIGS. 19A and 19B.
  • Example 2 was a circular EC device 1910 with a substrate 1902 being 13 inches (33.02 cm) in diameter and a second smaller substrate 1901 being 12 inch (30 cm) in diameter.
  • a busbar 1904 on the smaller substrate 1901 was formed by screening on a silver frit from Dupont Electronic Materials, Wilmington, Del. (frit Type 7713). The frit forming was deposited in a perimeter ring geometry to form busbar 1904 , with the outer dimensions of the ring being substantially the same as that of substrate 1901 .
  • the width of the ring was 2 mm and the thickness was 5.5 micrometers.
  • busbar 1904 ring In one part of the busbar 1904 ring the silver frit was painted on the edge (while keeping it connected to the ring) and extended on to the back of the substrate to form a conductive path 1908 of busbar 1904 which is conductive from the front to the back.
  • An electrical conducting wire 1906 is connected to conductive path 1908 on the back.
  • Substrate 1901 was heated to 575° C. for 6 minutes to consolidate and cure the frit.
  • the busbar 1905 on the larger substrate 1902 was formed by attaching a copper beryllium spring clip 1905 around the circumference.
  • Spring clip 1905 comprises a continuous perimeter portion 1911 which extends circumferentially around the edge of substrate 1902 , and finger connector portions 1912 which extends radially from continuous perimeter portion 1911 to substrate 1902 .
  • a conducting wire 1907 was soldered to clip 1905 to power substrate 1902 .
  • EC cell 1910 was assembled by gluing the two substrates together with adhesive 1903 , as shown in FIGS. 19A and 19B.
  • the smaller substrate 1901 was kept concentric with the larger substrate 1902 .
  • the means employed does not adversely affect other components of the device operation. This is especially problematic when the TC acts as a substrate for an active EC layer or layers (such as for devices which contain EC tungsten oxide deposited on ITO-coated glass substrates).
  • the means employed do not too strongly diminish the transmissivity or apparent transmissivity of the TC or otherwise adversely affect the cosmetics of the device.
  • the resistance of the TC may be decreased appreciably by increasing its thickness, but increased thickness generally has a strongly negative impact on TC transmissivity characteristics and cost.
  • a desirable means of imparting a relatively high effective conductivity to a TC comprises depositing a pattern of a highly conductive material over, under, or within it (or some combination).
  • Commercially available TC's such as half-wave ITO or doped tin oxide (DTO) can be used and modified by adding internal busbars according to the present invention.
  • the pattern can be formed as lines across the substrate. These lines may or may not intersect.
  • the lines or patterns may be referred to as internal busbars (IB's).
  • FIG. 20A shows a substrate 2001 made of, for example, glass, coated with a transparent conductive coating 2002 .
  • Internal busbars 2003 are formed on conductive coating 2002
  • FIG. 20B shows additional internal busbars 2004 transverse to internal busbars 2003 .
  • the internal busbars (IB) of the present invention do not react with the cell components. That is, the internal busbars should be chemically and electrochemically isolated from the reactive layers of the cell. Reactive layers are the electrolyte, the ion insertion electrodes, and the electrochromic layers. In these layers, chemical and physical reactions take place when the cell is colored or bleached.
  • the chemical and electrochemical isolation can be by any convenient means such as, for example, by interposing a barrier layer between the IB and the reactive layer.
  • the property of being not ionically conductive is a requirement of the optical passivation layer so that, when a voltage is applied to the finished cell for coloring or bleaching, no ion transport takes place from any of the cell components to the internal busbars and vice versa.
  • the isolated IB's of this invention are connected to the conductive layers by connecting portions that are electrically conductive. Accordingly, the IB's of this invention can provide substantial improvement of the electrical properties of the conductive layer while not being in contact with the layer.
  • the effective sheet resistance was taken as the resistance that would be measured between an electrode connected on one full side of the square and another connected to the opposite full side. It should be noted that the calculations can be repeated for a grid pattern which may consist of curved lines or non-uniformly dimensioned (e.g., in width and thickness) conductive line patterns.
  • Table 1A Calculated effective sheet resistances ⁇ / ⁇ for a system comprising 3 strips, where each strip possesses the dimensions (h s , w s ) given in the Table.
  • Table 1B h s ⁇ N s N s h s 1 2 3 4 5 100 nm 13.448 13.396 13.344 13.293 13.243 1 ⁇ m 9.721 7.595 6.232 5.283 4.586 2 ⁇ m 7.595 5.283 4.051 3.284 2.762 3 ⁇ m 6.232 4.051 3.001 2.383 1.976 4 ⁇ m 5.283 3.284 2.383 1.87 1.538 0.1 mm 0.339 0.171 0.115 0.086 0.069
  • Table 1B Calculated effective sheet resistances ⁇ / ⁇ for a system comprising Ns strips, where each strip possesses a width of 0.15 mm and a height, h s , as indicated in the Table.
  • Table 10 w s ⁇ N s N s w s 1 2 3 4 5 0.01 mm 12.232 11.181 10.297 9.543 8.891 0.05 mm 8.891 6.628 5.283 4.392 3.758 0.1 mm 6.628 4.392 3.284 2.623 2.183 0.15 mm 5.283 3.284 2.383 1.87 1.538
  • Table 1C Calculated effective sheet resistances ⁇ / ⁇ for a system comprising N s strips, where each strip possesses a height of 4 ⁇ m and a width, w s , as indicated in the Table.
  • N s The number, N s , of IB's is such that there is a fixed spacing of 1 cm between busbars. Edge busbars are not represented in the calculations (so, e.g., for a L cm ⁇ L cm system, there are (L ⁇ l) IB's). In all cases, the underlying conducting sheet possesses a sheet resistance of 15 ⁇ / ⁇ .
  • the effective sheet resistance is useful for comparing substrates of comparable size.
  • an effective resistance (R) defined as the effective sheet resistance multiplied by the area of the substrate (thus possessing units of ⁇ cm 2 / ⁇ ), is more useful for comparing substrates of different sizes.
  • Table 2B comprises the data for the effective resistance (R), for each sheet, as a function of substrate size. TABLE 2B Calculated effective resistances for Systems A and B.
  • the width of the internal busbars should be small so that the active area of the EC device can be maximized. Further, such narrow widths also minimize optical interference to viewing through EC devices to which such internal busbars are incorporated. Thus, narrow widths are less obtrusive to vision.
  • the descriptors “narrow or wide” refer to a “width” dimension parallel to the surface of the feature being described, while the descriptors “thin or thick” refer to a “thickness” dimension orthogonal to the surface of the feature being described.
  • a preferred geometry of the IB's include patterns which are greater than about 1 ⁇ m in thickness, and most preferably greater than about 10 ⁇ m in thickness.
  • any convenient material can be used and formed by any convenient technology, materials and technologies that allow such thick IB's to be deposited are preferred. Examples of materials which are easy to deposit in these dimensions are typically conductive inks, pastes, and frits. Examples of the methods are described below.
  • the overall conductivity of the substrate does not depend appreciably on whether the conductive electrode coating is over the grid, around the grid, under the grid, or in some such combination.
  • the grid if the grid is deposited on the surface of the transparent conductor, the grid should be prevented from reacting or corroding in the device through the use of a protective barrier or passivation coating.
  • the construction and materials of such a barrier coating depends upon the degree of reactivity of the grid material at the potentials encountered during device operation.
  • the internal busbars of the present invention may not be directly connected to other busbars such as edge busbars or such signal leads.
  • the internal busbars of the present invention can be termed “floating”busbars.
  • the signals are generally conducted to the internal busbars of the present invention by the conductive layer that is in contact with them. By such contact, the conductive layer's conductive is effectively lowered because the internal busbars of the present invention have lower conductivity than the conductive layer they are in contact with.
  • the IB's of the present invention can be optionally connected to other busbars described above, to other IB's, or to electrical leads.
  • an IB of the present invention can nevertheless receive an applied signal by the IB's being “bridged” to other voltage sources through the conductivity of the conductive layer the IB is in contact with.
  • applications such as, for example, those that call for specific signals being applied to specific internal busbars where the internal busbars of the present invention can optionally be directly connected to a signal source.
  • the IB's can occupy a variety of transverse locations in a device.
  • a pattern may be deposited on top of the TC.
  • a device of the form
  • EC refers to an electrochromic film
  • the height of a grid on TC 1 should be significantly less than the cell gap (i.e., the thickness of the electrolyte/redox species medium), preferably much less.
  • the thickness of the grid is much less than that of the EC film, then the grid has little effect on the shape of the EC film. If the thickness of the grid is on the order of or greater than that of the EC film, then the EC film may often form a noticeable “relief” of the grid pattern (or it may even form in separate areas defined by the grid pattern).
  • the durability of devices with the IB grid of the present invention generally should be similar to devices without the IB grid. Any durability test should yield the same result with or without the grid. That is, the addition of the internal busbars of the present invention should not affect the reliability and durability of the devices. Accordingly, results of any durability tests to qualify a device for a particular application are likely transferable, or can be anticipated to be the same if such tests are repeated with the devices having internal busbars. Because durability is one of the key issues involved in developing a commercially viable device, this is an important parameter. To ensure durability of these devices, it has been discovered that it is preferred to deposit a passivation layer on top of the internal busbars, particularly if the IB's are deposited on top of the transparent ECE's. Materials for passivation are described below.
  • the “effective height” of the grid may be reduced by embedding the grid conductor partially in the TC and substrate.
  • Internal busbar conductors 2102 are embedded in substrate 2101 .
  • the formation of internal busbar conductor 2102 may be done by any convenient way such as, for example, by etching or ablating away a desired pattern in the substrate and then depositing the desired grid material.
  • the effective height of the grid may be reduced by embedding it partially in the glass as well as the TC.
  • the portion of busbar conductors 2102 that are above the surface plane of substrate 2101 is removed until the surface and the busbar conductors are at substantially the same plane 2103 .
  • the grid is partially embedded into the glass and then the surface is planarized by, for example, polishing to produce a structure as shown in the process in FIG. 21. Planarizing may also be done by depositing additional material on to the substrate so that the top surface of this added material is coplanar with the grid.
  • FIG. 21 shows conductors 2102 having circular cross section such as commonly found in a wire, it could be of another convenient shape, such as rectangular. Additionally material can be deposited, for example, from solutions, or by physical vapor deposition, etc. Some examples of such materials are polyimide, sol-gel deposited oxides and organic/inorganic hybrids.
  • a TC is then deposited on the resulting planarized surface and the resulting glass
  • This process of the present invention has the distinct advantage that the more chemically active components of the device such as the EC film and the electrolyte are not directly exposed to the IB grid material.
  • the layers in single substrate devices are generally each quite thin (typically in the 100's of nm). It is therefore particularly preferred to use IB's which are fully embedded under the TC in such devices.
  • the IB on the outer TC (layer 103 ′ of FIG. 1 E) could consequentially be of any thickness since it will protrude on the outside of the device.
  • IB's on one or both TC's in a device depends on a variety of factors, including the required response time and coloration uniformity characteristics and the cost of manufacturing the devices. Devices generally display faster response times and greater coloration uniformity with the IB's implemented on both TC's.
  • EC device 2210 has conductive transparent substrate 2201 transversed by narrower internal busbars 2202 and wider internal busbars 2203 .
  • Narrower internal busbars 2202 and wider internal busbars 2203 are separated by gaps 2208 from edge busbar 2204 .
  • Gaps 2208 are bridged by conductive transparent substrate 2201 .
  • Narrower internal busbars 2202 and wider internal busbars 2203 optionally connect directly to edge busbar 2204 .
  • Another component of the present invention is the use of IB's which will be optically less prominent, by making the IB's much deeper than they are wide.
  • r 1b the aspect ratio of the internal busbar structure divided by its effective height (thickness)
  • the height direction of the IB's should be transverse to the plane of the substrates of the device. But for some devices such as, for example, an automotive windshield, the primary viewing direction might be at some angle to the approximate plane of the windshield. In such applications it would be preferable to implement the IB's such that their height direction is parallel to such slanted viewing direction. As shown in FIG. 23, device 2301 has internal busbars 2302 embedded in substrate 2303 at an angle parallel to the viewing direction 2305 .
  • a device 3101 has internal busbars 3102 disposed such that no internal busbar blocks a contiguous channel. Internal busbars 3102 are in contact with only one device edge and extend only to the other device edge, thereby forming a contiguous channel 3103 . If the device is filled with the electrolyte after edge sealing (such as by vacuum back-filling), only one fill hole is required to perform the filling task.
  • FIG. 31B shows a device 3110 where internal busbars can extend from one device edge to the other device edge.
  • the internal busbars are arranged in a staggered configuration. Consequently, although internal busbars 3102 ′ might extend from one device edge to the other device edge, and each internal busbar 3102 ′ might be thicker than one half the gap distance, their staggered arrangement forms a contiguous channel 3103 ′ which allows easy filling of device 3110 , with electrolyte fluid, without interruption.
  • FIG. 31C shows a device 3120 which has internal busbars 3102 ′′ that can extend from one device edge to the other device edge, and that can be in an overlapping relation.
  • Internal busbars 3102 ′′ are, however, in alternate ramped geometries which form a contiguous channel 3102 ′′ which allows easy filling of device 3120 , with electrolyte fluid, without interruption.
  • FIGS. 31B and 31C show embodiments of the present invention in which the sum of the thicknesses of the internal busbars is larger than the cell gap distance. Yet, the innovative geometries of the present invention allows such internal busbars' use without any problems of electrical shorting or interrupted electrolyte fluid continuity. As described above, the width of the internal busbars should be small so that the active area of the overall EC device can be maximized. The resistance of internal busbars with narrow width can be nonetheless low because the height (thickness) of the internal busbars can be made effectively thick. As described above, geometries and patterns that form IB's having thicknesses greater than about 1 ⁇ m are preferred, and most preferred are thicknesses greater than about 10 ⁇ m. FIGS. 31B and 31C show how such thicker dimensions can be used without causing the gap distance to be disadvantageously thick.
  • the IB's included in devices under the present invention may be used for additional purposes, and these may or may not require modification of the IB design.
  • the IB's may be used as Joule heating elements for purposes such as de-fogging.
  • FIG. 24 shows a device 2410 with an EC assembly 2401 having two internal busbars 2402 over the layers of TC 2403 .
  • Applying a voltage V1 and V2 of equal values across the two ends will induce a current flow along each of the internal busbars 2402 but will not result in EC activity in device 2410 because, with equal voltage potentials at each end, there is no current path or potential drop transverse to the device.
  • the signals can be adjusted accordingly to provide for a current path and a potential drop transverse to the device by changing V1 and V2 to be unequal. For most EC devices the voltage difference needed between V1 and V2 is less than 2 volts.
  • IB's are implemented on both TC's of a window-type device, separate heating of both TC's without inducing EC activity requires balancing of the lateral voltage potentials so that there is no transverse potential. If simultaneous coloring is desired, the potentials can be adjusted accordingly.
  • the IB's may also be used as antennae for electromagnetic signals.
  • a strip IB as a monopole antenna, letting one end float electrically and connecting the other end to the appropriate signal processing electronics such as, for example, a radio receiver.
  • the signals from a set of strip IB's forming well known antennae geometries may be combined and the combined signal appropriately processed.
  • Other patterns of IB's forming well known antennae geometries may be used to optimize the antenna functionality.
  • IB's may also be used as transmitters following well known transmitter grid geometries.
  • IB's may also be used to provide or enhance the effective shielding from unwanted electromagnetic waves or interference.
  • the penetration depth (or “skin depth”) of electromagnetic waves into the devices may be decreased by increasing the effective conductivity of the TC layers.
  • specific IB patterns may be employed such as, for example, forming a part of a Faraday cage to provide optimal shielding for a particular class of electromagnetic waves.
  • FIG. 25A shows a device 2501 with internal busbars 2505 arranged at an angle to and proximate to a busbar 2507 with proximate gaps 2508 between busbar 2507 and each internal busbar 2505 .
  • Proximate gaps 2508 are bridged by conductive layer 2509 on substrate 2510 .
  • Busbar 2507 can be an internal busbar or an edge busbar.
  • Busbar 2507 and internal busbars 2505 form a single addressable array 2503 powered by a conductor 2504 .
  • each internal busbar 2505 is directly connected to busbar 2507 .
  • FIG. 25B shows a device 2502 with separately addressable internal busbars 2506 , each separately powered by separate conductors 2504 .
  • an EC device e.g., a sunroof or windshield
  • Such individual control can produce a number of effects such as, for example, a gradient effect, a shade effect, or a geometric pattern effect.
  • light sensors For example, for an automotive sunroof, one can use light sensors to effectively track the position and intensity of the sun and then color more deeply the appropriate regions of the sunroof.
  • information regarding the presence and positions of occupants of the automobile may be combined with the signals from the light sensors to determine the appropriate signals to apply to the separately addressable IB's to obtain an appropriate coloring or bleaching pattern.
  • the light sensors should be situated such that they provide effective indications of the light intensity from a variety of directions.
  • the presence and positions of occupants of the automobile may, for example, be sensed via transducers in the seats and/or by detecting the status of the seatbelts.
  • Smart Devices can be made by using the signals derived from a system of sensors to determine the appropriate drive signals to be applied to the individually-addressable IB's and edge busbars in EC devices.
  • Conductive frits are usually pastes and liquids (also termed inks) of a conductive material in a carrier.
  • the carrier typically cures or typically is eliminated during a post-application process such as subjecting to elevated temperatures.
  • Conductive frits for IB can be deposited by any convenient method such as, for example, X-Y Motor Painting/Screening, Doctor Blading/Silk Screening/Circuit Printing, Chemical Vapor Deposition and Physical Vapor Deposition (CVD and PVD):
  • a programmable X-Y table with a fluid dispenser may be utilized to apply the desired pattern to the substrate.
  • the thickness and width of the conductive line is determined by factors such as the size of the dispenser tip opening, the viscosity of the fluid, the dispenser line pressure and the lateral speed of the dispensing tip relative to the substrate, and the distance between the dispensing tip and the substrate.
  • Low viscosity molten metals may also be used for the busbars. These could be sprayed or processed by soldering or welding. These methods could be assisted by ultrasound or other energy imparting means to promote uniformity and/or better adhesion to the substrate.
  • Doctor Blading/Silk Screening/Circuit Printing This method involves the forcing of a viscous liquid through narrow openings in an appropriate mask, to be deposited on a substrate in a pattern determined by the mask design.
  • This mask may consist of any type of tape, film, or other mask material, such as a silk-screen-like item, placed on top of the substrate, with channels or isolated voids in a desired pattern.
  • An excess of the fluid is then placed at one end of the mask, then a uniform, flat tool (such as a “squeegee” or similar implement) is dragged across the mask, forcing the fluid through the pattern troughs onto the substrate.
  • Another alternative is to silkscreen, or otherwise use a doctor blade to deposit uniform layers of photoprintable thick film compositions.
  • the internal busbar pattern is then formed by exposing the deposited film to certain wavelengths of light through masks and followed by chemical processing.
  • the passivation materials for internal busbars such as certain dielectric materials can be similarly processed.
  • CVD is a known process which deposits a coating by decomposing a chemical vapor to provide the depositing material.
  • PVD is a known process which deposits a coating by vaporizing a material and then redepositing this in a substrate in a vacuum chamber.
  • CVD and PVD may be assisted by energy imparting sources such as plasma, ionized beams, microwave, etc.
  • patterns are applied by placing either a shadow mask over the substrate and coating directly onto the surface, or by using photolithographic technology to apply a photoresist mask to the substrate, coating that assembly with metal, and then stripping the photoresist layer away, leaving the metal pattern.
  • Some exemplary frit, inks and conductive adhesives that may be employed in this invention include:
  • DuPont Electronic Materials Wilmington, Del., Silver-Bearing Conductors: DuPont Silver Thick Film Composition, Nos. 1991, 1992, 1993, 1997; DuPont Silver Thick Film Composition, #7713; and DuPont Solamet Photovoltaic Compositions such as #E64885-52A.
  • one or both of the substrates may have added internal busbars according to the present invention.
  • FIG. 26A shows a device 2608 having a perimeter busbar 2602 on substrate 2601 .
  • Substrate 2601 has a conductive layer 2615 on its surface.
  • a series of internal busbars 2603 form a crosshatch pattern.
  • Internal busbars 2603 can be on, in, and/or below conductive layer 2615 .
  • the perimeters of each internal busbar 2603 are in contact with conductive layer 2615 .
  • FIG. 26B shows a device 2609 having a series of internal busbars 2604 forming a parallel pattern. Neither series of internal busbars 2603 or 2604 touch perimeter busbar 2602 .
  • the internal busbars conduct a current that travels from the perimeter conductor through the conductive layer 2615 to the internal busbar. This may be advantageous, since the adhesive used to seal the edges of the two substrates need not be modified in composition and no change in processing parameters is needed for ensuring good adhesion to the internal busbars and for accommodating the change in substrate topography.
  • FIG. 26C shows a device 2610 having a coiling internal busbar 2605 which is in contact with conductive layer 2615 at the entire perimeter of internal busbar 2605 .
  • Coiling internal busbar 2605 has higher conductivity than conductive layer 2615 , which serves to lower the overall resistance of conductive layer 2615 , thereby making more homogeneous the applied signal to conductive layer 2615 .
  • Coiling internal busbar 2605 can stand alone as shown.
  • Coiling internal busbar 2605 also can be formed in close proximity at its outer coil to a perimeter busbar (not shown). Alternatively, the coiling internal busbar can be attached directly to a signal power by leaving a portion of the coiling internal busbar exposed and attaching a signal wire to the exposed portion.
  • a passivation layer may be deposited using similar techniques described previously. If certain materials and methods are used to deposit the grid pattern such as silk-screening of metal frits, then post-treatment such as curing or hardening with time, heat, radiation (UV, visible, IR, microwave) may be required. The passivation layer is typically deposited after the above post-treatment. Similar types of post-treatment procedures may be required to harden the passivation layer.
  • the post-treatment for the grid pattern may also result in an in-situ formation of a passivation layer on the surface.
  • the in-situ formed surface may consist of a phase separated inert material, an oxidize portion, a nitride portion, etc. This will also depend on the atmosphere and temperature conditions under which such post-treatment is carried out.
  • This passivation layer may be sufficiently passivating to be incorporated in these devices. Treatment where a part of the exposed grid pattern becomes passivated could also be done when the grid patterns are deposited by physical and chemical vapor deposition. The surface of these may be passivated using oxidation, nitriding, heat, laser, plasma, or ion bombardment assisted treatments.
  • the passivation layer may consist of organics, inorganics or hybrid materials.
  • Adhesives such as, for example, non-conducting epoxy adhesives, urethanes, acrylates, or polyesters could be deposited for passivation. These may be the same materials that are used for making device seals.
  • the materials may be cured by heat and/or radiation, such as UV, IR or microwave. The viscosity and the application procedure can be adjusted so that the desired thickness is obtained.
  • the materials can be applied by any convenient method such as, for example, being screened, dispensed, sprayed, or painted. Sol-gel methods could also be used to deposit oxides and polyceramics as passivation layers. Examples of such materials are alcoholic or non-alcoholic based solutions of metal alkoxides, nitrides, halides, or mixtures thereof, or solutions of reactive metallic precursors with organic complexing agents. Further, these oxides may be inert such as silica or could be conducting such as indium tin oxide and doped tin oxide. Preferably the passivating materials should be non-conductive, both ionically and electronically.
  • Electronically conducting materials which may be used as passivating materials are those which are used in making transparent ECE's such as doped tin oxide and indium tin oxide. They should not also be attacked, swelled, or interact with the layers that come in contact with such as electrochromic layers, ion storage layers, electrolytes, etc. Examples of some commercial encapsulants/passivation layers that could be silk-screened include #A3840, #A3560, and #A3563, made by Engelhard. An example of a photoprintable passivation layer is Fodel DG211 from DuPont Electronic Materials.
  • Electrochromic devices use several transparent conductors that are not reactive while the other components such as electrochromic layers, counterelectrodes, and redox materials in the electrolyte necessarily participate in the electrochemical activity required for electrochromic operation.
  • non-reactive materials are defined as those that lie outside the electrochemical potential range that is utilized for operating the EC device. Also materials that are insulators and/or do not transmit or get intercalated with ions under the above operating conditions and will not change their physical properties in the cell (such as dissolution in the liquid electrolyte if used) can also be considered as non-active.
  • Materials such as many polymers such as epoxies, polyimides, acrylics, urethanes, and inorganics such as dense silica, alumina, several other oxides, silicates, and organo-silicates can be also considered non-reactive.
  • metals such as gold and platinum may also be considered non-reactive. Thus these metals may be used for busbars without additional passivation layers.
  • the passivation layer may extend to the edge of the substrate, or stop short of the edge so as to only be in the interior of the device.
  • the internal busbars can be electrically contacted with the edge busbars (for example by using wires, tapes, conductive adhesives, solders, or wire clips).
  • the novel edge busbars of the present invention may also be used in conjunction with the novel internal busbars of the present invention.
  • the conductivity of the substrate can also be enhanced through the use of a wire pattern embedded in a substrate (the substrate may be constructed from glass, plastic, or some other material). This wire pattern substitutes for the grid pattern described above. If the substrate is essentially electrically insulating, and if the conductive pattern is entirely embedded in the insulating substrate, then it is generally necessary to connect electrically the conductive pattern and the transparent conductor. This may be done, for example, by drilling holes though the substrate up to the metal grid and then filling the holes with a conductive material. FIGS. 27A, 27B, 28 , and 29 illustrate this concept, including different methods of ensuring transparent conductor/plug contact.
  • FIGS. 27A and 27B show a device 2710 with a substrate 2705 covered with a transparent conductor layer 2704 .
  • Internal busbar conductors 2702 are embedded in substrate 2705 .
  • Conductive plugs 2703 lead from the surface of device 2710 to electrically contact internal busbar conductors 2702 .
  • transparent conductor layer 2704 was applied after the holes for plugs 2703 were made but before plugs 2703 were formed.
  • FIG. 28 shows a device 2801 formed by attaching internal busbars 2802 to a surface 2807 of a substrate 2803 .
  • Holes 2805 are formed effective to extend from an opposite surface 2808 of substrate 2803 to internal busbars 2802 .
  • Conductive plugs 2804 are formed effective to extend from internal busbars 2802 to opposite surface 2808 .
  • Transparent conductive layer 2806 is then formed on opposite surface 2808 , contacting conductive plugs 2804 , thereby being in electrical contact with internal busbars 2802 .
  • FIG. 29 shows a device 2901 where direct addressing of the internal busbar conductor was not necessary.
  • Device 2901 has an internal busbar conductor 2902 embedded in substrate 2904 .
  • a conductive layer 2903 provides electrical contact between transparent layer 2905 and internal busbar conductor 2902 .
  • Inert filler plug 2906 fills the hole.
  • Transparent conductor 2905 is applied after the hole that provide access to internal busbar conductor 2902 is made. Then conductive layer 2903 is formed in the hole. Finally, inert filler plug 2906 is formed.
  • the conductive pattern is not entirely embedded in the substrate (i.e., if it contacts the transparent conductor) or if the substrate is sufficiently conductive, a separate conductor is generally not necessary.
  • Internal busbars can also be used to make devices with those substrates on which only low conductivity transparent ECE's can be deposited.
  • transparent ECE's such as indium tin oxide and doped tin oxide are deposited at high temperatures (in excess of 200° C.) to get good conductivity. Most of those materials, when deposited on plastics, at lower temperatures, are less conductive.
  • EB's as described above in conjunction with lower conductivity transparent ECE's would result in high conductivity substrates which will be attractive for electrochromic devices.
  • Step 1 Temperature raised from 25° C. to 100° C. at 10° C./min and held at 100° C. for 15 minutes.
  • Step 2 Temperature raised from 100° C. to 325° C. at 10° C./min and held at 325° C. for 10 minutes.
  • Step 3 Temperature raised from 325° C. to 600° C. at 10° C./min and held at 600° C. for 10 minutes.
  • Step 4 Temperature lowered from 600° C. to 25° C. at 10° C./min.
  • the “TEC-Glass” products are manufactured by an on-line chemical vapor deposition process. This process pyrolytically deposits onto clear float glass a multi-layer thin film structure, which includes a microscopically thin coating of fluorine-doped tin oxide (having a fine grain uniform structure) with additional undercoating thin film layers disposed between the fluorine-doped tin oxide layer and the underlying glass substrate. This structure inhibits reflected color and increases light transmittance.
  • the resulting “TEC-Glass”product is a non-iridescent glass structure having a haze within the range of from about 0.1% to about 5%; a sheet resistance within the range of from about 7 to about 1000 ohms per square or greater; a daylight transmission within the range of from about 77% to about 87%; a solar transmission within the range of from about 64% to about 80%; and an infrared reflectance at a wavelength of about 10 ⁇ m within the range of from about 30% to about 87%.
  • a TEC 15 substrate (3 inch ⁇ 3 inch; 7.5 cm ⁇ 7.5 cm) was silk-screened with silver paste as described in Example 1, where the length of the silver strip was incrementally varied in such a manner as to leave an equal distance between edges, at right angles to the strips, of the glass substrate as shown in FIG. 26B.
  • the distances of the silver strip from the edge for Examples 4, 5, 6, and 7 are 0.0 mm, 1.0 mm, 3.0 mm, and 7.0 mm respectively.
  • the resistance of the substrate was measured by soldering a metal strip 2 mm wide at both edges of the substrate which were at right angles to the internal silver strips to serve as a representative portion of a perimeter busbar.
  • Example 4 The Comparative Example 3C, a TEC 15 substrate with no internal silver busbars had a resistance of 15 ⁇ .
  • Example 4 the substrate with internal silver strips extended fully to the perimeter busbars had a resistance of 0.1 ⁇ .
  • Example 7 Even in Example 7, with the silver busbars as far as 7 mm from the perimeter busbar, the resistance is decreased to 3.2 ⁇ from the Comparative Example's 15 ⁇ .
  • a 3′′ ⁇ 3′′ (7.5 cm ⁇ 7.5 cm) TEC 15 substrate coated with 380 nanometers of WO 3 according to the method set forth in U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,252,354, 5,457,218 and 5,277,986 and a counter electrode of TEC 15 of similar size was made into a cell using an epoxy seal containing 210 ⁇ m spacers. The two electrodes were positioned so that they were slightly off-center exposing a region at either end for application of a metallic busbar. Prior to assembly the counter electrode had two holes drilled in it for application of the electrolyte.
  • the cell was filled with electrolyte containing 0.01M LiClO 4 and 0.05M ferrocene in a 60:40 volume % mixture of propylene carbonate and tetramethylene sulfone and the fill holes plugged with epoxy.
  • the conductive surfaces which protruded from either side of the cell were ultrasonically soldered with lead-tin-cadmium-based solder. Wires were then attached to these contacts.
  • the electrochromic performance of the device was determined by placing the cell in a spectrometer and following the color kinetics at 550 nm while applying a coloring potential of 1.3 volts followed by a bleaching potential of ⁇ 0.3 volts.
  • the cell In the transmissive (bleached) state the cell had a transmission of 77% and in the fully colored state a transmission of 10% T. At a coloring potential of 1.3 volts the cell took 46 seconds to color from 70% T to 10% T and 47 seconds to bleach back to 70% T.
  • Cell A Comparative Example 4C, had conductive electrodes with no internal busbars.
  • Cell B Example 9, had internal busbars on the working electrode (WO 3 ) only.
  • Cell D Example 11, had internal busbars on the both electrodes.
  • Example 9 the internal busbars were deposited as described in Example 8.
  • the cells were colored at 1.3 volts for 90 seconds and bleached at ⁇ 0.3 volts for 90 seconds.
  • the color kinetic data for the cells is shown in the following Table 4: TABLE 4 Time to color from Time to bleach from 70% T to 10% T 10% T to 70% T Cell Seconds Seconds Cell A 89 89 Cell B 74 65 Cell C 89 89 Cell D 56 58
  • An electrochromic cell was prepared as described in Example 8 with conductive electrodes which contained internal busbars without a passivation layer. The cell was cycled at 70° C. at a color potential of 1.3 volts for 15 seconds, long enough to colorize, followed by being bleached for 45 seconds at ⁇ 0.3 volts. After 5,000 such cycles the cell showed visible reaction of the silver strips within the cell. This resulted in a degradation in the cell's optical properties.
  • An electrochromic cell was prepared as described in Example 8, containing internal silver busbars, on both electrodes, with a protective epoxy overcoat. At a coloring potential of 1.3 volts the cell colored from 70% T to 10% T in 8 seconds. The cell was cycled at 70° C. under a coloring potential of 1.3 volts for 15 seconds and a bleach potential of ⁇ 0.3 volts for 45 seconds. After 5,000 cycles the cell showed no visible reaction of the internal busbars in the cell nor degradation of the cell's electrochromic performance.
  • ITO indium tin oxide
  • the ITO was deposited by electron beam (E-beam) evaporation and deposited directly on top of the TEC 15 and the silver strip lines through the use of a mask.
  • the E-beam target was an indium tin oxide composite and the thickness of the ITO layer thus formed was 500 nm.
  • Two of these TEC 15 substrates having the described electrodes were used to make an electrochromic cell as described in example 9. Under a coloring potential of 1.3 volts the transmission at 550 nm changed from 76% T to 8% T. It took 14 seconds to modulate from 70% T to 10% T at 1.3 volts, while it took 23 seconds to bleach back to 70% T at ⁇ 0.3 volts.
  • Silver strips were deposited onto TEC 15 as described in example 3, and overcoated with a layer of Sol-Gel derived antimony doped tin oxide (ADT).
  • ADT Sol-Gel derived antimony doped tin oxide
  • the ADT precursor was prepared as described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,525,624 and 5,457,218.
  • the electrodes were made into an electrochromic cell as described in example 9. At a coloring potential of 1.3 volts the cell colored from 70% T to 10% T in 19 seconds. At a potential of ⁇ 0.3 volts it bleached back to 70% T in 20 seconds.
  • busbars which are less than 100 ⁇ m in width. These lines are practically invisible to the eye, depending on the distance between the eye and the substrate on which the lines are deposited. For example, a normal eye subtends a small enough angle with lines of widths of 100 ⁇ m from a distance of 19 inches that the line is not discernible (about 0.01 degrees). Thus, any angle equal to or smaller than 0.01 degrees can be considered as invisible.
  • busbar widths that form these angles, depending upon the distance of the substrate from the observer, can be utilized with little or no interference with vision.
  • 50 ⁇ m wide lines (6 ⁇ m thick) spaced at a distance of 0.75 cm are expected to give the same overall conductivity to the substrates as lines which are 100 ⁇ m wide (6 ⁇ m thick) and spaced 1.5 cm. Both of these widths and line spacings are expected to give photopic transmissions in excess of 70% when deposited on conductive glass (such as TEC glass from LOF) with a resistance of 8 or more ohms/square.
  • conductive glass such as TEC glass from LOF
  • widths of these lines can be wider for rear automotive windows as compared to the windshields, since the latter are closer to the observer. Further, the material in these widths can also be used to deposit antennas on glass (such as automotive windows) which are invisible, i.e., the window appears transparent although a patterned antenna is printed using these conductors and processes.
  • TEC 15 was used as the transparent conductor in each cell.
  • Example 15 had an internal busbar while Comparative Example 6C did not.
  • the cell without the busbar, Comparative Example 6C was assembled similarly to the assembly described in Comparative Example 4C.
  • the spacing between the substrates was 88 micrometers.
  • the two electrodes were positioned with an offset so that about 0.25 inch (0.63 cm) of each electrode strip, at either of the 3′′ (7.5 cm) ends of the substrates, was exposed.
  • a solder was applied by a heated ultrasonic soldering system (Sunbonder from Sanwa Components USA, San Diego, Calif.).
  • the solder used was Cerasolzer 186 (obtained from Sanwa Components US), and had an average thickness of about 20 micrometers.
  • Example 15 The second cell, Example 15, also had a gap 88 micrometers thick and was made with both internal busbars and edge busbars as taught in this invention.
  • edge busbars and an internal silver frit busbar were applied to three contiguous edges, via an x-y dispensing technique, similar to that shown in FIG. 33A.
  • the frit layers were fired with the four-step procedure as in Example 3 and then passivated as in Example 8 using a black colored bisphenol A based epoxy adhesive.
  • This frit/passivation pattern was applied to both the substrates.
  • the width of the frit line was about 0.7 mm and thickness of the frit line was between 10 and 15 micrometers.
  • the thickness of the passivation layer was about 30 to 40 micrometers with a width of about 1.5 mm so as to completely cover the frit to form an encapsulation around the frit.
  • One of the substrates was then coated with tungsten oxide, assembled, and filled as described in the Comparative Example 4C.
  • the frit pattern was identical on both the substrates except that the frit line pattern was lightly offset so that the frit lines on the two substrates were next to each other rather than opposed or on top of each other. This was done to ensure that any local bumps would not lead to any electrical shorting and that the cell gap is maintained at 88 micrometers.
  • the internal busbar was formed by one of the frit lines, while the other three frits formed an edge busbar since they were outside the cell seal area.
  • the soldered busbar which was applied in addition to the frit busbar on the edge, reinforced the conductivity on that edge, while providing a means to attach a soldered electrical lead. The silver frit and the soldered busbar were touching each other in this Example.
  • Example 15 and Comparative Example 6C were colored at 1.3 volts for 60 seconds and bleached at ⁇ 0.3 volts for 60 seconds.
  • the plots of transmission versus time are shown in FIG. 34A, and the concomitant current flow through the devices is shown in FIG. 34B.
  • FIG. 33B DuPont Frit type 7713 was used to form the frit layers.
  • Comparative Example 6C the cell without the internal busbar, the coloring reaction is slow and the depth of color is small.
  • Example 15 the coloring and bleaching reactions are faster and the depth of coloration is much higher because the internal busbars are able to supply much higher levels of current when needed during coloration and bleaching.
  • devices that demand high currents any time during coloration or bleaching will particularly benefit from this invention.
  • EC devices requiring currents in excess of 0.1 mA during coloration or bleaching will benefit most.
  • the coloring voltage only needs to be applied intermittently, depending on the length of the color state memory, after sufficient coloration has been achieved. For example, if the memory of the device was longer than the color duration required for the particular application to be colored, then the coloring potential effectively could be applied just once and then turned off (i.e., the device is left in non-powered open circuit mode). The potential can then be applied again when the device's light transmission needs to change, e.g., while bleaching or changing its transmission to a different desired level. However, under certain circumstances, it might be necessary to keep the device in a desired state of transmission for periods that are longer than their color state memory.
  • the period t 1 after which the coloration voltage is re-applied, depends in part on the extent of color change that is allowed before it might become obvious to the user that the device light transmission is changing.
  • This allowable change in photopic transmission, all measured at 550 nm, for a window in a building or a car (e.g., a sunroof) is preferably in the range of from about (the difference (T c1 %-T c2 %), as in FIG. 35) 0.1% to about 20%, more preferably from about 1% to about 15%, and most preferably from about 5% to about 10% from the desired colored state.
  • the above transmission criteria can also be used where the devices only color in the near infrared region, about 0.7 ⁇ m to about 2.5 ⁇ m.
  • the change in light transmission can be solar transmission instead of photopic transmission.
  • the light transmission wavelength can be selected in any conveniently selected range.
  • FIG. 35 where transmission vs. time and applied voltage vs. time is plotted for a typical EC device controlled by the present invention.
  • a voltage V c is first applied to colored the window (as shown by the transmission T % falling, indicating that the light transmission is low). The voltage is then removed, as shown by a break in the voltage line, for a period of t 1 . During this time t 1 , the cell starts to bleach, as shown by the transmission T % rising.
  • the time ti is related to the length of the color state memory for a particular EC device.
  • the coloring potential is reapplied for a period of t 2 followed by the removal of power (holding period) for a period of t 1 .
  • This alternating sequence is continued indefinitely, for as long as it is desired to keep the device in that desired state of transmission.
  • the desired state is a range of transmission defined by T c1 % and T c2 % .
  • the total time t C is the overall time of coloration.
  • FIG. 35 also shows that the initial coloring voltage can be applied as an increasing linear ramp to a maximum potential V c .
  • a step potential V c can be applied.
  • Another way to apply the potential is by imposing a maximum current limitation. Either of these two modes, or a non-linear ramp, could be conveniently used. With increasing device area, it may be preferred to ramp the coloring and bleach potential so that the current densities at the edges can be lower. This also promotes a spatial uniformity in color change during coloration and bleaching. This is particularly noticeable as the device area increases.
  • the coloration potential (V c ) could be applied as a step potential (as shown), or it may be ramped from the open circuit potential of the device to V c .
  • V c or V b referes to the potential which the power supply attempts to apply to the EC cell and is also the limiting potential on the EC cell.
  • the EC cell has charateristics of an (RC) circuit, the potential of the cell (V cell ) only changes slowly as shown by the dashed line in FIG. 35.
  • t 1 at ⁇ 20° C. could range from a few hours to several days or even months, while t 1 at 70° C. could change to range from about 1 to about 15 minutes.
  • t 2 at ⁇ 20° C. could range from about 1 to about 60 minutes, while changing to range at 70° C. from a fraction of a minute to about 10 minutes. Further, the change in these times might not be linear with temperature.
  • t 1 and t 2 can be fixed as in the prior art; but in this invention these time intervals can be allowed to change as discussed above, unlike the prior art.
  • FIG. 35 also shows that even the bleach time (tB) could depend on the device temperature or/and on the total time the device was kept in the colored state (t c ) prior to initiating the bleach.
  • both t 1 and t 2 decrease with increasing temperature.
  • the temperature sensor may be any convenient sensor such as, for example, a thermistor, a RTD thermocouple, a transistor, or a diode, the output from which can be used to determine t 1 and t 2 .
  • the thermistor would preferably be a negative thermal coefficient (NTC) thermistor.
  • NTC negative thermal coefficient
  • the resistance of the NTC thermistor would decrease and the resulting RC product (R is resistance, and C is capacitance) connected to the LM 556 (National Semiconductor, Santa Barbra, Calif.) timer would also decrease leading to smaller t 1 and t 2 .
  • the drop in resistance in the NTC thermistor with temperature would be correlated with the transmission changes during t 1 and t 2 periods of the EC device.
  • the temperature coefficient of the thermistor and the capacitor in the circuit should be chosen so that the change in RC would naturally mimic the desired change trends needed for t 1 and t 2 .
  • t 1 and t 2 will depend on the depth of coloration. For example, in the open circuit mode the transmission change for a deeper colored state may be faster (thus requiring a shorter t 1 ) than for a shallower colored state. Similarly, it may take more time to achieve a darker state (thus requiring a longer t 2 ) Since the depth of coloration is typically related to the potential used for coloration, one could define and store in the control circuit a profile of t 1 and t 2 values that are calibrated with the applied coloration voltage.
  • t 1 and t 2 may also shift. Account could be kept of the number of cycles, time spent in a particular state of transmission or any other convenient method which keeps a track of the age and usage of the cell. An aging profile with varying t 1 and t 2 could be used to drive the cell and if needed, the potential can also be varied and controlled to keep the initial level of coloration. Such control can be by any convenient method such as, for example, the use of monitoring sensors and feedback processes.
  • no prescribed periods are used but rather the actual level of coloration is sensed through the EC cell.
  • the degree of color change can be detected by the photosensor and once the coloration has changed to a predetermined level, the necessary voltage can be applied to recolor the EC cell back to its original depth.
  • Use of the photosensor can also eliminate any need to pre-program values of or factors to calculate t 1 and t 2 with aging, temperature or coloration voltage.
  • Photosensors e.g., CdS photoconductors on Si photodiodes, can be used to provide feedback signals for controlling t 1 and t 2 instead of presetting fixed values for t 1 and t 2 .
  • the photosensor(s) would monitor the transmission of the EC cell and actively signal the circuitry as to the appropriate times to remove and to apply the voltage. As coloration rates and bleach rates change with temperature, aging, and other factors, t 1 and t 2 are adjusted accordingly.
  • Preferably a pair of photosensors are used. One photosensor is placed on top of the cell to obtain the baseline for incoming light while another is placed underneath the cell to collect the transmitted light.
  • the electrical signals from these two photosensors are then connected to a differential amplifier, the output of which is proportional to the relative transmission through the cell.
  • a differential amplifier the output of which is proportional to the relative transmission through the cell.
  • the cell will be subjected to open circuit (holding period t 1 ) or voltage application (period t 2 ).
  • the depth of coloration can still be maintained since t 1 and t 2 will change due to the feedback provided by the photosensors. For example if the coloration rate of the cell slows down, both t 1 and t 2 will increase to maintain a pre-determined differential output from the photosensors for identical illumination conditions. Also, if t 1 and t 2 become longer than pre-determined “acceptable periods”, then the circuit may be configured to increase the coloration potential (subject to a maximum safe-potential for the devices) to increase the coloration speed.
  • Another method monitors the current (I) or the rate of change in current injected with time (t), i.e. dI/dt. Once dI/dt reaches a prescribed low value, the coloring potential is removed.
  • the transmission change during the holding period (t 1 ) can also be correlated to the open circuit potential change between the two cell electrodes.
  • the potential between the two opposing electrodes of the EC cell (V cell ) will also decrease.
  • a coloring voltage can be then applied to recolor the EC device.
  • the time period t 2 can be determined by checking the current being injected into the cell. For example, as shown in FIG. 34B, for a constant voltage the rate of change of the current decreases with time and reaches a limiting value. Thus, when the change in the current with time becomes smaller than a predetermined level, the coloring voltage can be removed.
  • the charge injected during coloration can be monitored by a charge integration circuit. Once a predetermined charge has been injected, the coloration voltage can be removed.
  • the charge passed into the device for a desired level of coloration may depend on temperature.
  • V cell asymptotically approaches V c .
  • V cell is within 5% (preferable 1%) of V c
  • the coloring potential V c is removed to let the cell rest in open circuit conditions.
  • V c could be continued to be applied for an additional fixed time after the above condition is met to allow the cell to reach equilibrium.
  • the total coloration time (t 1 or t 2 ) are obtained by adding the time for coloration during which V cell approaches V c and the fixed duration described above.
  • V cell the potential of the cell (V cell ) is measured and when it drops to about 3 to 30% of V c (preferably 10 to 15% of v c ) the coloring voltage V c is re-applied.
  • V cell the potential of the cell
  • V c the coloring voltage
  • the coloring and bleaching voltages may also be varied with temperature if desired. For example, depending on the devices, higher voltages may be used at lower temperature or vice-versa. Additionally, with temperature feedback to the control circuities, both the duration (i.e., t 1 and t 2 ) and the voltage can be varied simultaneously to further mitigate electrical or electrochemical stress on the EC cell.
  • the voltage can be made temperature dependent by having a thermistor-containing voltage reference in the power supply.
  • This thermistor can be a NTC (negative thermal coefficient) or a PTC (positive thermal coefficient) type. As the temperature rises the resistance will be lower in NTC thermistors. Consequently, when incorporated with suitably-biased series resistors and an operational amplifier (op amp), the reference voltage to the error-sensing op amp will be lower as temperature increases, resulting in a lower voltage applied to the EC cell at higher temperatures.
  • op amp operational amplifier
  • FIG. 39 An example of a circuit incorporating an NTC thermistor TM 1 and an op amp OP 1 is shown in FIG. 39. As the temperature increases, the resistance of the TM 1 will be lower, resulting in a reference voltage from PS 2 to OP 1 to be lower. Thus, output voltage V OUT will be lower. Accordingly, a properly designed resistor stack with a combination of series and/or parallel resistors incorporating such thermistors would cause the voltage needed (V OUT ) to track with operating temperature.
  • each component was PS 1 was 12 VDC, R 1 and R 2 were 10K ⁇ each, C 1 was 10 ⁇ F, PS 2 was 2.5 VDC, OP 1 was a LM324 op amp available from National Semiconductor, Santa Clara, Calif., TM 1 was an NTC Thermistor having a resistance of 1.76 kg at 50° C., and the output voltage was 1.35 V.
  • a PTC thermistor TM 2 can also be used in a circuit to change the output voltage with temperature, an example of which is shown in FIG. 40.
  • the values of each component were similar to that example above, PS 3 was 12 VDC, R 3 and R 4 were 10K ⁇ each, C 2 was 10 ⁇ F, PS 4 was 2.5 VDC, OP 2 was a LM324 op amp, TM 1 was an PTC Thermistor having a resistance of 1.76k ⁇ at 5° C. , and the output voltage was 1.15 volts.
  • the thermistor can also be used in a comparator circuit to trigger the microprocessor to use different t 1 , and t 2 periods, for example, as shown in FIG. 41.
  • the thermistor TM 3 used was a NTC Digikey part # PNT 117-ND available from Panasonic, Cupertino, Calif., with a resistance of 1.76K ⁇ at 50° C.
  • the potentiometer resistor R 5 in series with the thermistor was adjusted to match the thermistor's set value, i.e. 1.76K ⁇ .
  • PS 5 was 12 VDC
  • R 6 and R 7 were each 15K ⁇
  • the op amp was an LM324 op amp available from National Semiconductor.
  • the voltage drop across R 6 and R 7 (Vcc) is 5.0 V.
  • the positive input of the op amp is fixed at 2.5 V by the two 15K ⁇ series resistors R 6 and R 7 .
  • the TM 3 resistance is higher than 1.76K ⁇ resulting in a voltage of higher than 1 ⁇ 2 of Vcc (that is, 2.5 V) to the negative input of the LM324 op amp. Since the negative input is higher than the positive input there is no output from the op amp at such lower temperatures. When the temperature climbs to 50° C.
  • the resistance in the thermistor drops below 1.76K ⁇ , thereby lowering the voltage below 2.5 V and resulting in a positive output signal from the op amp that can be routed to a microprocessor input port.
  • the microprocessor can then change the t 1 , and t 2 periods in response to the positive output signal.
  • the output of the op amp will be turned on at the threshold temperature; however near the region of this threshold there may be thermal fluctuations which may cause the output to erratically turn on and off.
  • a positive hysteresis can be added to the op amp comparator using positive feedback.
  • a feedback loop can be formed by resistor R 12 , resulting in a Schmitt trigger.
  • the values of the components were those of the corresponding components in FIG. 41, with the added resistors R 11 being 10K ⁇ and R 12 being 1K ⁇ .
  • Schmitt triggers With such a Schmitt trigger in the circuit, the low trigger threshold is different from the high trigger threshold (the difference being the hysteresis intentionally induced in the comparator, rather than a single threshold value as in a conventional comparator).
  • Such Schmitt triggers can also be used in photosensors to detect daylight—it is well known that around the region of daylight threshold, e.g., during dusk and dawn, photocells can behave erratically. Having positive hysteresis in the op amp comparator will aid in obtaining a smooth output.
  • Schmitt triggers can be used in EC skylight circuits where both photosensors and temperature sensors are employed.
  • FIG. 43 shows an example of an implementation of an adjustable voltage power supply where the output voltage supplied to the electrochromic panel ECU 1 can be tuned to give two different output voltages depending on the transistor switch T 4 which will be activated when there is a predefined temperature change.
  • PS 7 was 12 VDC
  • PS 8 was 2.5 VDC
  • R 14 and R 13 were each 10K ⁇
  • R 15 and R 16 were each 1K ⁇
  • R 17 was 4K ⁇
  • C 3 was 10 ⁇ F.
  • the transistors T 3 and T 4 , and the op amp were those described above.
  • the trigger to the base of T 4 can come from either a microprocessor port as shown in FIG. 43, or the comparator output from a circuit as shown in FIG. 41 or 42 .
  • the resistor R 15 Upon turning on of transistor T 4 , the resistor R 15 will be in parallel with the reference resistor R 14 resulting in a lower overall resistance and hence lower reference voltage to the error-sensing op amp.
  • the output voltage will also be lower.
  • such output voltage can change to vary the EC color voltage below full coloration, e.g., during half color.
  • the EC power supply can also incorporate current limitation, e.g., using simple transistor switching or current holdback techniques.
  • the addition of a sensing resistor in series with the power output, together with another transistor as shown in FIG. 44, can limit the maximum current flowing in the circuit by the judicious choice of the sensing resistor R 20 value.
  • This sensing resistor can be fixed for constant maximum current or made variable for variable current limiting in the circuit.
  • PS 9 was 12 VDC
  • PS 10 was 2.5 VDC
  • R 18 and R 19 were 10K ⁇
  • TM 4 was an NTC thermistor having a resistance of 1.76K ⁇ at 50° C.
  • Op Amp OP 6 was an LM324
  • T 5 and T 6 were 2N3904 transistors described above
  • C 4 was 10 ⁇ F.
  • sensing resistor R 20 having a resistance of 1K ⁇ (V BE of T 6 is 0.7 volts)
  • the voltage output V OUT was 1.35 volts, and was limited to a current I OUT of 0.7 mA.
  • the variation in t 1 may be much more strongly dependent on temperature than t 2 (e.g., see device #1 and 2 in Table 5 below). In such cases the powering circuit could be simplified so that only t 1 varies with temperature and t 2 is fixed in duration.
  • the coloration and bleaching are controlled by applying a pre-specified maximum potential and that this potential can be a step, ramp, non-linear, etc.
  • the power supply can be configured so that it applies a pre-specified current for coloring and bleaching, subject to a maximum safe-potential. This means that the applied potential from the power supply will vary with time (to compensate for changes in impedance, for example).
  • a controlled current source could be used. The current is reduced, or the current source is removed, as the maximum safe-potential is reached. Thus, when a pre-specified potential between the cell electrodes is reached, the power source is removed.
  • a current limit for coloring (or bleaching) for non-internal busbar cells is typically chosen between 50 to 5000 ⁇ A/cm 2 of active area of the EC cell, more preferably between 100 and 1000 ⁇ A/cm 2 . For cells with internal busbars current limit (if imposed) can exceed the upper limit of this range to insure that time to color and bleach is rapid.
  • the temperature measuring or sensing elements such as thermistors, ferroelectric capacitors, thermocouples, or other such temperature measuring means, are mounted in such a way that they sense or measure temperatures that are similar to the temperature of the EC cells. That is, the measured temperature must have a corresponding relation to the temperature of the EC cell.
  • the measuring means could be mounted on a cell surface, on a cell edge, or at a position proximate to the cell so that the temperature of the cell and the temperature of the sensing element are similar. In some cases it may be preferred to mount the thermistor so that it is hidden from the direct view of the user. Adhesives with high thermal conductivity may be used for mounting so that the sensing elements are close in temperatures to the substrates they are mounted on.
  • the sensing element should measure a temperature that is relevant to the temperature of the large EC cell or of the multiple EC cells.
  • relevant temperature would be, for example, an average temperature across the large EC cell or the multiple EC cells.
  • the peak or low temperature might be relevant. Accordingly, the sensing element should be positioned so that such a relevant temperature is sensed or measured.
  • determining t 2 may also be used for determining and/or controlling t 1 .
  • the time period t b may be fixed or could be varied.
  • the EC control circuit was designed to incorporate the intermittent powering of the EC cell E 1 , as described above.
  • the coloring and bleach potentials were fixed at 1.2 V and ⁇ 0.3 V respectively, while t 1 and t 2 were allowed to vary with temperature.
  • the system can utilize any convenient voltage as would be apparent to one of ordinary skill in the art.
  • 12 V DC is used.
  • the voltage can be supplied from any convenient source such as, for example, from a car battery or from a transformer that steps down 110 V AC to 12 V DC.
  • the circuit uses a LM 556 dual timer (National Semiconductor, Santa Clara, Calif.), which includes an astable timer U 1 /A and a monostable single shot timer U 1 /B, to control the timed cycles for the EC device.
  • the output of timer U 1 /A drives a transistor Q 1 which then further drives a transistor Q 2 .
  • Transistor Q 2 activates the relay K 1 :A which upon closing applies the coloring potential from the 1.2 V voltage source.
  • a pair of diodes D 1 and D 2 isolate the outputs of U 1 /A and U 1 /B from each other.
  • Astable timer U 1 /A is cycling constantly but its output is only applied to electrochromic cell E 1 when switch S 3 is in the color position after an initial time period, for example, 200 sec from U 1 /B.
  • Resistors R 2 and R 3 may each be replaced with a NTC thermistors, e.g., model DC95-& 104Z available from Thermometrics, Edison, N.J., to allow for t 1 and t 2 compensation at electrochromic cell E 1 .
  • a NTC thermistors e.g., model DC95-& 104Z available from Thermometrics, Edison, N.J.
  • Monostable single shot timer U 1 /B provides the initial duration—in this case, for example, 200 sec, of coloring or bleaching potential.
  • the values are calculated, in this example, to yield the 200 sec duration to initially color or bleach the cell and is triggered by switch S 1 .
  • the output from switch S 1 drives transistors Q 2 and Q 3 .
  • Resistor R 6 can be replaced with an NTC thermistor to obtain longer and shorter initial bleaching (or coloring) periods, respectively.
  • electrochromic cell E 1 The potential which is applied to electrochromic cell E 1 depends on the position of switch S 3 , which the user selects. If switch S 3 is in the coloring position, astable timer U 1 /A takes over after the initial 200 sec coloring cycle and then electrochromic cell E 1 is cycled intermittently by astable timer U 1 /A to maintain coloration. Astable timer U 1 /A is never applied while switch S 3 is in the bleaching position.
  • ferroelectric-capacitors having a Curie point, T c , for example, below ⁇ 45° C., based on SrTiO 3 — containing compositions can also be used in the timer circuit to provide temperature sensitive capacitors.
  • T c Curie point
  • SrTiO 3 — containing compositions can also be used in the timer circuit to provide temperature sensitive capacitors.
  • the capacitance declines with increasing temperature. Accordingly, such capacitors can be used to cause the periods of t 1 and t 2 to be changed along non-linearly with temperature changes, such as to cause even longer periods at lower temperatures and shorter periods at higher temperatures.
  • a combination of thermistors and ferroelectric capacitors can be used simultaneously to obtain the RC product necessary to change t 1 and t 2 according to temperature.
  • a microcontroller can also be used to obtain t 1 and t 2 functionalities in the control circuities using built-in timer modes thus negating the use of any external timer chips such as LM555 or LM556.
  • Examples of such microcontrollers are PIC16F84 from Microchip (Chandler, Ariz.), MC68HC11E9 from Motorola (Tempe, Ariz.), and Z-80 from Zilog (Campbell, Calif.).
  • Temperature sensors can be connected to the microcontroller to change t 1 and t 2 accordingly.
  • Flash memory or EEPROM can further be utilized in conjunction with the microcontroller to store information on the temperature dependence, electrical history and aging properties of the EC cell. This information will then be used as feedback to optimize the cell bleaching and coloring characteristics. These may include changes to V c , V b , T cl %, T c2 %, t 1 , t 1 , t 2 and t b .
  • a Microchip microcontroller PIC16F84 as shown in FIG. 36B was used (in place of the LM556 dual timers of FIG. 36A) in a circuit similar to that shown in FIG. 36A.
  • the EC cell was configured so that it could only be colored during the day time by using a CdS photocell sensor to determine whether it is daytime or nighttime. At night, the EC coloring function was disabled. Upon coloring, a coloring potential of 1.2 V from the power supply would be applied to the cell for 3 minutes. Following this initial coloring potential, the specific t 1 and t 2 intermittence functionality (for example, 45 sec turn off and 15 sec turn on of the coloring potential) was also written into the program.
  • a ⁇ 0.3 V would be applied to the cell for 3 minutes.
  • the output pin would be enabled turning on the relay or semiconductor switches to power the EC cell directly from the coloring or bleaching power supplies.
  • the firmware was programmed into the microcontroller using a PicStart Plus Programmer.
  • a thermistor suitably mounted on the EC cell can also be connected to one of the I/O ports in the P1C16F84. The change in resistance of the thermistor is then correlated to temperature of the EC cell. Depending on the temperature measured, the coloring and bleaching potentials, t 1 and t 2 characteristics can then be controlled.
  • Microcontrollers can also be used to control the powering method of the EC cells during coloring and bleaching. This includes specific potential ramps, constant current control, or potential increases and decreases in multiple discrete steps.
  • Various electrochromic devices 3 in ⁇ 3 in, were fabricated using 12 ohms/square ITO as the conductive substrates.
  • the tungsten oxide coating deposition methods and device fabrication processes used in these EC devices were similar to the methods and processes described in copending U.S. patent application Ser. No. 09/155,601 (incorporated by reference herein) which also describes the use of and methods to fabricate Selective Ion Transport Layers (SITL).
  • SITL Selective Ion Transport Layers
  • the EC devices were made both with SITL layers and without SITL layers.
  • the electrolyte consisted of at least one solvent, one dissociable salt and at least one redox promoter. Polymeric viscosity modifiers and UV stabilizers and water were also added.
  • any of the solvents described in copending U.S. patent application Ser. No. 09/155,601 could be used, although carbonates, sulfolanes, glymes, and their mixtures are preferred.
  • suitable carbonates are propylene carbonate, ethylene carbonate, ethyl propyl carbonate, isopropyl ethyl carbonate, diethyl carbonate, methyl propyl carbonate, isopropyl methyl carbonate, ethyl methyl carbonate, dimethyl carbonate, butylene carbonate and other alkyl carbonates.
  • examples of some other suitable solvents are alkyl sulfones, tetraglyme, toluene, xylene, decaline and other aliphatic and aromatic alkyls with or without substituted polar groups.
  • Dissociable salts were typically based on alkali metal cations, such as lithium, sodium, and potassium.
  • alkali metal cations such as lithium, sodium, and potassium.
  • suitable anions are perchlorate, tetrafluoroborate, triflate, etc., as described in copending U.S. patent application Ser. No. 09/155,601, which lists other suitable salts.
  • the redox promoters used in the devices were typically based on ferrocene and its derivatives.
  • Substituted ferrocenes with electron donating groups attached on the cyclopentadiene rings of the ferrocenes are a preferred sub-class in ferrocenes. These groups can be substituted to any of the cyclopentadiene rings. Further, the substituted groups may be the same or different on each of the rings. Such groups include methyl, propyl, n-butyl, tertiary butyl, etc.
  • ferrocenes examples include decamethyl ferrocene, octamethyl ferrocene, tertiary butyl ferrocene, interannual substituted ferrocenes such as 1-1′-(propane-1,3-diyl) ferrocene, 1,1′:3,3′-bis(propane-1,3-diyl) ferrocene, 1,1′:2,2′:4,4′-tri(propane-1,3-diyl) ferrocene.
  • ferrocenes are biferrocenes and bridge ferrocenes, where in the latter, the cyclopentadiene rings of different ferrocene molecules are chemically bonded to each other. Examples of these include 2,2-bis(tert-butylferrocenyl)propane, 2,2-bis(ethyl ferrocenyl)propane, etc. Further, the selection of the ferrocene will also influence the extent of the back reaction with other ingredients, components and device construction details remaining the same.
  • the size of such crystals should typically be smaller than about 0.5 ⁇ m, preferably less than 0.2 ⁇ m so that they do not create haziness in optically clear systems.
  • Some preferred polymers are polymethyl methacrylate, polyvinyl chloride, polyvinyl chloride and polyvinyl acetate copolymers, polyvinyl butyral, polyacrylonitrile and its copolymers, polyvinylidene fluoride, copolymers of polyvinylidene fluoride and hexafluoropropylene. The last two are available from Elf Atochem North American (Philadelphia, Pa.) under the trade names of Kynar and Kynar flex respectively.
  • the electrolyte was processed using a sol-gel technique to form a solid.
  • the solid resulted from the formation of “Si—O—Si” cross-linkages in-situ after filling the EC cell with a electrolyte precursor. This is also described below.
  • the devices were colored by applying 1.2 V.
  • the values of T c1 % and T c2 % were 10% and 15% respectively.
  • the leakage current was measured as the current consumed after applying the coloring potential for 15 minutes.
  • the table also shows that when ferrocene has bulky constituents, such as in the compound 2,2-bis(ethyl ferrocyl)propane, a lower leakage current is obtained. For example, compare the leakage current of device 1 to that of device 2 , and the leakage current of device 5 to that of device 6 .
  • electrolyte A 85% Propylene carbonate, 0.8% 2,2-bis(ethyl ferrocenyl)propane, 0.4% LiClO 4 , 9.4% PMMA, 3.6% UV400, and 0.1% water (all percenntages by weight).
  • Elecrolyte B 85.2% Propylene carboate, 0.7% ferrocene, 0.4% LiClO 4 , 9.5% PMMA, 3.6% UV400 and 0.7% water (all percentages by weight).
  • Electrolyte C 53.6% Propylene Carbonate, 35.7% Sulfolane, 8.4% Poly(methy methacrylate), 1.0% Deionized water, 0.8% Ferrocene, 0.5% Lithium perchlorate (all percentages by weight). TABLE 5 De- Type of Leakage vice Electrolyte SITL SITL Temp. t 2 current # composition Layer layer ° C.
  • Electrolyte C No 25 30 20 210 50 20 20 370 70 15 20 530 2 Electrolyte A No 25 61 6 126 50 31 4 268 70 24 4 392 3 See forma- No 25 a 7 31 29 tion of sol- gel electro- lyte below this table 50 b 5 15 87 70 c 2 12 151 4 Electrolyte B Yes Poly- 25 1079 14.4 6.4 ceram-2 50 431 7.2 31.5 70 184 5.8 90.0 5 Electrolyte B Yes Poly- 25 590 24 10 ceram-1 50 145 8 47 70 64 6 136 6 Electrolyte A Yes Poly- 25 2749 10.2 4.8 ceram-1 50 1272 6 13 70 785 4 26.7 7 Electrolyte C Yes PSSNa 25 3600 25 3.3 70 900 7 14.5
  • Polyceram layer was processed as described in the examples given below. Polyceram layer was made in the same way but the ratio of ingredients was modified. The weight ratio of (CH 3 (OCH 2 CH 2 ) n OCONH(CH 2 ) 3 Si(OC 2 H 5 ) 3 to Si(OCH 3 ) 4 was 1:0.51 in the case of Polyceram-1 but 1:1.02 in the case of Polyceram-2.
  • a cell fabricated as in comparative Example 1 utilizing an ITO electrode and a transparent WO 3 ITO coated glass substrate is then filled with the solution obtained above.
  • the cell thickness in this example was 53 ⁇ m rather than 210 ⁇ m as given in the earlier example.
  • the solution forms a rigid gel (net work) within 10 hours.
  • the gel time can be controlled, e.g., by changing the type and amount of catalyst (e.g., HCl is used above) as known in the art, temperature of cell after filling and using appropriate functionality of the ingredients.
  • Functionalised ferrocenes also could be used which will attached chemically to the electrolyte network.
  • ferrocenes could be used by themselves or in conjunction with non-functionalized ferrocenes (the ones which will not chemically attach to the network). Depending on the cell characteristics if non-ferrocene redox materials are used, the same can be implemented for non-ferrocene redox materials.
  • the cell may also consist of ferrocene and non-ferrocene based redox materials.
  • the power consumption of these devices can be further reduced by incorporating such elements in the circuit that would efficiently step down the voltages from the incoming power supply to the desired coloration or bleaching voltages.
  • a typical car battery has an output of about 12 V, while an EC device might only need 1 to 2 volts for coloration, for example 1.2 V.
  • the EC device needs a current of 10 mA in the colored state at a voltage of 1.2 V, then a power conserving circuit would allow only a 1 mA drainage from the battery at 12 V assuming that the power is converted at 100% efficiency.
  • Typical power supplies for powering EC devices in automotive mirrors use linear regulators or linear regulation for the voltage conversion process. Although widely used for such applications, the power conversion efficiencies of linear regulators are usually very low, typically 10-30%. The conversion efficiency, however, is typically not a major concern. Since the EC mirror is normally operated when the car in turned on, the current or power draw is not a significant drain on the car's alternator and linear regulation can be utilized. Examples of such circuits are described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,148,014, 5,193,029, and 5,220,317, each incorporated herein by reference.
  • the switching regulator can be used for EC devices as taught in the present invention and can offer up to 95% efficiency.
  • the current draw is usually maintained when the voltage is switched from high to low potential.
  • the output current will still be 1 mA, which reflects a power conversion efficiency of only 10%.
  • use of circuits that regulates the power supply voltage by a switching function to control the electrochromic products increases the power conversion efficiency by at least two fold over linearly regulated power supplies.
  • the current draw is usually preferably 2 mA or less at 12 V in order not to drain the battery excessively.
  • the present invention subjects the cell to an intermittent voltage rather than a continuous voltage, thereby enhancing device durability.
  • the switching power supply of the present invention is used to convert the power efficiently to reduce the battery drain.
  • the regulator should preferably have a low or no quiescent current.
  • FIG. 37A An example of a switching regulator circuit used in this invention is shown in FIG. 37A.
  • the circuit is able to regulate even low voltages below about 1.2 V.
  • the switching regulator circuit of this invention has a low or no quiescent current in order not to drain the battery excessively.
  • Switching regulators as used here, have lower current drains than linear regulators.
  • the switching regulator of the present invention preferably should have a quiescent current drain of lower than 100 mA. It is more preferred that the switching regulator of the present invention have a quiescent current drain of lower than 25 mA and most preferably lower than 5 mA. Such low current drains minimize drawdown of the battery in situations where the battery is not being charged such as while the vehicle is parked with ignition off.
  • PWM pulse width modulation
  • a switching regulator e.g. National LM78S40
  • PWM pulse width modulation
  • the series pass transistor is turned on and off at a convenient predetermined frequency (usually in the range of about 25-250 kHz).
  • the output voltage is the average of the rectangular pulses resulting from such switching.
  • Switching regulation results in higher efficiency, such as over 30% and can be as high as about 95%.
  • the quiescent current draw is also very low, typically less than imA thus keeping overall heat dissipation low.
  • Maxim MAX 1627 Maxim Company, Sunnyvale, Calif.
  • the quiescent current draw can be further lowered to 1 ⁇ A.
  • a switching regulator circuit used in this invention can be based on a National LM78S40 switching regulator chip U 1 . It accepts a 12 V pre-regulated input voltage. A peak current of 1.5 A is assumed for this regulator. A sense resistor calculated as 0.33/peak current according to the manufacturer, R 4 detects the peak incoming current. Based on the value of input and output voltage expected, a duty cycle of 23% is obtained. Assuming a switching frequency of 25 kHz, a turn-on time of 33 ⁇ s is calculated. Based on the turn off time, the timing capacitor C 2 of 0.15 ⁇ F is then used to set the switching frequency to 25 kHz.
  • An inductor, L 1 was used to couple the switching pulses while the capacitor C 1 reduces the ripples in the pulses to an average voltage output.
  • the combination of peak current and turn-on time results in an inductance of 50 ⁇ H.
  • Voltage ripple of 1% is tolerated resulting in the capacitor C 1 of about 1mF.
  • the chip contains a built-in PWM module, Darlington series pass transistor and reference voltage. Trimmer resistor, R 5 , in conjunction with series resistor R 3 , then sets the output voltage.
  • the built-in reference voltage is set at 1.3 V which is the lower limit for the regulated voltage. In the circuit the reference voltage is reduced by using a voltage divider via series resistors, R 1 and R 2 of 1 M ⁇ each to further lower the minimum voltage regulated to 0.65 V.
  • an NTC thermistor can also be used in place of trimmer resistor R 5 .
  • the resistance decreases, leading to lower coloring and bleaching voltages while at lower temperatures, the resistance is higher resulting in higher voltages.
  • Switching regulator radiates EMI due to the switching transistor.
  • Adequate shielding e.g. Faradaic shield, must be provided to mitigate such EMI to reduce electromagnetic interference with other subsystems including communications such as a cellular phone.
  • the shielding aspect could be useful for powering of EC components in a car or any other transportation vehicle. It is also novel to use switching and linear regulator with the former working when the car is in a parked state while the latter being used while the car is parked (ignition off), the degree of interference to other electronic systems is lower.
  • a switching regulator used in this invention employing a MAXIM Max 1627 yielding very low quiescent current of 0.001 mA is shown in FIG. 37C.
  • the switching efficiency is a high as 85% at 1 A current draw. Without modification using the manufacturers' specification, this chip outputs voltage at a lower limit of 1.27 V.
  • the circuit is modified, to allow output voltages lower than 1.27 V, by having feedback resistors R 2 and R 1 connected through a high speed comparator MAXIM Max 987.
  • the p-MOSFET used in the circuit was International Rectifier (El Segundo, Calif.) IRF7416.
  • the voltage applied to the EC cell may consist of a non-linear ramp.
  • the ramp only refers to the time period when the voltage is changing before the voltage settles at the hold potential (e.g., V c is holding potential in FIG. 38B).
  • Such non-linearity can be obtained, e.g., by having some amount of internal resistance in the power supply. This internal resistance can be intentionally designed into the power supply itself or by inserting an external resistor between the voltage terminal and the EC cell. This is shown in FIG. 38A where resistor R 7 is placed in series with the power supply output and EC cell.
  • FIG. 38C describes the various shapes that the voltage vs. time curves can follow depending on the circuit parameters.
  • the applied voltage is across the EC cell and the resistor.
  • a switching regulator circuit was constructed similar to the one described previously except that a thermistor was located in place of fixed resistor R 5 -see FIG. 37B.
  • An example of the thermistor used is KE D331BZ from Thermometrics (Edison, N.J.). It exhibits resistance values of 4000 ⁇ and 60 ⁇ at ⁇ 25° C. and 65° C. respectively.
  • the voltage was automatically tuned to 1.3 V and 1 V at ⁇ 25° C. and 65° C. respectively.

Abstract

Edge busbars on a substantial perimeter of an electrochromic device are disclosed having electrical paths wrapping over the perimeter edge. Internal busbars interior from the perimeter are disclosed which lower the conductivity of the conductive layer of an electrochromic device. Signals supplied to the busbars to control the electrochromic device are controlled by a switching power supply that allows the maintaining of the color of the electrochromic device without application of continuous power.

Description

  • This application claims the benefit of U.S. Provisional Patent Application No. 60/091,678, filed Jul. 2, 1998.[0001]
  • BACKGROUND OF THE INVENTION
  • 1. Field of the Invention [0002]
  • This invention relates to busbars utilized in electrically powered cells. In particular, this invention relates to edge and internal busbars utilized in electrochromic devices. This invention also relates to edge and internal busbars that can be utilized in other electrically powered cells such as electroluminescent and photochromic devices, thin-film batteries, and other cells that use geometries similar to the electrochromic devices described herein. Further, this invention relates to control circuits and methods to control the coloration of such electrochromic devices through an intermittent application of power. [0003]
  • Electrochromic (EC) devices are devices in which a change in an electrical signal applied to the EC device results in a change in an optical property of the EC device. Typically, the optical property is optical transmittance, although other properties can be affected such as, for example, optical spectral distribution or polarization. Electrochromic devices can be used for many applications, such as rear view automotive mirrors, windows, sunroofs, shades or visors for automotive and mass transportation applications, architectural windows, skylights, displays, light filters and screens for light pipes, displays, and other electro-optical devices. [0004]
  • A variety of technologies exist for producing chromogenic members. “Chromogenic devices”, as used herein, is employed as commonly known in the art. Examples of these chromogenic devices include electrochromic devices, photochromic devices, liquid crystal devices, user-controllable-photochromic devices, polymer-dispersed-liquid-crystal devices, and suspended particle devices. [0005]
  • For example, electrochromic devices are discussed by N. R. Lynam and A. Agrawal in “Automotive Applications of Chromogenic Materials”, [0006] Large Area Chromogenics: Materials & Devices for Transmittance Control, Optical Engineering Press, Bellingham, Wash. (1989), incorporated herein by reference. Other pertinent references include N. R. Lynam, “Electrochromic Automotive Day/Night Mirrors”, SAE Technical Paper Series, 87036 (1987); N. R. Lynam, “Smart Windows for Automobiles”, SAE Technical Paper Series, 900419 (1990); C. M. Lampert, “Electrochromic Devices and Devices for Energy Efficient Windows”, Solar Energy Materials, 11, 1-27 (1984); JP 58-20729; and U.S. Pat. Nos. 3,521,941, 3,807,832, 4,174,152, 4,338,000, 4,652,090, 4,671,619, 4,702,566, 4,712,879, 4,793,690, 4,799,768, Re. 30,835, 5,066,112, 5,073,012, 5,076,674, 5,122,647, 5,142,407, 5,148,014, 5,239,406, and 5,657,149 each incorporated herein by reference.
  • Electrochromic panels are also discussed by Sapers, S. P., et al. in “Monolithic Solid-State Electrochromic Coatings for Window Applications”, Proceedings of the Society of Vacuum Coaters Conference (1996), incorporated herein by reference, with regard to devices of the type shown in FIG. 1E. Devices comparable to that shown in FIG. 1E, and having photovoltaic layers for self-biasing operation are also described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,377,037. [0007]
  • Other related references of interest include U.S. Patent No. 5,241,411, U.K. Patent No. 2,268,595, Japanese Laid-Open Patent No. Appln. No. 63-106730, Japanese Laid-Open Patent No. Appln. No. 63-106731, and U.S. Pat. No. 5,472,643, each incorporated herein by reference. Also pertinent is International Application No. PCT/US 97/05791, incorporated herein by reference, which pertains to electrochromic devices that can vary the transmission or reflection of electromagnetic radiation by applying an electrical stimulus to an EC device. International Application No. PCT/US 97/05791 uses a selective ion transport layer in combination with an electrolyte having at least one redox active material to provide a high-performance device. [0008]
  • Also suitable for use in this invention are liquid crystal devices such as those described by N. Basturk and J. Grupp in “Liquid Crystal Guest-Host Devices and Their Use as Light Shutters”, [0009] Large Area Chromogenics: Materials & Devices for Transmittance Control, Optical Engineering Press, Bellingham, Wash. (1989), incorporated herein by reference.
  • User-controllable-photochromic devices (UCPC) are discussed in U.S. Pat. No. 5,604,626, entitled “Novel Photochromic Devices”, incorporated herein by reference. [0010]
  • Polymer-dispersed-liquid-crystal (PDLC) devices are described by N. R. Lynam and A. Agrawal, “Automotive Applications of Chromogenic Materials”, [0011] Large Area Chromogenics: Materials & Devices for Transmittance Control, Optical Engineering Press, Bellingham, Wash. (1989), incorporated herein by reference.
  • Suspended particle devices are discussed in U.S. Pat. No. 4,164,365, incorporated herein by reference. [0012]
  • Examples of chromogenic devices that emit light are described in Applied Physics Letters, Vol. 71, page 1293 (1997). [0013]
  • Examples of chromogenic devices that can store image patterns due to a change in an optical property of a material are described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,744,267, incorporated herein by reference. [0014]
  • The general control of chromogenic devices is discussed in U.S. Pat. Nos. 4,793,690, 4,799,768, 5,007,718, and 5,424,898, incorporated herein by reference. [0015]
  • The phenomenon of prolonged coloration of chromogenic devices is discussed in U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,076,673 and 5,220,317, each incorporated herein by reference. [0016]
  • FIGS. 1A through 1E depict typical examples of known electrochromic devices, while FIG. 1F shows another known type of chromogenic device. [0017]
  • For example, FIG. 1A depicts a layered EC device which includes a [0018] substrate 101, transparent conductor 103, electrochromic (redox) medium 105, transparent conductor 103′ and substrate 101′.
  • FIG. 1B illustrates a layered EC device which includes a [0019] substrate 101, transparent conductor 103, EC layer 107, electrolyte (redox medium) 109, transparent conductor 103′ and substrate 101′.
  • FIG. 1C shows another layered EC device having a [0020] substrate 101, transparent conductor 103, EC layer 107, ion-selective transport layer 111, electrolyte (redox medium) 109, transparent conductor 103′ and substrate
  • Still another such EC device is shown in FIG. 1D. This device includes a [0021] substrate 101, transparent conductor 103, EC layer 107, electrolyte 113, counterelectrode 115, transparent conductor 103′ and substrate 101′.
  • FIG. 1E shows an EC device having a [0022] substrate 101, transparent conductor 103, EC layer 107, electrolyte (ion-conductive layer) 117, counterelectrode 115 and transparent conductor 103′.
  • A typical liquid crystal or PDLC device is shown in FIG. 1F. This device includes a [0023] substrate 201, transparent conductor 203, liquid crystal or PDLC medium 205, transparent conductor 203′ and substrate 201′.
  • Since the above chromogenic devices are known to those skilled in the art, a detailed explanation of the manner of construction and operation of such devices is not necessary. [0024]
  • In general, it is important to distribute the voltage to an electrochromic (EC) device uniformly in order to (i) maintain the uniformity of the coloration and bleaching of the EC device during changes between such states of coloration and bleaching, (ii) to improve uniformity in such colored and bleached states, and finally (iii) to enhance the kinetics of coloration and bleaching. As the size of an EC device increases, it becomes increasingly more difficult to maintain the desirable voltage distribution uniformity because increased size typically leads to increased resistance of various components. Such increased resistance results in voltage drops and current losses that adversely affects the uniformity of voltage distribution. [0025]
  • In other electrical devices, a particular spatial voltage distribution profile often is desired. As the size of such devices increases, similar to the example of EC devices, it also becomes increasingly more difficult to maintain the desired spatial voltage distribution profile because of the increasing electrical resistance of various components. [0026]
  • An applied voltage is commonly distributed at the periphery of EC devices through the use of an edge busbar which distributes an applied voltage to a surface conductor electrode. The applied voltage causes a response in a particular responsive property of an EC device. Consequently, spatial or temporal differences in the applied voltage will cause spatial or temporal differences in the responsive property. Ohmic losses along an edge busbar can therefore critically affect the even distribution of voltage, leading to undesirable non-uniformities in the coloration and bleaching of an EC device. [0027]
  • Furthermore, EC devices often employ thin film transparent conductors such as indium tin oxide (ITO) and doped tin oxides (DTO) for the surface conductor electrode. Such thin film transparent conductors are also used in a wide range of applications in other areas such as displays, solar cells, and liquid crystal devices. If the magnitude of the electrical currents in such devices is large, there can be a considerable electrical potential drop across the transparent conductor. Similar to the effect of voltage variations along an edge busbar, variations of voltage in thin film transparent conductors can also lead to spatial inhomogeneities in the device behavior as well as to slower overall device kinetics. Such effects become increasingly noticeable and problematic with increasing device area. [0028]
  • Another related aspect of electrochromic devices is that they are current consuming devices. Accordingly, it is advantageous for the transparent conductors, i.e., the surface electrodes, to be very conductive. For applications such as large area EC panels, where current consumption is large, it is particularly important that the transparent conductors possess high effective conductivities. Present conventional large-area EC devices fabricated from commercially available transparent conductors such as, for example, ITO and DTO, generally possess slow kinetics and often display nonuniform coloring. For example, large-area EC devices presently are often darker at the edges than in the center. [0029]
  • EC devices can be fabricated on one substrate as described in U.S. Pat. No. 4,712,879; J. Gordon H. Matthew et. al., [0030] Proc. of 3d Svmposium on Electrochromic Materials, The Electrochemical Society, Proc. Volume 96-24, Pennington, N.J., 1997, p. 311; and Badding, M. E., et al., Proc. of 3d Symposium on Electrochromic Materials, The Electrochemical Society, Proc. Volume 96-24, Pennington, N.J., 1997, p. 369, each incorporated herein by reference.
  • Electrochromic devices can also be made using two substrates as described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 4,761,061, 4,768,865, 4,902,108, 5,142,407, 5,231,531, 5,472,643, and U.S. patent application Ser. No. 09/155,601, filed Aug. 9, 1997, each incorporated herein by reference. [0031]
  • Prior art EC devices are also described in Lynam N. R., Agrawal, A., [0032] Automotive Applications of Chromogenic materials, in Large-Area Chromogenics: Materials and Devices for Transmittance Control, SPIE Optical Engineering Press, Bellingham, Wash., 1990, p. 46 and Lampert C. L., Selkowitz, S. E., Large-Area Chromogenics: Materials and Devices for Transmittance Control, SPIE Optical Engineering Press, Bellingham, Wash., 1990, p. 22, each incorporated herein by reference.
  • U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,202,787 and 5,151,824, each incorporated herein by reference, show the way busbars in an EC device are typically put on the substrate edges in the prior art. As shown in FIGS. 2, 3A, and [0033] 3B, taken from the referenced patents, in a commercial EC automotive mirror which features two substrates 2223 and 2224, or 3333 and 3334, the substrates are staggered slightly with respect to each other. Spring clips 2221 and 2222, or 3331 and 3332, of a conductive material such as a copper sheet or a beryllium copper coated with tin are clipped to the two staggered edges of substrates 2223 and 2224, or 3333 and 3334, in order to provide an electrical connection to substrates 2223 and 2224, or 3333 and 3334. The two substrates must be offset, or staggered, from each other in order to expose surfaces 2225 and 3335 for the attachment of clips 2221 and 2222, or 3331 and 3332. The surfaces 2225 and 3335 are minimized in order to maximize the optical throughput area of the device—that is, to maximize the overlapping area of the two substrates. Accordingly, the prior art provides electrical connections at less than one half of the perimeter of each substrate.
  • When a potential is applied to the [0034] wire clips 2221 and 2222, or 3331 and 3332, only a small potential drop occurs in these clips because of their high conductivity. The small potential drop can be neglected for small dimensions. However, as the dimensions of the application increases, the potential drop can become significant. Such potential drops can be a problem because the potential drop comes at a cost to the potential available to the chromogenic elements themselves. Further, significant current flow can occur at the clips and clip junctions, thereby adversely adding to the overall current load.
  • The resistance of a typical wire clip used in commercial automotive mirrors that are about 12 inches (30 cm) in length is about 0.29. The conductivity associated with the clip depends on the intrinsic conductivity of the material, the geometric parameters of the clip (such as thickness, width and the length of the strip), and on the relevant contact resistance. [0035]
  • To demonstrate the current consumption in the EC devices, a commercial EC automotive mirror was colored by applying a DC step voltage of 1.4 V. The mirror initially consumed a current of 3 mA/cm[0036] 2, decreasing to 0.9 mA/cm2 in the fully colored state.
  • According to Hichwa, B.P1, “Large Area Electrochromics for Architectural Applications”, [0037] International Conference on Coatings on Glass, Saarbrucken, Germany, October 1996, an EC window device made from all thin films on a single substrate when powered at 1.8 V showed an initial current consumption of about 2 mA/cm2 which decreased to about 1 μA/cm2 in the colored steady-state. By assuming that such devices can be fabricated with the above current values scaling with size while keeping similar performance characteristics, the current consumption can be calculated for an EC automotive mirror and a single substrate EC window at different dimensions.
  • Table 1 shows the current consumption of the devices with two different active areas: (1) 6 inches by 6 inches (15 cm×15 cm) and (2) 12 inches by 12 inches (30 cm×30 cm). [0038]
    TABLE 1
    Colored (steady
    Device Initial current state) current
    type/Size consumption consumption
    Auto Mirror, 0.7 A 0.2 A
    6 inch (15 cm)
    Thin film 0.5 A 0.2 mA
    window, 6 inch
    (15 cm)
    Auto Mirror, 2.8 A 0.8 A
    12 inch (30 cm)
    Thin film 1.9 A 0.9 mA
    window, 12 inch
    (30 cm)
  • Therefore, as the size of the EC device increases, the current loads that the electrodes must carry are substantially increased. [0039]
  • Table 2 shows the resistance characteristics of several materials and the resistance associated with a tape with a dimension of 1 meter in length, 2 mm in width and 0.1 mm in thickness. Table 2 also shows the resistance drop in these tapes when they carry 0.1, 1 and 10 A of current. [0040]
    TABLE 2
    Data for one m long tape with a
    width of 2 mm and a thickness of
    Resist- 0.1 mm
    ivity Resis- Voltage Voltage Voltage
    at 25° C. tance drop at drop at Drop at
    Material (10−8Ωm) (Ω) 0.1A (v) 1A (v) 10A (v)
    Aluminum 2.71 0.1355 0.01355 0.1355 1.355
    Copper 1.71 0.0855 0.00855 0.0855 0.855
    Gold 2.21 0.1105 0.01105 0.1105 1.105
    Silver 1.62 0.081 0.0081 0.081 0.81
    Tungsten 5.39 0.2695 0.02695 0.2695 2.695
    ITO 200 10 1 10 100
    Stainless 72 3.6 0.36 3.6 36
    steel
    type 304
    Tin 11.5 0.575 0.0575 0.575 5.75
    Copper/
    beryllium
    (98/2)
    Indium 8 0.4 0.04 0.4 4
    Nickel 7.12 0.356 0.0356 0.356 3.56
    Rhodium 4.3 0.215 0.0215 0.215 2.15
    Nichrome 150 7.5 0.75 7.5 75
    Solder 16 0.8 0.08 0.8 8
    (Pb/Sn,
    67/33)
    Solder 25 1.25 0.125 1.25 12.5
    (Sn/Ag,
    95/5)
    Conduct- 300 15 1.5 15 150
    ive epoxy
    Ablebond ®
    8380
    Silver 7 0.35 0.035 0.35 3.5
    Frit
    (DuPont,
    1991)
  • As seen in Table 2, several materials incur serious voltage drops across their resistance runs (for a specific geometry) for the amount of current that must be provided to the EC cell. Since EC devices are typically powered at 1 to 3 volts, the voltage drop can significantly affect the actual voltage applied to the EC material, causing increases in coloration and bleach times, and in certain devices, leading to nonuniform coloration in the steady state condition. The problem of the voltage drop, resulting from the electrode resistance, is compounded by the increase in current when the size of the device gets larger as seen previously in Table 1. This invention is particularly useful for those EC devices where the current consumption exceeds 0.1 A during either coloring or bleaching processes. [0041]
  • When chromogenic devices are fabricated using two coated substrates, the typical gap between the substrates is in the range of from 10 to 1000 micrometers. As the size of the devices increases, such as for a six inch by six inch (15 cm×15 cm) device, in order to increase the charge throughput and to distribute the charge uniformly, it is important that busbars be applied to as much of the device perimeter as possible. [0042]
  • One prior art approach for a rectangular device as shown in FIG. 4, is to offset [0043] substrates 3301 and 3302 simultaneously around two edges of a corner to provide two exposed L-shaped surfaces 3304. Then, busbars 3303 are attached in a conventional way.
  • In another prior art approach, [0044] busbars 5503 are applied on opposite edges of exposed surface pairs 5504 by employing the geometry as shown in FIG. 5 where the rectangular substrates 5501 and 5502 are pivoted from each other so that the long dimension of each rectangular substrate is parallel to the short dimension of the other rectangular substrate.
  • Neither approach provides busbar coverage of a substantial perimeter of a substrate. As used herein, “substantial perimeter” means more than half of the perimeter of a substrate which is covered by a continuous busbar. For larger devices such as those bigger than about 6 inches (15 cm) in width and length, it is especially desirable to put the busbars all around the device, in a manner which covers a substantial perimeter of each substrate in order to provide the applied signal to the entire chromogenic panel evenly. [0045]
  • Nevertheless, as described above, as the length of the busbar run increases, the resistance undesirably increases. As a result, the prior art increases the thickness of the busbar material for large devices in order to increase the conductivity/unit length of the busbar in an attempt to maintain the desirably low resistance of the busbar. However, a major problem with the use of conventional busbars such as spring clips and wires for such large chromogenic applications arises when the thickness of the busbar exceeds the typical cell gaps. Even when the thickness of the busbar does not exceed the cell gap, the geometries of the prior art busbars and their placement limit the allowable increases to conductivities. Further, there may also be a problem around substrate corners when one continuous strip of the prior art busbar clip is used. [0046]
  • Another method with substantial coverage is provided all around the periphery, by using thin conductors, as shown in U.S. Pat. No. 5,066,112. However, in this case, the conductor thickness is limited by the gap between the substrates and its width. [0047]
  • Another approach is to make the two substrates dissimilar in size so that the edges of one substrate extend from all around the perimeter of the other substrate. In this configuration, conventional wire clip busbars can be used on the larger substrate. However, it is difficult to attach conventional wire clip busbars to the smaller substrate due to the limited gap available between the two substrates. The very close geometry could cause electrical shorting of the two substrates at the conventional wire clip busbar of the smaller substrate. [0048]
  • As noted above, in addition to the problem of voltage drops from the edge busbar clips, if the magnitude of the electrical currents in EC devices is large, there can be a considerable electrical potential drop across the thin film transparent conductor, leading to detrimentally slower overall device kinetics and spatial inhomogeneities in the EC device behavior. Therefore, for applications where current consumption is large, and especially where the area of the EC devices is large (e.g., chromogenic panels), it is particularly important that the transparent conductors possess large effective conductivities. Large-area EC devices fabricated from commercially available transparent conductors such as, for example, indium tin oxide (ITO) and doped tin oxide (DTO) generally possess slow kinetics and often display nonuniform coloring (e.g., darker at the edges to which the busbars are connected than in the center). [0049]
  • Values for the sheet resistance of commercially available transparent conductors such as ITO and DTO are typically greater than about 5 Ω/sq (the units are also commonly written as Ω/▪) to about 15 Ω/sq. Lower sheet resistances may be obtained by increasing the thickness of the transparent conductor, but this adversely affects the optical properties (e.g., increased haziness and/or diminished transmissivity) and also adds appreciably to the cost. It is desirable to form substrates which possess appreciably lower effective sheet resistance (can be less than 1 Ω/sq) at a cost that is attractive for applications such as those described above. [0050]
  • U.S. Pat. No. 5,293,546, incorporated herein by reference, describes a method for making a display device in which one of the electrodes is preferably a metallic grid. Preferred line widths were 20 micrometers with line spacings of 500 micrometers and line heights of 0.2 to 3 micrometers. The grid is then coated by a metal oxide (e.g., 1000 Å of ITO). The invention relates to displays in which high resolution processing equipment must be used for depositing the grid pattern. Thus the cost is high, particularly if large substrates such as 6 inch−6 inch (15 cm×15 cm) or bigger are required because maintaining high precision in such a fine grid pattern over increasing areas is costly. Further, since these substrates must be over-coated with ITO, they are unable to use more cost effective, mass produced transparent conductors, such as mass produced ITO or inexpensive DTO deposited onto glass sheets in a float line. [0051]
  • U.S. Pat. No. 4,768,865, incorporated herein by reference, describes the use of a free-standing metallic grid as one of the transparent conductors. In this invention, the metal grid participates directly in the electrochemical reaction in the EC cell. However, for most EC devices, it is not desirable for the electron conductor also to participate in the reaction. [0052]
  • U.S. Pat. No. 5,724,176, incorporated herein by reference, describes the use of a counterelectrode for a smart window that contains a transparent substrate and a linear electrically conductive material formed on a surface of the transparent substrate. A layer of an electrochromic material is formed on the window's surface, and a layer of an electrolyte is arranged between the counterelectrode and the electrochromic electrode and in contact with the layer of the electrochromic material. Various patterns are described for the placement of the linear electrically conductive material. [0053]
  • U.S. Pat. No. 5,066,111, incorporated herein by reference, describes laminated EC devices. A metal grid on a glass substrate is employed as one electrode and a longitudinal set of busbars, preferably composed of a metal foil such as copper, or an electroconductive ceramic frit deposited on glass or on the surface of an electro-conductive film, is employed as the other electrode. The electrochromic film is deposited over the second electrode. Thus, the metal foil or frit conductors of the U.S. Pat. No. 5,066,111 invention are always in direct contact with either the electrochromic coating or the electrolyte. However, such direct contact can decrease the device lifetime because of reaction between the coating and the electrolyte or electrochromic coating. Moreover, if put on glass and then coated with the transparent conductive coating (TCC), other problems can arise. Most importantly, the TCC is usually deposited in a thickness of less than 0.3 micrometers. In comparison, tapes or underlying frits, etc., are typically in thicknesses of 10 to 1000 times the thickness of TCC. Thus, vacuum methods that are typically used to coat TCC have difficulty getting a conforming coating that adequately covers the edges. The reference does not address the relationship of the busbar thickness and width to the device size. [0054]
  • POLYCHROMIC™ solid films are described in European Patent Publication No. [0055] EP 0 612 826 A1, incorporated herein by reference. The reference describes how polychromic solid films may be used in electrochromic devices, particularly glazings and mirrors, whose functional surface is substantially planar or flat or that are curved with a convex curvature, a compound curvature, a multi-radius curvature, a spherical curvature, an aspheric curvature, or combinations of such curvature.
  • Often, a demarcation means, such as a silk-screened or otherwise applied line of black epoxy, may be used to separate the more curved, outboard blind-spot region from the less curved, inboard region of such electrochromic mirrors. The demarcation means may also include an etching of a deletion line or an otherwise established break in the electrical continuity of the transparent conductors used in such mirrors so that either one or both regions may be individually or mutually addressed. Optionally, this deletion line may itself be colored black. Thus, the outboard, more curved region may operate independently from the inboard, less curved region to provide an electrochromic mirror that operates in a segmented arrangement. As described in European Patent Publication No. [0056] EP 0 612 826 A1, upon the introduction of an applied potential, either of such regions may color to a dimmed intermediate reflectance level, independent of the other region, or, if desired, both regions may operate together in tandem.
  • An insulating demarcation means, such as demarcation lines, dots and/or spots, may be placed within electrochromic devices, such as mirrors, glazings, optically attenuating contrast filters and the like, to assist in setting out the interpane distance of the device and to enhance overall performance, in particular the uniformity of coloration across large area devices. Such insulating demarcation means, constructed from, for example, epoxy coupled with glass space beads, plastic tape or die cut from plastic tape, may be placed onto the conductive surface of one or more substrates by silk-screening or other suitable technique prior to assembling the device. The insulating demarcation means may be geometrically positioned across the panel, such as in a series of parallel, uniformly spaced-apart lines, and may be clear, opaque, tinted, or colorless, and appropriate combinations thereof, so as to appeal to the automotive stylist. [0057]
  • As described in European Patent Publication No. [0058] EP 0 612 826 A1, a demarcation means may be used that is conductive as well, provided that it is of a smaller thickness than the interpane distance and/or a layer of an insulating material, such as a non-conductive epoxy, urethane or acrylic, is applied thereover so as to prevent conductive surfaces from contacting one another and thus short-circuiting the electrochromic assembly. Such conductive demarcation means include conductive frits, such as silver frits like the #7713 silver conductive frit available commercially from E.I. du Pont de Nemours and Co., Wilmington, Del., conductive paint or ink and/or metal films. Use of conductive demarcation means, such as a line of the #7713 silver conductive frit, having a width of about 0.09375″ (0.238 cm) and a thickness of about 50 μm, placed on the conductive surface of one of the substrates of the electrochromic device may provide the added benefit of enhancing electrochromic performance by reducing busbar-to-busbar overall resistance and thus enhancing uniformity of coloration, as well as rapidity of response, particularly over large area devices. However, the non-conductive layers are applied in a way which does not prevent the underlying frit lines from making contact with the electrolyte or electrochromic layers. Thus, this frit may potentially react, especially when coloring and bleaching potentials are applied.
  • As described above, electrochromic (EC) devices are used to reversibly vary the light transmission or reflection by application of an electrical voltage. Applications of electrochromic devices include windows for architectural use (windows, interior partitions, skylights, light pipes), windows in transportation (automobiles, trucks, planes, trains, boats, etc.), eye-wear, and displays (including large area signage). [0059]
  • Electrochromic windows in buildings can provide higher energy efficiency as compared to static transmission windows, while increasing the user comfort by controlling illumination and reducing glare. The same benefits can accrue for transportation uses where the user comfort is enhanced by reducing solar heat and glare during the day, while reducing the cooling load on the air-conditioner. In many of these applications the EC device can be required to be kept in a certain desired state of transmission for long periods of time. For example, a window may be kept in a darkened or bleached state for many hours of the day and may even be kept in this state for many days. [0060]
  • Thus, it is desirable to enhance the durability of EC devices that are used in this long single state mode, while reducing energy consumption of the EC devices. Reducing energy consumption is particularly useful in circumstances where solely a battery is used to power such a device and thus, it is important to ensure that the battery drain is minimized. Such circumstances include use in a car, aircraft, watercraft, or eyeware. One aspect of the present patent describes circuitry which addresses one or more of these issues. [0061]
  • U.S. Pat. No. 5,148,014, incorporated herein by reference, describes the use of a linear regulated power supply to power an EC mirror. [0062]
  • U.S. Pat. No. 5,193,029, incorporated herein by reference, describes the use of a Zener diode and transistor, which is essentially a linear regulation, to provide voltage to an EC mirror. [0063]
  • U.S. Pat. No. 5,220,317, incorporated herein by reference, describes the use of a voltage divider consisting of series resistors to scale down the voltage provided to EC elements. [0064]
  • Electrochromic devices which will benefit from this invention are well known in the art. For example, these are described in U.S. patent application Nos. 09/155,601 and 08/699,940, filed Apr. 9, 1997 and Aug. 20, 1996, respectively. [0065]
  • For those EC devices which are colored by applying a voltage, it would be desirable not to require applying continuously the coloring potential after the required coloration depth has been reached. Such continued application of the coloring potential, while promoting EC reactions, can also promote side reactions which could have detrimental effect on the device longevity. This applies for all EC devices which need to be maintained in a state of coloration that is different from their natural transmission state. The natural transmission state of an EC device is measured at equilibrium with no applied potential and when the potential difference between the opposing electrodes is zero. [0066]
  • Typically, the EC devices can be kept colored for a finite period of time when the coloring potential is removed, i.e., the color of the device will change towards its natural state over a period of time. This change could occur over a wide range of time intervals, from fast over several seconds or minutes, to as slow as extending up to many days, depending on the device. A device where this change is fast is said to have short “memory” and one where the change is slow is said to possess long “memory”. For example, U.S. patent application No. 09/155,601 discloses devices with long memories and compares them with devices that have short memories. [0067]
  • It is clear that is would be advantageous to be able to maintain a coloration setting without having to maintain an applied voltage to electrochromic devices because circuitry that allows intermittent adjustment of the voltage as needed to maintain a coloration setting would lead to lower Dower consumption in the device. [0068]
  • U.S. Pat. No. 5,384,578 (to Lynam et.al.), incorporated herein by reference, describes the use of intermittent voltages for continuously variable mirror and windows, but does not relate to changing the voltage-on or voltage-off periods and voltage-time shapes under different conditions as discussed in the present invention. [0069]
  • U.S. Pat. No. 4,298,970 (to Saegusa), incorporated herein by reference, describes a technique for utilizing an intermittent technique to drive EC displays with memory. The patent only describes bimodal displays which have only two states, i.e., colored and bleached states and does not discuss devices which need continuously variable light transmission across a continuum of transmissive states. [0070]
  • U.S. Pat. No. 5,007,718, incorporated herein by reference, describes a method of driving electrochromic elements by using a current stabilizing circuit and a voltage stabilizing circuit in tandem with a power supply to form a stabilized power source, and applying a gradually increased coloring voltage and a gradually decreased discoloring voltage to keep the current flow within predetermined amounts. [0071]
  • U.S. Pat. No. 5,365,365, incorporated herein by reference, describes an electrochromic system for controlling the color state by determining the charge needed to obtain a set color from the discharge potential of the system and the coloration set-point. An integrator measures the charge passing through the system and compares it to the charge to be transferred, which is measured by a differential amplifier which compares a discharge potential measured by a capacitor with a selected color set-point. [0072]
  • U.S. Pat. No. 5,231,531, incorporated herein by reference, describes an electrochromic system in which a voltage generator is connected to electrically conductive films by an electrical control circuit. The voltage generator receives a set-point from a control unit and generates a potential differences as a function of the temperature of the electrolyte. [0073]
  • SUMMARY OF THE INVENTION
  • This invention is related to edge and internal busbars that lower the overall effective resistance of electrical devices, particularly EC devices, thereby enabling large devices to maintain desirable electrical properties. The present invention describes the benefits of applying the busbars of the present invention to a substantial perimeter of an EC device, as well as the materials and processes to accomplish this. [0074]
  • As shown later, the contact points with the conductive coatings constituting the EC devices may be less than half of the perimeter, but the busbar of the present invention runs continuously for more than half of the device perimeter. The term “busbar” refers to a conducting medium that provides a substantially uniform voltage to all those points on the device perimeter that are connected to the busbar. The busbar should be capable of carrying substantial current with a voltage drop of preferably less than {fraction (1/10)}th of the applied voltage, or a voltage drop less than that which causes a perceptible change in the kinetics of the device (rate of coloration and bleach) or in the depth of coloration. [0075]
  • The voltage drop should be less than that voltage drop which would cause a perceptible change in the kinetics or coloration properties of the device. Thus, for some particular devices, higher voltage drops can be accommodated so long as such perceptible changes do not occur. Generally, however, such voltage drops are less than {fraction (1/10)}th of the applied voltage. [0076]
  • The conductance of the edge busbar conductor is dependent on the cross-section, length and the intrinsic conductivity of the busbar material. Since the gap between the two substrates for a EC cell is limited, the thickness of the busbar conductors must be within the limitations imposed by the cell's size. To maximize the EC device viewing area, the width of the conductor in the prior art is limited as shown in FIGS. 4 and 5, where the width is limited to the exposed [0077] areas 3304 and 5504. Typically, this width is less than 25 mm, preferably less than 10 mm, in order to maximize effective cell area. At times, this width can be on the order of less than 2 mm. Further, for a device made by substrates that are exactly stacked on one another and separated by a gap of 100 micrometers, the thickness of the conductor on each substrate located between the two substrates is typically limited to less than 50 micrometers.
  • The present invention teaches the use of materials and processes to deposit busbars on a substantial portion of the device perimeter while overcoming the geometric constraints described above. A copper conductor which is 35 micrometers thick and 3 mm wide exhibits a resistance drop of 0.16Ω per meter. Accordingly, for a device that is one meter square, a continuous conductor around the device periphery will exhibit a drop of 0.32Ω from one diagonal edge to the other. For a device that will carry a current as low as even one ampere, the drop of 0.32 V at an applied potential of about 1.5 V is significant. This can result in non-uniform coloration, slow kinetics, etc. In such devices, it is preferable to maintain the potential drop below {fraction (1/10)}th of the applied voltage or below any voltage that will cause a perceptible change in the color uniformity of the device or a decrease in the kinetics. [0078]
  • Since the current consumption of an EC device changes with time, particularly when step potentials are used, it is preferable that the potential drop in the busbar is kept within the limits described above during both the switching period and also when the steady state is reached. If other materials from Table 2 are used instead of copper, except for silver, the resistance drop will be even higher for the same busbar dimensions. Thus the geometry of the busbar (such as thickness and width) of the tape will have to be increased for best performance. [0079]
  • An object of the present invention is to overcome the prior art constraints on edge busbar effective resistance arising from the geometrical limitations of busbar length, width, and thickness. The present invention uses specific geometry, materials and processes to form the edge busbars. [0080]
  • This invention overcomes these geometrical limitations by forming a conductive path from the electrode on a front side of a substrate to the edges of the substrate and then extending this conductive path on to the back of the substrate. On the edge of the device, on the back, or on both the edge and the back, highly conductive paths such as reinforcing conductors may be employed to lower the busbar resistance. The conductive path from the front of the substrates to the back could be the continuation of the same material which is used for the transparent conductor, such as indium tin oxide, or can be fabricated from a different material, so long as dimension and conductivity requirements are met. That is, the conductivity must be effective to prevent a potential drop of 10% or a potential drop that would detrimentally affect the performance of the EC panel, while the dimensions must be effective to allow the substrates to maintain a close proximity to each other. Once the conductive path is formed on the back of the substrates, the geometrical limitations on the thickness and the width of the busbar conductor are relieved substantially. [0081]
  • Accordingly, the present invention provides an edge busbar for an electrical device, wherein the edge busbar comprises at least one electrically conductive connector portion effective to form an electrically conductive path from a surface of the electrical device, wrapping around a portion of an edge, to an opposite surface of the electrical device, and an electrically conductive perimeter portion in electrical contact with the connector portion, wherein the perimeter portion is peripherally on a substantial perimeter of the electrical device. [0082]
  • The connector portion of the edge busbar of the present invention can be continuous peripherally on a substantial perimeter of the electrical device, can be continuous peripherally on an entire perimeter of the electrical device, or can be composed of a plurality of connector portions. That is, the connector portion can wrap completely around an entire perimeter edge of the electrical device, can wrap completely around a substantial perimeter portion of the perimeter of the electrical device, or it can be a series of smaller portions that each wrap around smaller portions of the perimeter of the electrical device. Regardless, there is a perimeter portion of the edge busbar of the present invention which is peripherally on a substantial perimeter of the electrical device and connects to the various connector portion(s) of the present invention. [0083]
  • The front of a substrate is generally defined as the surface having the conductive electrode layer thereon. [0084]
  • In the case of a two substrate device, the front of a substrate is the surface facing the other substrate. In the case of a single substrate EC device, the front of a substrate is the surface facing the EC stack. In general, the layer of transparent conductive material is on the front of a substrate. [0085]
  • Although other parameters such as the conductivity of the transparent conductors (electron conductors), the ionic conductivity of the electrolyte layer, and the intercalation rate in the EC coating and other coatings if used, might also influence the kinetic parameters of EC devices, as shown above, the resistance of the edge busbar itself can have an important affect on the performance of the EC device. Accordingly, it is an object of the present invention to minimize the contribution of the edge busbars towards slowing the EC device kinetics. The edge busbars of the present invention may also assist in promoting a spatially uniform rate of color change during coloring and bleaching cycles. [0086]
  • In one embodiment of the present invention, an edge busbar includes a connector portion that has a separation or separating portion. However, the connector portion at each side of the separation is electrically connected by the conductive electrode coating layer of the electrical device. The separation is relatively small between the connector portions on each side of the separation, so that there is negligible resistance across the break. In other words, the separation is electrically bridged by the conductive electrode coating layer. This allows the connector portion to be effectively continuous peripherally about the entire perimeter of the electrical device even though separations exist in the connector portion. Advantages to this configuration include ease of manufacture and reduced complexity of design. [0087]
  • Busbars of the present invention can be advantageously used in pairs. Another embodiment of the present invention provides an edge busbar pair for an electrical device, each edge busbar comprising a connector portion and a perimeter portion, wherein each connector portion is effective to form an electrically conductive path from a front surface of a substrate, wrapping around a portion of an edge of the substrate, to an opposite back surface of the substrate. The perimeter portions being in electrical contact with its respective connector portion, and wherein each perimeter portion is peripherally on a substantial perimeter of each respective substrate, and wherein the front surfaces of each substrate face each other with each substantial perimeter proximate to and substantially opposite to the other substantial perimeter. [0088]
  • As discussed previously, each edge busbar of an edge busbar pair can be continuous peripherally on a substantial perimeter of its substrate, can be continuous peripherally on an entire perimeter of its substrate, or can be composed of a plurality of connector portions. It is advantageous for each edge busbar to be composed of a plurality of connector portions. It is particularly advantageous for each connector portion of each edge busbar to be in an alternating relation with connector portions of the other edge busbar. As shown later, when the connector portions are in such alternating relation, the thickness of the busbar material can be thicker than one half of the total gap distance between the substrates and yet still not cause an electrical short. Further, a sealant and/or an insulator can be added to assure against any shorting. Nonetheless, as explained earlier, thicker busbar material is desirable in order to maximize conductivity. [0089]
  • The present invention can be implemented for single substrate devices or dual substrate devices. The edge busbars of the present invention can be used singly as needed advantageously (as contrasted with the prior art). However, single substrate devices can nonetheless require a pair of edge busbars because such devices, as described earlier and as known in the art, often are made by forming an EC stack onto a substrate. In such cases, the EC stack requires a pair conductive electrodes as well as the substrate. Accordingly, both conductive electrodes have electrical signals applied to them which would benefit from the advantages of the edge busbars of the present invention. [0090]
  • In the present invention, an edge busbar is used having a portion that can be fabricated of any convenient material with an effective maximum thickness that can be inserted in the cell gap without shorting from touching with the other busbar or with the opposing conductive substrate. At the same time, the edge busbar of the present invention provides sufficient conductivity such that a negligible voltage drop (preferably less than one tenth of the applied voltage) occurs in the edge busbar. Further, the edge busbar of the present invention covers a substantial portion of the device perimeter and can include the internal busbars of the present invention. [0091]
  • The present invention also relates to the construction of substrates, especially transparent conducting substrates, which possess relatively large effective conductivities by the inclusion of internal busbars. [0092]
  • The present invention further relates to the use of the aforementioned substrates to construct affordable large area EC devices that can be used for architectural applications, (e.g. windows, partitions, skylights, diffuser panels, light pipes, etc.), automotive (windows, sunroofs, etc.) or other transportation (windows for planes, trains, buses, boats, etc.) applications, or signage applications (including large area displays such as those used at stock exchanges, airports and other such facilities). [0093]
  • The present invention also provides substrates which possess appreciably lower effective sheet resistances (can be less than 1 Ω/sq or Ω/▪) at a cost that is attractive for applications such as those described above. [0094]
  • The present invention teaches means for lowering the sheet resistance of thin film transparent electrically conducting assemblies for use in chromogenic devices, particularly electrochromic (EC) devices. The present invention permits the manufacture of EC devices which possess significantly improved kinetics with regard to coloration and/or bleaching, even for devices which possess relatively large active areas. The present invention also results in devices which possess considerably improved coloration and bleaching uniformity. [0095]
  • Most practical EC devices, as shown in FIG. 6, are comprised of an “EC Assembly” [0096] 6601 which is effectively bound on either side by electronically conducting electrodes (ECE) 6602. Generally speaking, electrodes 6602 may be comprised of any of a variety of electronic conducting materials. Because EC devices are generally used to modulate light, however, at least one of the ECE 6602 should possess reasonable transparency at the wavelengths of interest (mirrors and many displays, e.g., typically possess only one transparent ECE; and window-type devices typically possess two transparent ECE's). The present invention provides improved effective conductivity of transparent ECE's in a manner readily integrated into the device structure.
  • The present invention forms internal busbars by providing strips of highly conductive material electrically connected to interior portions of a transparent ECE. The internal busbars add regions of increased conductivity into a transparent ECE, thereby lowering the overall effective resistance of the transparent ECE. Such lowered overall resistance leads to large device advantages. [0097]
  • The internal busbars of the present invention have increased conductivity compared to the transparent ECE when measured along the longitudinal direction of the conductive strips of the present invention. That is, in a top view of the transparent ECE with an internal busbar strip, when one compares a section of the conductive strip having a length L and a width W with a section of the transparent ECE also having the dimensions of W×L, the conductivity of the W×L section of the internal busbar will be higher than the conductance of the W×L section of the transparent ECE, along either dimension L or W. Preferably the conductivity of the conductive strip will be greater than about 2 times the conductivity of the transparent ECE, more preferably greater than about 10 times. [0098]
  • The internal busbars of the present invention achieves such higher conductance by several ways. According to one embodiment of the present invention, materials having inherently higher conductivities are used for the busbars. According to another embodiment of the present invention, the busbar strips are made thicker than the surrounding transparent ECE. Such thicker strips can be embedded below the transparent ECE and/or into the underlying substrate. It is important that these two—that is, the internal busbars and the transparent ECE—are in electrical contact with each other (continuous or spatially intermittent). One may even use a material, to enhance or to tailor the electrical characteristics of this electrical contact, different from that material of the internal busbars or of the transparent ECE. [0099]
  • In another embodiment, the internal busbar strips are formed on a different surface from that surface which has the transparent ECE. Strip connecting portions connect interior portions of the transparent ECE or device with segments of the internal busbar strip. Such strip connecting portions can extend through the substrate. The internal busbars of this embodiment are nonetheless “internal” because they connect to regions of the transparent ECE away from the periphery. [0100]
  • The present invention also is directed to circuitry which uses low power. Another object of the present invention are circuits which apply intermittent coloration power to EC devices in order to maintain or control the EC devices' coloration while compensating for the EC devices' inherent coloration decay without needing a constant application of coloration power.[0101]
  • BRIEF DESCRIPTION OF THE DRAWINGS
  • FIGS. 1A, 1B, [0102] 1C, 1D, 1E, and 1F are side cross-sectional views of a number of different prior art electrochromic, liquid crystal, PDLC, and photochromic devices suitable for use in the present invention.
  • FIG. 2 is a perspective view of a prior art arrangement of edge busbars clips on two substrates. [0103]
  • FIG. 3A is an perspective exploded view of a prior art arrangement of edge busbar clips on two substrates. [0104]
  • FIG. 3B is a sectional view of a prior art arrangement of edge busbar clips on two substrates. [0105]
  • FIG. 4 is a perspective view of a prior art arrangement of edge busbars clips on two substrates. [0106]
  • FIG. 5 is a perspective view of a prior art arrangement of edge busbars clips on two substrates. [0107]
  • FIG. 6 is a schematic side view of an EC device. [0108]
  • FIG. 7A is a schematic sectional view of an EC device having edge busbars of the present invention. [0109]
  • FIG. 7B is a schematic sectional view of an EC device having edge busbars and conductive paths of the present invention. [0110]
  • FIG. 8A is a perspective view of an EC device with a substrate having edge busbars of the present invention. [0111]
  • FIG. 8B is a schematic top plan view of a substrate having a continuous conductive path of the present invention. [0112]
  • FIG. 8C is a schematic top plan view of a substrate having strip conductive paths of the present invention. [0113]
  • FIG. 9A is a schematic side view of a pair of edge busbars of the present invention. [0114]
  • FIG. 9B is a schematic side view of an adhesive multilayer strip for the fabrication of an edge busbar of the present invention. [0115]
  • FIG. 9C is a plan view of an adhesive multilayer strip for the fabrication of an edge busbar of the present invention. [0116]
  • FIG. 9D is a perspective partial view of a pair of edge busbars of the present invention at a corner. [0117]
  • FIG. 10 is a schematic cross sectional view of a pair of edge busbars of the present invention. [0118]
  • FIG. 11A is a side view of a prior art stacked substrate arrangement. [0119]
  • FIG. 11B is a top view of a prior art stacked substrate arrangement. [0120]
  • FIG. 12 is a schematic side sectional partial view of a prior art stacked substrate arrangement. [0121]
  • FIG. 13 is a perspective view of a single substrate with a bottom conductor applied according to an embodiment of the present invention. [0122]
  • FIG. 14 is top view of a single substrate with a top conductor applied according to an embodiment of the present invention. [0123]
  • FIG. 15A is a schematic sectional side view of a single substrate with a top and bottom conductors applied according to an embodiment of the present invention. [0124]
  • FIG. 15B is a schematic sectional side view of a single substrate with a top and bottom conductors applied according to an embodiment of the present invention. [0125]
  • FIG. 15C is a schematic sectional side detail view of a substrate with a bottom conductor and signal connections according to an embodiment of the present invention. [0126]
  • FIG. 16A is a schematic sectional side view of a single substrate with embedded edge busbars according to an embodiment of the present invention. [0127]
  • FIG. 16B is a schematic sectional side view of a single substrate with embedded edge busbars according to an embodiment of the present invention. [0128]
  • FIG. 17A is a top view of a substrate with a continuous conductor busbar according to an embodiment of the present invention. [0129]
  • FIG. 17B is a perspective view of a substrate with a continuous conductor busbar according to an embodiment of the present invention at an intermediate fabrication step. [0130]
  • FIG. 18 is a graph of the light transmittance vs. time for different busbar configurations according to the present invention. [0131]
  • FIG. 19A is a schematic sectional view of a stacked circular substrate arrangement according to an embodiment of the present invention. [0132]
  • FIG. 19B is a top view of a stacked circular substrate arrangement according to an embodiment of the present invention. [0133]
  • FIG. 20A is a schematic perspective view of a coated substrate with internal busbars formed on the surface according to an embodiment of the present invention. [0134]
  • FIG. 20B is a schematic perspective view of a coated substrate with two sets of internal busbars formed on the surface according to an embodiment of the present invention. [0135]
  • FIG. 21 is a schematic cross sectional view of a process to form embedded internal busbars on a substrate according to an embodiment of the present invention. [0136]
  • FIG. 22 is a schematic plan view of a device with internal busbars having different widths according to an embodiment of the present invention. [0137]
  • FIG. 23 is a schematic cross sectional side view of a device with internal busbars having a transverse axis parallel to a sight line that is at an angle to the surface normal according to an embodiment of the present invention. [0138]
  • FIG. 24 is a schematic cross sectional diagram of a device according to an embodiment of the present invention having internal busbars that cause a property change when a signal is applied between them, a different property change when a signal is applied along each busbar equally, and changes in both properties when a difference occurs in the signals applied to each busbar according to an embodiment of the present invention. [0139]
  • FIG. 25A is a schematic plan view of a group of internal busbars addressable as a group according to an embodiment of the present invention. [0140]
  • FIG. 25B is a schematic plan view of a group of internal busbars individually addressable according to an embodiment of the present invention. [0141]
  • FIG. 26A is a schematic plan view of two groups of internal busbars arranged at an angle to each other according to an embodiment of the present invention. [0142]
  • FIG. 26B is a schematic plan view of a group of internal busbars arranged substantially parallel to each other according to an embodiment of the present invention. [0143]
  • FIG. 26C is a schematic plan view of a spiral internal busbar according to an embodiment of the present invention. [0144]
  • FIG. 27A is a schematic plan view of a group of internal busbars connected to the conductive layer by conductive posts according to an embodiment of the present invention. [0145]
  • FIG. 27B is a schematic side sectional view of a group of internal busbars connected to the conductive layer by conductive posts according to an embodiment of the present invention. [0146]
  • FIG. 28 is a schematic perspective exploded view of a group of internal busbars connected to the conductive layer by conductive posts according to an embodiment of the present invention. [0147]
  • FIG. 29 is a schematic side sectional close up view of an internal busbar connected to the conductive layer by a conductive post according to an embodiment of the present invention. [0148]
  • FIG. 30 is a graph of the transmissivity v. elapsed time for EC cells of different sizes without internal busbars or edge busbars. [0149]
  • FIG. 31A is a schematic plan view of a set of internal busbars disposed on a substrate according to an embodiment of the present invention. [0150]
  • FIG. 31B is a schematic sectional view of a set of internal busbars disposed between two substrates according to an embodiment of the present invention. [0151]
  • FIG. 31C is a schematic sectional view of a set of internal busbars disposed between two substrates according to an embodiment of the present invention. [0152]
  • FIG. 32A is a schematic sectional view of an electrically reinforced edge busbar according to an embodiment of the present invention. [0153]
  • FIG. 32B is a schematic sectional view of an electrically reinforced edge busbar according to an embodiment of the present invention. [0154]
  • FIG. 32C is a schematic sectional view of an electrically reinforced edge busbar according to an embodiment of the present invention. [0155]
  • FIG. 32D is a schematic sectional view of an electrically reinforced edge busbar according to an embodiment of the present invention. [0156]
  • FIG. 32E is a schematic sectional view of an electrically reinforced edge busbar according to an embodiment of the present invention. [0157]
  • FIG. 33A is a plan view of an electrochromic cell according to an embodiment of the present invention. [0158]
  • FIG. 33B is a cross-sectional side view of an electrochromic cell according to an embodiment of the present invention. [0159]
  • FIG. 34A is a graph of the coloration kinetics of a 6″ by 3″ (15 cm×7.5 cm) electrochromic window with internal busbars according to an embodiment of the present invention, and of a comparison electrochromic window without internal busbars. [0160]
  • FIG. 34B is a graph of the current/time behavior of a 6″ by 3″ (15 cm×7.5 cm) electrochromic window with internal busbars according to an embodiment of the present invention, and of a comparison electrochromic window without internal busbars. [0161]
  • FIG. 35 is a graph of light transmission (T) and applied voltage (V) as a function of time (t) according to an embodiment of the present invention. [0162]
  • FIG. 36A is a circuit diagram of an embodiment of the present invention that includes a thermistor. [0163]
  • FIG. 36B is a circuit diagram of an embodiment of the present invention that includes a micro-controller. [0164]
  • FIG. 37A is a circuit diagram of a switching regulator circuit according to an embodiment of the present invention. [0165]
  • FIG. 37B is a circuit diagram of a switching regulator circuit according to an embodiment of the present invention. [0166]
  • FIG. 37C is a circuit diagram of a switching regulator circuit according to an embodiment of the present invention yielding a very low quiescent current. [0167]
  • FIG. 38A is a circuit diagram of a switching regulator circuit according to an embodiment of the present invention having a resistor placed in series with the power supply output and EC cell. [0168]
  • FIG. 38B describes the various shapes that the voltage vs. time curve can follow depending on the parameters of the control circuit of the present invention that controls an EC cell and compared to the prior art continuous step shape and the prior art linear ramp shape. [0169]
  • FIG. 38C describes the various shapes that the voltage vs. time curves can follow depending on the circuit resistance parameters. [0170]
  • FIG. 39 is a circuit diagram illustrating the incorporation of an op amp and thermistor in a circuit for regulating the voltage supplied to an EC cell. [0171]
  • FIG. 40 is a circuit diagram illustrating the use of a thermistor in a circuit to vary the output voltage with temperature. [0172]
  • FIG. 41 is a circuit diagram illustrating the use of a thermistor in a comparator circuit. [0173]
  • FIG. 42 is a circuit diagram illustrating the use of a thermistor in a comparator circuit. [0174]
  • FIG. 43 is a circuit diagram illustrating the use of an adjustable voltage power supply with an EC device. [0175]
  • FIG. 44 is a circuit diagram illustrating the use of a sensing resistor in series with the power output to limit the maximum current flowing in the circuit. [0176]
  • FIG. 45 illustrates an electric circuit attached to an EC cell having switches that may be used to determine t[0177] 1 or t1 by mesuring the voltage at the EC cell Vcell and comparing the value with Vc or VB.
  • DETAILED DESCRIPTION OF THE INVENTION
  • Edge Busbars [0178]
  • In the present invention, a conductive path is formed from the electrodes to the edges of the substrate. Preferably, this path is extended on to the back of the substrate as shown in FIGS. 7A and 7B (the details of other coatings employed in the device have been omitted). Two [0179] substrates 701 and 702 are shown attached to each other at close proximity by cell adhesive 703. On the edge of the device, preferably including on the back, highly conductive paths are employed to lower the busbar resistance. FIG. 7A shows an edge busbar 704 of the present invention which wraps around the edge of the substrate to provide highly conductive paths on three sides of the edge. FIG. 7B shows a conductive path 706 of the present invention to which is attached a highly conductive perimeter portion 705.
  • The [0180] conductive path 706 from the front of the substrates to the back could be the continuation of the same material which is used for the transparent conductor on the substrate, such as indium tin oxide, or can be fabricated from a different material. Once the conductive path is formed on the back of the substrates, the geometrical limitations on the thickness and the width of the busbar conductor are relieved substantially because the perimeter portion can cover a larger area without concerns about thickness. The busbar of the present invention includes the conductive path and the perimeter portion.
  • [0181] Conductive path 706 forms an electrical connection from the front to the back. Therefore, the paths can be called connector portions. These electrical connector portions can be made using conductive adhesives, silver frits (e.g., available from Dupont Electronic Materials, Research Triangle Park, N.C. or FX 33-246 available from Ferro Inc. of Santa Barbra, Calif.), solder materials, physical vapor deposition, chemical vapor deposition, electroless deposition of metals, metallo-organics (e.g., available from Engelhard Electronic Materials, N.J.) and conductive tapes. The conductivity of these connector portions need not be as high as the perimeter portions that connect to these connector portions because the connector portions only have to carry the current over a short distance, hence their actual effective resistance is low.
  • These connector portions could be continuous, thereby merging with the perimeter portion, or in strips. Either connector portion configuration, continuous or strips, encompasses a substantial portion of the device perimeter. FIG. 8A shows two [0182] substrates 801 and 802, separated for clarity. Substrate 802 is shown with a continuous conductive path 803. FIG. 8B shows substrate 802, continuous conductive path 803, and an adhesive 804. FIG. 8C shows a substrate 802′, strip conductive paths 803′, and adhesive 804. In FIG. 8C, perimeter portion 805 connects strip conductive paths 803′. Perimeter portion 805 extends to a back perimeter region (not shown).
  • According to the present invention, referring to FIGS. 8B and 8C, it is not necessary to have a width of the substrate exposed between the sealant or adhesive [0183] 804 and the connector portion or conductive paths 803 and 803′. Depending on the nature of the sealant and connector portion and their bonding characteristics, a partial or a complete overlap may exist. If the connector portion of the present invention is used in the strip form as shown in FIG. 8C, the connector portion strips on the bottom and on the top substrates may be offset from each other, may be stacked on top of each other, or may have no particularly set geometric relationship.
  • In a preferred configuration where the connector portion strips are offset, the thicknesses may be increased almost to the point where they occupy the entire gap between the substrates without shorting. Such connector portion strips are offset effective to allow an insulating distance between a particular connector portion strip and any neighboring connector portion strips connected to an opposite substrate, as well as between the particular connector portion strip and the opposite substrate. The insulating distance can include insulating material. The insulating material can also be preformed on the conductive strips. In a particularly preferred configuration, the connector portion strips from one substrate are in an alternating relationship to the connector portion strips of the other substrate. [0184]
  • The perimeter portion materials could be selected from the same list of materials as the connector portions. However, to enhance their conductance, materials with high conductivity could be selected and/or the geometry (i.e., increased thickness, width, perimeter portions etc.) may be different from the connector portions. [0185]
  • Thick metallic strips and wires may also be used as perimeter portions. The conductive path of the connector portions of the present invention overcomes the prior art's dependence on the busbars' specific conductivity because the present invention provides a broad area of conductance to which the connector portion is attached. [0186]
  • The devices are preferably assembled (e.g., by bonding together two substrates) after the connector portion strips or front to back connections are attached to each of the substrates. If counterelectrode coatings are required in the EC device, such strip connector portions can be formed or positioned before or after these coatings are deposited. Further, the part of the connector portion strips on the back of the substrates can be joined or reinforced (such as with conductive copper tapes) with highly conducting medium either before or after the device assembly. The adhesive in the copper tapes may be pressure sensitive adhesive (PSA), or may be curable later into a thermosetting material by the application of pressure, heat, radiation, moisture, or more than one of these methods. [0187]
  • As described above, and further below, the edge busbars of this invention can be augmented (“reinforced”) in conductivity. That is, the electrical conductivity is augmented or reinforced in order to increase the busbar electrical conductivity, by such methods as (i) by wrapping a continuous connector from the front to the back of the substrate, thus providing a wider conductor resulting in higher electrical conductivity, (ii) by attaching the connector to a conductive wire, foil, or tape positioned on the back of the substrate so that the connector's conductivity can be augmented by the conductance of the wire, foil, solder, frit, or tape, and (iii) attaching a wire or conductor on the edge of the substrate to electrically contact the connector in order to augment the conductance of the connector. [0188]
  • A preferred method to form the edge busbar is to use a conductive tape with a conductive adhesive layer that conducts through the adhesive layer thickness. FIG. 9B shows a [0189] conductive tape 909 having a conductor 911, a conducting adhesive layer 912 and an optional insulating layer 910. A continuous strip of such a tape is shown in FIG. 9C. Tape 909 includes the continuous conductor or perimeter portion 913, and fingers or connector portions 914 that will form the contact with the transparent conductor on the front side of the substrate. The front side, as defined previously, refers to the substrate side that faces the other substrate of an EC device, while the back of a substrate refers to the side, opposite to the front side, that faces away or is farther away from the other substrate. Tape 909 connects the front of the substrate (facing inward) by way of connector portions 914 to perimeter portion 913 at the back of the substrate. An edge portion 915 of connector portion 914 lies on the edge of the substrate.
  • As shown in FIG. 9C, [0190] perimeter portion 913 and strip connector portion 914 could be integrally connected, i.e., one piece of tape of the perimeter portion is preferably aligned with the bottom edge of the substrate, or is on the backside of the substrate. The flat side is folded and adhered to the substrate back. For a rectangular device with sharp corners, the tape in the corner could be folded over the back side to form a crease without effecting the connector portions at the front side. Since there is effectively no limitation on the gap or tape thickness on the back side (or the outside) of the device, the procedure of the present invention can be used without affecting the separation distance of the substrates. Instead of a crease on the back side, the tape can be cut and the tape strips running at an angle to each other can be folded on top of each other on the corners. The corners may also be bridged by a piece of another tape, wire, solder, etc., to keep preferably one continuous electrical path forming a perimeter portion for each substrate. The tape or the strip on the back can be made more conductive by reinforcing the tape with a more conductive medium, e.g., more tape, wire, metallic strip, etc. Accordingly, the perimeter portion can be multilayered or made from a number of components.
  • In this description, the use of the above shape of the tape (i.e. tape with connector portions or fingers extending from a continuous perimeter portion) avoids any kinds of creases or kinks on the front surface. Such kinks can develop as the tape traverses over the corners of the substrate. It is readily understood that as an edge bends to form a curve or to form a corner, an inner path which is a certain distance from the outer edge will trace a different distance from the outer edge. In the case of a convex curve, the inner path will be shorter. Accordingly, a non-stretching material will tend to crease or kink to try to accommodate the excess material on such an inner path. The recesses between each connector portion prevents accumulation of excess material on the front side between the substrates. [0191]
  • The above description shows a tape that is easily and advantageously used for applications where a pair of edge busbars can be placed correspondingly opposite each other on two substrates without physical interference or electrical shorting because of the innovative geometry of the edge busbar pairs of the present invention. Such geometry innovatively allows the pair of edge busbars to nest together in an alternating relation. Such geometry further innovatively allows each of the pair of edge busbars to be thicker than half the gap separating the substrates on which they cover, thereby increasing the edge busbar conductivity without shorting to each other. Such geometry also allows edge busbars to wrap around corners without interfering busbar material in between the substrate separation gap. [0192]
  • For those EC panels that are rectangular in shape, it is particularly at the corners that certain configurations of the present invention are important. It is important to ensure that no fingers are located on those areas of the tape which bend around the sharp corners. Furthermore, the fingers are spaced such that they do not overlap each other over the conductive substrates. Any kinks, overlaps, or creases on the front (conductive) side can interfere with the predetermined gap between the two substrates and, depending on the materials employed, could also lead to electrical shorting between the two substrates. [0193]
  • The tape shown in FIG. 9C can optionally have an additional row of strip connector portions [0194] 914 (not shown) on the side of perimeter portion 913 opposite the side with the row of strip connector portions 914 shown. In this optional configuration, perimeter portion 913 is affixed to the edge of the substrate and the each opposite rows of strip connector portions 914 are affixed to respective opposite surfaces of the substrate.
  • Besides for substrates with sharp corners, the geometry of the tapes described above can be similarly employed for substrates with circular, elliptical, or any other regular or irregular shapes. For shapes that have a gradual change, such as a circle, the width of the strip connector fingers and the spacing between them should be such so that no noticeable kink is introduced on the front side of the substrate for the reasons described above. [0195]
  • The electrical connections to the device are made from the perimeter portion on the back of the substrate by using more conductive tape, solder, adhesive, wires, etc., or preferably the tape described above may be provided in a pre-cut size and shape that has a connector or a connector attachment already assembled. [0196]
  • As shown in FIG. 9A, it is preferable for [0197] connector portion 914 of each tape 909 to be in an alternating relationship with the connector portions 914 of the other tape 909 to minimize the chances of shorting or of overlapping of fingers. As shown in FIG. 9D, a corner of substrate 901 and a corner of substrate 902 meet without any connector portions 914 at the corners. The connector portions 914 remain in an alternating relationship to prevent any overlap of tape conductive material
  • As shown in FIG. 9B, [0198] tape 909 employed for this purpose can be coated or laminated with a nonconductive material insulating layer 910 on the side that is non-adhering. This will reduce the chances for shorting of the two substrates should the fingers inadvertently overlap or if there is a malfunction, for example, when one of the strip fingers lifts off the surface.
  • In another method, highly conductive busbars are made by wrapping the connector from the substrate front to the substrate edges and then reinforcing the edge portion with a highly conductive material. This is shown in FIGS. 32A and 32D. The connectors are shown as [0199] 3205 and 3205″ and the reinforcements as 3203 and 3203′″ forming the busbars 3202 and 3202′″. The reinforcement can be any convenient shape such as a cylindrical wire, as shown for example. Another shape is a flattened wire. In this example the conductor is shown significantly thicker at the edges than its thickness on the front of the substrate. In FIG. 32D, the reinforcement is located in a precut groove on the edges of the substrate.
  • FIG. 32E shows highly conductive reinforced busbars having the reinforcement in a groove with the conductive connector wrapping from the front of the substrate around the edge to the opposite side of the substrate. [0200]
  • The busbars can be made by any convenient method such as, for example, by feeding the reinforcing wire and solder (as connector) so that both can be put in place simultaneously. Another method could be where the wire is pre-attached, e.g., by wrapping and then mechanically tightening around the perimeter of the substrate. The solder is then deposited on the front and the edge thus electrically attaching the reinforcement with the connector. In this method it may be advantageous to have a precut groove on the perimeter edge of the substrate in which the wire can be placed, as shown in FIG. 32D. [0201]
  • The arrangement shown in FIG. 32A can be modified as shown in FIGS. 32B and 32C where the connector wraps around from the front to the back. Similarly, the conductor shown in FIG. 32D can be extended by having a wrap around connector (as shown in FIG. 32E). Further, the wire may be placed in a groove on the edge (as shown in FIG. 32D) or in a groove made in the back of the substrate close to the perimeter edge (not shown). [0202]
  • The connector may be deposited by using a soldering iron, with its tip shaped so that the solder can be melted and simultaneously deposited on two adjacent surfaces (as shown in FIG. 32A) or on three adjacent edges (as shown in FIG. 32B). Instead of using a solder, a conducting adhesive may also be applied. The solder or adhesive may be applied from a bath of molten solder or uncured liquid adhesive by dipping the substrate edge in the bath and then moving the part (e.g., rotationally) effective to cover a substantial perimeter of the substrate. [0203]
  • To improve the reliability of the connections, it is preferred to seal the device using a non-conducting adhesive. As shown in FIG. 10, it may even be desirable to allow the edge sealant adhesive to fill in the remaining gap between the substrates and preferably extend to the substrates edges for improved reliability. [0204] Substrates 1001 and 1002 are separated and attached to each other by cell adhesive 1003. Edge busbars 1005 including conductive paths that wrap around to the fronts of substrates 1001 and 1002 have an edge sealant 1004 filling the respective gaps between each opposite pairs of edge busbars. Any convenient non-conducting material can be used such as, for example, a curable formulation such as a caulking, a heat or radiation curable material, or a hot melt adhesive that cures later, or a non-curable formulation such as a hot-melt adhesive. Some examples of materials used in sealants are silicones, polysulfides, butyls, urethanes, epoxies, vinyls, polyolefins, polyamides and acrylics, etc. Hot melt urethanes that cure later due to the diffusion of moisture may be preferred as a sealant because devices so made could be handled soon after fabrication and a non-flowable, non-sagging bond is obtained after curing. One may preferably employ the cell adhesive 1003 to be the same as edge sealant 1004. This adhesive may have spacers so that the cell spacing is governed by the size of these spaces and the thickness of edge busbars 1005. This avoids electrical shorts between the two substrates, due to busbar peel, moisture condensation or conductive impurity.
  • Although the present invention has been discussed in terms of electrochromic devices, it can also be useful in photochromic devices (U.S. Pat. No. 5,604,626, incorporated herein by reference), liquid crystal based devices as described in Motogomery, G. P., in [0205] Large-Area Chromogenics: Materials and Devices for Transmittance Control, SPIE Optical Engineering Press, Bellingham, Wash., 1990, p. 577, suspended particle devices (Research Frontiers Inc., Woodbury, N.Y.) and other devices.
  • Highly conductive busbars may be deposited on single substrate devices in a number of ways to achieve substantial perimeter contact. In the prior art, for example in U.S. Pat. No. 5,187,607, incorporated herein by reference, the busbars for an EC device do not cover a substantial perimeter of the device. As shown in FIG. 12 (taken from U.S. Pat. No. 5,187,607) a busbar is formed on the edges of the substrate. The first transparent coating layer (bottom conductor) is deposited so that it touches both the busbars, but it is not continuous. This coating is either etched or deposited in such a way (e.g., by masking) that there is no electrical continuity between the two busbars. The coatings which comprise the EC stack are substantially deposited on one of these sections. However, the top conductor is deposited in such a way that it touches the second part of the bottom conductor and is electrically insulated from the first part of the bottom conductor by the EC stack. Thus, in this design none of the two busbars occupies a substantial perimeter of the device. Instead, the busbars run along the two edges similar to the prior art discussed previously. [0206]
  • As shown in FIGS. [0207] 11A, and 11B, the use of busbars according to the present invention which are deposited on a substantial perimeter of an electric cell can be effectively employed for those devices that use thin coatings on one substrate. A substrate 1101 has a transparent electrode 1102 on its front surface. An EC stack 1104 is on the transparent conductor 1102. A bottom busbar 1103 is formed on the perimeter of the transparent conductor 1102 while a top busbar 1105 is formed on the perimeter of the top of the EC stack. Electric leads are connected to each busbar.
  • As shown in FIG. 13, a [0208] bottom electrode 1402 is formed on substrate 1405 in a pattern with recesses 1301 at the edges of bottom electrode 1402. Bottom electrode 1402 can be formed by any convenient method such as, for example, by depositing the bottom electrode (e.g. made from ITO, doped tin oxide, doped zinc oxide, etc.) over an appropriate mask, or by etching through an appropriate mask after deposition. Preferably, the sheet resistance of the transparent conductors is less than about 30 Ω/▪, more preferably less than about 15 Ω/▪, and most preferably less than about 10 Ω/▪.
  • The EC stack is then deposited along with the top electrode only onto the device area, and recesses [0209] 1301 in the electrode border area. Optionally, one can deposit the EC stack over the device area and only the top electrode layer would extend into recesses 1301 of the electrode border. It is important to keep the top electrode layer and the bottom electrode layer from shorting, thus it is desirable that the top electrode be deposited in such a way that it covers only a portion of recesses 1301 in the border region to avoid shorting. Optionally, an insulating layer can be deposited.
  • As shown in FIGS. 14, 15A, and [0210] 15B, one embodiment includes forming an EC stack 1406 on bottom electrode 1402. A top electrode 1401 is formed on EC stack 1406. An edge busbar 1404 connects to top electrode 1401, while an edge busbar 1403 connects to bottom electrode 1402. Edge busbar 1404 comprises a perimeter portion 1404C and a connector portion 1404D. Connector portion 1404D includes a contacting portion 1404A and an edge portion 1404B. Contacting portion 1404A electrically contacts a surface of top electrode 1401. Edge busbar 1403 comprises a perimeter portion 1403C and a connector portion 1403D. Connector portion 1403D includes a contacting portion 1403A and an edge portion 1403B. Contacting portion 1403A electrically contacts a surface of bottom electrode 1402. Connector portion 1404D and 1403D are in alternating relationship on each side of EC device 1444.
  • One method to form the continuous busbar on this device is to utilize a tape as shown in FIGS. 9B and 9C. As described earlier, the first tape is placed around the periphery of the device with its fingers touching the bottom electrode in the connector border area. The continuous body of the tape is folded and adhered to the back of the substrate. The fingers of the tapes form the connector portions [0211] 1403D and 1404D. The fingers of the second tape are then adhered on the top electrode (in the connector border area) and folded and adhered to the back of the substrate.
  • The tapes, after assembly, appear as shown in FIG. 15A and 15B in a cross-section view (two sections shown from FIG. 14). One of the tapes is wider, in order to protrude out. Perimeter portion [0212] 1403C extends beyond perimeter portion 1404C to expose surface 1403E. This allows connection to be made to both edge busbars 1403 and 1404 directly to any convenient point or points on perimeter portion 1404C and to any convenient point or points on exposed perimeter portion 1403E.
  • Referring to FIG. 15C, the connection can be made by removing the insulating layer locally, or the tape may come with a connector-adapter and/or connector pre-attached as discussed earlier. Connections [0213] 1408A and 1408B are shown connecting to perimeter portions 1403C and 1404C, respectively while being insulated from perimeter portions 1404C and 1403C, respectively. Connections 1408A and 1408B can be, for example, a conductive wire or tape connected to an exterior signal connector. Connections 1408A and 1408B can be attached at only one corner (a smaller portion of the device perimeter), or at a longer portion of the device perimeter such as, for example, a substantial perimeter.
  • In all cases, one must be careful that the two [0214] busbars 1403 and 1404 do not electrically short in the regions 1410 where an edge of perimeter portion 1403C meets edge portion 1404B at the edge of substrate 1405. Shorting can be avoided by ensuring that the insulator layer of the tape extends out and covers the edges of the conductor. Alternatively, after adhering the first tape, these edges can be treated with an insulating material (tape, adhesive, coating) before the second tape is applied.
  • Once all the edge busbars are in place, the edges of the [0215] EC device 1444 can be encapsulated, for example, by injection molding (e.g., using thermoplastic elastomers or plasticized polyvinyl chloride) or reaction injection mold (e.g., using polyurethane) with a resin that can be solidified to ensure the reliability of the connections. It may even be desirable to cover the entire device with another substrate (preferably a glass or a plastic sheet) for mechanical and environmental protection before edge encapsulation. This cover substrate may also incorporate UV blocking characteristics. The edge encapsulation may be achieved such that a connector plug (which is internally connected to the busbars) is molded therein which can be easily disconnected from the power supply. This will allow EC panels to be quickly serviced and replaced in the field.
  • As shown in FIGS. 16A and 16B, [0216] busbars 1602 may be embedded in the edge of a substrate 1601 or busbars 1603 may be embedded in the edge regions of substrate 1601. The appropriate region of the substrate is etched, ablated, or otherwise conveniently removed to form a recess. A highly conductive material (e.g., a metal) is deposited into the recess region. Planarization, to bring the substrate surface and the busbars substantially to a plane, may be necessary prior to the deposition of an additional layer or layers. Such embedded busbars 1602 and 1603 can serve as perimeter portions with connector portions formed (not shown) by any convenient method such as, for example, wrapping tape around the edge to contact the back surface and the embedded busbar, depositing conductive material such as a frit or a coating around the edge from the embedded busbar to the back surface, or attaching a multitude of preformed conductive channels to the edge to contact the back surface and the embedded busbar.
  • As described previously, the edge busbar of the present invention provides sufficient conductivity such that a negligible voltage drop (preferably less than one tenth of the applied voltage) occurs in the edge busbar. The conductivity can be optionally reinforced by the addition of a supplemental conductor portion as part of the edge busbar of the present invention, as shown in FIGS. 32A, 32B, and [0217] 32C. In a preferred embodiment, an ultrasonic solder dispenses an appropriate soldering material on the edge of the substrate. A highly conductive medium (e.g. a wire, conductive tape or foil, etc.) is attached to reinforce the overall conductance around a substantial perimeter of the substrate. It is preferable that both the solder and Whe wire or strip are dispensed simultaneously to form the edge busbar and the reinforcement at the same time.
  • The reinforcement bar can also be in the form of a closed loop with a perimeter slightly smaller than that of the substrate. In this case, after applying the edge busbar, the reinforcement is expanded by heating and positioned around the edge making contact with the busbar. Of necessary, it can be soldered to further improve electrical contact. This method is particularly appropriate in the case of cells having circular or oval substrates where the reinforcement can be made in the form of a ring and contracted, by cooling, uniformly around the substrate. Finally, a lead can be soldered to the reinforcement. [0218]
  • Referring to FIG. 32A, an [0219] edge busbar 3202 is formed on a peripheral surface and a substantial perimeter edge of a substrate 3201. Edge busbar 3202 includes a reinforcement portion 3203 which can be any convenient conductor such as, for example, wire, foil, or bead of solder. Reinforcement portion 3203 is shown as a circular cross-sectional wire attached to the side of the edge portion 3205 of edge busbar 3202. A connection 3204 provides an external electrical lead to edge busbar 3202.
  • Referring to FIG. 32B, an [0220] edge busbar 3202′ is formed on opposing peripheral surfaces and a substantial perimeter edge of a substrate 3201. Edge busbar 3202′ includes a reinforcement portion 3203′ which is shown as a circular cross-sectional wire attached to the side of the edge portion 3205′ of edge busbar 3202′. A connection 3204′ provides an external electrical lead to edge busbar 3202′.
  • Referring to FIG. 32C, an edge busbar [0221] 320211 is formed on opposing peripheral surfaces and a substantial perimeter edge of a substrate 3201. Edge busbar 3202″ includes a reinforcement portion 3203″ which is shown as a circular cross-sectional wire attached to one peripheral edge portion 3206 of edge busbar 3202″. A connection 3204″ provides an external electrical lead to edge busbar 3202″.
  • Referring to FIG. 33A, a [0222] substrate 3301 is shown having a solder edge busbar 3302. Solder edge busbar 3302 is in electrical contact with one segment of a silver frit layer 3303. Another segment of silver frit layer 3303 forms an internal busbar 3304. Internal busbar 3304 is interior to the perimeter formed by a main epoxy seal 3305.
  • Referring to FIG. 33B, two [0223] substrates 3301′ and 3301″, each has a solder edge busbar 3302′ and 3302″ respectively. Each solder edge busbar 3302′ and 3302″ are in contact with segments of silver frit layers 3303′ and 3303″. A common epoxy seal 3305′ bounds internal busbars 3304′ and 330411 which are segments of silver frit layers 3303′ and 3303″ respectively.
  • The Examples which follow are intended as an illustration of certain preferred embodiments of the invention, and no limitation of the invention is implied. [0224]
  • EXAMPLES Example 1 and Comparative Examples 1C and 2C
  • EC devices were made having two substrates, one employing a one half wave ITO (about 12 ohms/square) on glass substrate (from Donnelly Applied Films, Boulder, CO) and the other being a [0225] TEC 15 glass (from Libby Owens Ford (LOF), Toledo, Ohio). The nominal size of these was 6 inch by 6 inch (15 cm×15 cm). The gap between the substrates was 210 micrometers. Busbars were formed using a copper tape with conductive adhesive. Three different configurations were made: (i) Comparative Example 1C was made in a configuration as shown in FIG. 2, where the edge busbar was on one edge of each substrate, (ii) Comparative Example 2C was made in a configuration as shown in FIG. 4, where the edge busbars are on the two edges of each substrate, and (iii) Example 1 was made in a configuration as shown in FIG. 7A and constructed by a method as shown in FIGS. 17A and 17B, where the edge busbars are on four edges of each substrate. Copper tape (with conductive pressure sensitive adhesive) was used to form the busbars. The thickness of the copper tape was 50 micrometers and a width of 3 mm.
  • To form the busbar on all four edges, as shown in FIGS. 17A and 17B, four strips of [0226] copper tape 1701 were attached to substrate 1702 and then folded on the back of the substrate. Care was taken that these strips were close but not overlapping. On only one of the substrates, the copper tape was covered with a 50 micrometer thick polyimide tape, the latter was wider than the copper tape by about {fraction (1/32)} of an inch (0.079 cm). This was done to prevent shorting of the two substrates if the copper tape peeled accidentally and touched the other substrate. Optionally, tabs 1703 can be formed by extending one portion of copper tape 1701. The two substrates were then adhered to each other in a configuration shown in FIG. 7A. The total gap between the two substrates was 210 micrometers (controlled by the adhesive) and the total thickness of the tape was 150 micrometers.
  • The assembled cells were powered by connecting power to the busbars. In the case of Example 1, power was connected to one of the [0227] copper tabs 1703 sticking out from each of the substrates. In this example the tabs were not joined by a wire or a tape on the back. Since the distance between the adjacent copper strips was small, the potential drop in the intervening ITO was negligible for this device. Thus, the busbars of Example 1 effectively formed a continuous electrical conductor around each substrate perimeter. The continuous electrical conductor of Example 1 included the connector portions being effectively electrically continuous as well as the perimeter portions being effectively electrically continuous.
  • FIG. 18 shows the kinetic traces of each of the three devices when they were colored and bleached by applying identical step potentials. Example 1, the cell with busbar on all four sides colors, was the fastest to color and colored the deepest (during the time shown in the graph), while Comparative Example 1C, the one with busbar only on one edge, was the slowest to color and also colored the least deep of the three devices. [0228]
  • Example 2
  • An [0229] EC device 1910 was made using two TEC 15 transparent conductive substrates as shown in FIGS. 19A and 19B. Example 2 was a circular EC device 1910 with a substrate 1902 being 13 inches (33.02 cm) in diameter and a second smaller substrate 1901 being 12 inch (30 cm) in diameter. Before EC device 1910 was assembled, a busbar 1904 on the smaller substrate 1901 was formed by screening on a silver frit from Dupont Electronic Materials, Wilmington, Del. (frit Type 7713). The frit forming was deposited in a perimeter ring geometry to form busbar 1904, with the outer dimensions of the ring being substantially the same as that of substrate 1901. The width of the ring was 2 mm and the thickness was 5.5 micrometers. In one part of the busbar 1904 ring the silver frit was painted on the edge (while keeping it connected to the ring) and extended on to the back of the substrate to form a conductive path 1908 of busbar 1904 which is conductive from the front to the back. An electrical conducting wire 1906 is connected to conductive path 1908 on the back.
  • [0230] Substrate 1901 was heated to 575° C. for 6 minutes to consolidate and cure the frit. The busbar 1905 on the larger substrate 1902 was formed by attaching a copper beryllium spring clip 1905 around the circumference. Spring clip 1905 comprises a continuous perimeter portion 1911 which extends circumferentially around the edge of substrate 1902, and finger connector portions 1912 which extends radially from continuous perimeter portion 1911 to substrate 1902. A conducting wire 1907 was soldered to clip 1905 to power substrate 1902. EC cell 1910 was assembled by gluing the two substrates together with adhesive 1903, as shown in FIGS. 19A and 19B. The smaller substrate 1901 was kept concentric with the larger substrate 1902.
  • Internal Busbars [0231]
  • To produce the desired improvements in EC device behavior, it is necessary to reduce appreciably the effective resistance of the transparent electronic conductors (TC) in the devices or to otherwise transport charge more efficiently laterally across the device. In contrast to the case of a TC, when the transparency of a particular electronically conducting electrode (ECE) is not important, the ECE can generally be made thick enough in the prior art so that its resistance does not adversely affect the device behavior. For example, for a prior art mirror device with an Aluminum (Al) ECE and an ITO ECE, the Al layer can be deposited sufficiently thick. The result, however, is that the effective resistance of the ITO (the transparent electronic conductor or TC) usually is the primary limiting factor which must be overcome to improve the device behavior. [0232]
  • In reducing the effective resistance of a TC, it is crucial to ensure that the means employed does not adversely affect other components of the device operation. This is especially problematic when the TC acts as a substrate for an active EC layer or layers (such as for devices which contain EC tungsten oxide deposited on ITO-coated glass substrates). In addition, one must ensure that the means employed do not too strongly diminish the transmissivity or apparent transmissivity of the TC or otherwise adversely affect the cosmetics of the device. For example, the resistance of the TC may be decreased appreciably by increasing its thickness, but increased thickness generally has a strongly negative impact on TC transmissivity characteristics and cost. [0233]
  • Means for Decreasing the Effective Resistance of The TC's [0234]
  • A desirable means of imparting a relatively high effective conductivity to a TC comprises depositing a pattern of a highly conductive material over, under, or within it (or some combination). Commercially available TC's such as half-wave ITO or doped tin oxide (DTO) can be used and modified by adding internal busbars according to the present invention. As shown in FIGS. 20A and 20B, e.g., the pattern can be formed as lines across the substrate. These lines may or may not intersect. The lines or patterns may be referred to as internal busbars (IB's). FIG. 20A shows a [0235] substrate 2001 made of, for example, glass, coated with a transparent conductive coating 2002. Internal busbars 2003 are formed on conductive coating 2002, FIG. 20B shows additional internal busbars 2004 transverse to internal busbars 2003.
  • It is important to ensure that the materials used for the internal busbars (IB) of the present invention do not react with the cell components. That is, the internal busbars should be chemically and electrochemically isolated from the reactive layers of the cell. Reactive layers are the electrolyte, the ion insertion electrodes, and the electrochromic layers. In these layers, chemical and physical reactions take place when the cell is colored or bleached. [0236]
  • The chemical and electrochemical isolation can be by any convenient means such as, for example, by interposing a barrier layer between the IB and the reactive layer. The property of being not ionically conductive is a requirement of the optical passivation layer so that, when a voltage is applied to the finished cell for coloring or bleaching, no ion transport takes place from any of the cell components to the internal busbars and vice versa. [0237]
  • As described below and in the figures, the isolated IB's of this invention are connected to the conductive layers by connecting portions that are electrically conductive. Accordingly, the IB's of this invention can provide substantial improvement of the electrical properties of the conductive layer while not being in contact with the layer. [0238]
  • A calculation of the effective sheet resistance corresponding to a pattern consisting of parallel lines on a transparent conductor was performed. The physical dimensions of these internal busbars (e.g., their thickness (or height), width, length, resistivity) along with the underlying transparent conductor characteristics, determine the overall effective sheet resistance. Tables 1A, 1B, and 1C below show the calculated effective sheet resistance of the substrates for various values of the relevant parameters. The calculations were made for 5 cm×5 cm square substrates traversed by five (n=5, or “N[0239] 5”) parallel internal busbars, each of width ws and height hs. For these calculations, the strips were assumed to be composed of Pt-metal (σ=0.96×105(Ωcm)−1). The effective sheet resistance was taken as the resistance that would be measured between an electrode connected on one full side of the square and another connected to the opposite full side. It should be noted that the calculations can be repeated for a grid pattern which may consist of curved lines or non-uniformly dimensioned (e.g., in width and thickness) conductive line patterns.
    TABLE 1A
    hs\ws ws
    hs 0.01 mm 0.05 mm 0.1 mm 0.15 mm
    100 nm 13.29 13.448 13.396 13.344
    1 μm 12.526 9.721 7.595 6.232
    2 μm 11.683 7.595 5.283 4.051
    3 μm 10.946 6.232 4.051 3.001
    4 μm 10.297 5.283 3.284 2.383
    0.1 mm 1.538 0.339 0.171 0.115
  • Table 1A. Calculated effective sheet resistances Ω/▪ for a system comprising 3 strips, where each strip possesses the dimensions (h[0240] s, ws) given in the Table.
    TABLE 1B
    hs\Ns Ns
    hs 1 2 3 4 5
    100 nm 13.448 13.396 13.344 13.293 13.243
     1 μm 9.721 7.595 6.232 5.283 4.586
     2 μm 7.595 5.283 4.051 3.284 2.762
     3 μm 6.232 4.051 3.001 2.383 1.976
     4 μm 5.283 3.284 2.383 1.87 1.538
    0.1 mm 0.339 0.171 0.115 0.086 0.069
  • Table 1B. Calculated effective sheet resistances Ω/▪ for a system comprising Ns strips, where each strip possesses a width of 0.15 mm and a height, h[0241] s, as indicated in the Table.
    TABLE 10
    ws\Ns Ns
    ws 1 2 3 4 5
    0.01 mm 12.232 11.181 10.297 9.543 8.891
    0.05 mm 8.891 6.628 5.283 4.392 3.758
     0.1 mm 6.628 4.392 3.284 2.623 2.183
    0.15 mm 5.283 3.284 2.383 1.87 1.538
  • Table 1C. Calculated effective sheet resistances Ω/▪ for a system comprising N[0242] s strips, where each strip possesses a height of 4 μm and a width, ws, as indicated in the Table.
  • The effect of size on the conductance of a 15 Ω/▪ (TEC 15) substrate with internal busbars is shown in Tables 2A and 2B below. [0243]
  • Two different systems are considered: [0244]
  • System A: IB's comprise Pt-strips (σ=0.96×10[0245] 5 (Ω·cm)31 1), each 0.15 mm wide and 41 μm high; and
  • System B: IB's comprise strips of DuPont 7713 Frit with a sheet resistance of R[0246] s=3 m Ω/▪ at 25 μm thickness. Each strip is 1.5 mm wide and 25 μm high.
  • The number, N[0247] s, of IB's is such that there is a fixed spacing of 1 cm between busbars. Edge busbars are not represented in the calculations (so, e.g., for a L cm×L cm system, there are (L−l) IB's). In all cases, the underlying conducting sheet possesses a sheet resistance of 15 Ω/▪.
    TABLE 2A
    Calculated effective sheet resistance for
    Systems A and B
    RSheet for Rsheet for
    Substrate Area System “A” System “B”
    5 cm × 5 cm 1.90 Ω/▪ 0.0250 Ω/▪
    10 cm × 10 cm 1.71 Ω/▪ 0.0222 Ω/▪
    30 cm × 30 cm 1.60 Ω/▪ 0.0207 Ω/▪
    100 cm × 100 cm 1.57 Ω/▪ 0.0202 Ω/▪
  • The effective sheet resistance is useful for comparing substrates of comparable size. However, an effective resistance (R), defined as the effective sheet resistance multiplied by the area of the substrate (thus possessing units of Ω·cm[0248] 2/▪), is more useful for comparing substrates of different sizes. Table 2B comprises the data for the effective resistance (R), for each sheet, as a function of substrate size.
    TABLE 2B
    Calculated effective resistances for Systems
    A and B.
    Effective Effective
    Resistance Resistance
    for System for System
    Substrate Area “A” “B”
    5 cm × 5 cm 47.4 Ω · cm2/▪ 0.624 Ω · cm2/▪
    10 cm × 10 cm 171 Ω · cm2/▪ 2.22 Ω · cm2/▪
    30 cm × 30 cm 1440 Ω · cm2/▪ 18.6 Ω · cm2/▪
    100 cm × 100 cm 15700 Ω · cm2/▪ 202 Ω · cm2/▪
  • It is desired that the width of the internal busbars should be small so that the active area of the EC device can be maximized. Further, such narrow widths also minimize optical interference to viewing through EC devices to which such internal busbars are incorporated. Thus, narrow widths are less obtrusive to vision. [0249]
  • As used herein, unless specified to the contrary, the descriptors “narrow or wide” refer to a “width” dimension parallel to the surface of the feature being described, while the descriptors “thin or thick” refer to a “thickness” dimension orthogonal to the surface of the feature being described. [0250]
  • A preferred geometry of the IB's include patterns which are greater than about 1 μm in thickness, and most preferably greater than about 10 μm in thickness. Although any convenient material can be used and formed by any convenient technology, materials and technologies that allow such thick IB's to be deposited are preferred. Examples of materials which are easy to deposit in these dimensions are typically conductive inks, pastes, and frits. Examples of the methods are described below. [0251]
  • Generally, the overall conductivity of the substrate does not depend appreciably on whether the conductive electrode coating is over the grid, around the grid, under the grid, or in some such combination. In the present invention, if the grid is deposited on the surface of the transparent conductor, the grid should be prevented from reacting or corroding in the device through the use of a protective barrier or passivation coating. The construction and materials of such a barrier coating depends upon the degree of reactivity of the grid material at the potentials encountered during device operation. [0252]
  • The internal busbars of the present invention may not be directly connected to other busbars such as edge busbars or such signal leads. The internal busbars of the present invention can be termed “floating”busbars. The signals are generally conducted to the internal busbars of the present invention by the conductive layer that is in contact with them. By such contact, the conductive layer's conductive is effectively lowered because the internal busbars of the present invention have lower conductivity than the conductive layer they are in contact with. The IB's of the present invention can be optionally connected to other busbars described above, to other IB's, or to electrical leads. However, as discussed below, an IB of the present invention can nevertheless receive an applied signal by the IB's being “bridged” to other voltage sources through the conductivity of the conductive layer the IB is in contact with. There are applications such as, for example, those that call for specific signals being applied to specific internal busbars where the internal busbars of the present invention can optionally be directly connected to a signal source. [0253]
  • In addition to a variety of lateral geometries, the IB's can occupy a variety of transverse locations in a device. For example, a pattern may be deposited on top of the TC. In a device of the form[0254]
  • Glass|TC1|electrolyte/redox species|EC|TC2|Glass
  • (where EC refers to an electrochromic film), for example, one may deposit a grid pattern on TC[0255] 1, on TC2, or on both TC's. Naturally, the height of a grid on TC1 should be significantly less than the cell gap (i.e., the thickness of the electrolyte/redox species medium), preferably much less. For a grid deposited on TC2, one must ensure that the thickness, morphology, and chemistry of the grid do not adversely affect the EC film. Regarding thickness, if the thickness of the grid is much less than that of the EC film, then the grid has little effect on the shape of the EC film. If the thickness of the grid is on the order of or greater than that of the EC film, then the EC film may often form a noticeable “relief” of the grid pattern (or it may even form in separate areas defined by the grid pattern).
  • The durability of devices with the IB grid of the present invention generally should be similar to devices without the IB grid. Any durability test should yield the same result with or without the grid. That is, the addition of the internal busbars of the present invention should not affect the reliability and durability of the devices. Accordingly, results of any durability tests to qualify a device for a particular application are likely transferable, or can be anticipated to be the same if such tests are repeated with the devices having internal busbars. Because durability is one of the key issues involved in developing a commercially viable device, this is an important parameter. To ensure durability of these devices, it has been discovered that it is preferred to deposit a passivation layer on top of the internal busbars, particularly if the IB's are deposited on top of the transparent ECE's. Materials for passivation are described below. [0256]
  • As shown in FIG. 21, the “effective height” of the grid may be reduced by embedding the grid conductor partially in the TC and substrate. [0257] Internal busbar conductors 2102 are embedded in substrate 2101. The formation of internal busbar conductor 2102 may be done by any convenient way such as, for example, by etching or ablating away a desired pattern in the substrate and then depositing the desired grid material. The effective height of the grid may be reduced by embedding it partially in the glass as well as the TC. One can etch or ablate away consecutively the TC coating and the substrate, followed by depositing the desired grid material. Alternatively, one can deposit the grid onto, or embed the grid into, the glass before the TC is deposited. The portion of busbar conductors 2102 that are above the surface plane of substrate 2101 is removed until the surface and the busbar conductors are at substantially the same plane 2103.
  • In one embodiment, the grid is partially embedded into the glass and then the surface is planarized by, for example, polishing to produce a structure as shown in the process in FIG. 21. Planarizing may also be done by depositing additional material on to the substrate so that the top surface of this added material is coplanar with the grid. Although FIG. 21 shows [0258] conductors 2102 having circular cross section such as commonly found in a wire, it could be of another convenient shape, such as rectangular. Additionally material can be deposited, for example, from solutions, or by physical vapor deposition, etc. Some examples of such materials are polyimide, sol-gel deposited oxides and organic/inorganic hybrids.
  • A TC is then deposited on the resulting planarized surface and the resulting glass|TC substrates used in the same manner as they are typically used. This process of the present invention has the distinct advantage that the more chemically active components of the device such as the EC film and the electrolyte are not directly exposed to the IB grid material. [0259]
  • Except for the glass substrates, the layers in single substrate devices (See, for example, FIG. 1E) are generally each quite thin (typically in the 100's of nm). It is therefore particularly preferred to use IB's which are fully embedded under the TC in such devices. The IB on the outer TC ([0260] layer 103′ of FIG. 1E) could consequentially be of any thickness since it will protrude on the outside of the device.
  • Whether it is desirable to include IB's on one or both TC's in a device depends on a variety of factors, including the required response time and coloration uniformity characteristics and the cost of manufacturing the devices. Devices generally display faster response times and greater coloration uniformity with the IB's implemented on both TC's. [0261]
  • IB Dimensions [0262]
  • The dimensions of the IB's width and depth can be varied throughout a substrate. As shown in FIG. 22, [0263] EC device 2210 has conductive transparent substrate 2201 transversed by narrower internal busbars 2202 and wider internal busbars 2203. Narrower internal busbars 2202 and wider internal busbars 2203 are separated by gaps 2208 from edge busbar 2204. Gaps 2208 are bridged by conductive transparent substrate 2201. Narrower internal busbars 2202 and wider internal busbars 2203 optionally connect directly to edge busbar 2204.
  • By combining, for example, narrow and wide IB's one can enhance the conductivity of the substrate while maximizing its transmission. However, while incorporating the use of wider IB's decreases their resistance (and thus advantageously decreases the effective resistance of the TC), it also affects the apparent transmission of the device. The transverse or primarily transverse direction is usually the direction of most importance for the optical properties of the devices. Accordingly, increasing the depth (or height) of the IB's is advantageous when compared to increasing the width of the IB because increasing the depth will typically have a much smaller adverse effect on the cosmetic appearance and/or the apparent transmission of the devices than increasing the width. [0264]
  • Another component of the present invention is the use of IB's which will be optically less prominent, by making the IB's much deeper than they are wide. For example, defining the aspect ratio, r[0265] 1b, as the effective width of the internal busbar structure divided by its effective height (thickness), it is generally desirable to have r1b smaller than 1, for optical transmission applications where a viewing path is through the surface on which is deposited the busbar structure.
  • The reason is that, if one is viewing parallel to the height (thickness) of the IB, then increasing the thickness while the other dimensions of the IB remain constant does not substantially affect the appearance of the device; but such increased thickness does desirably reduce the resistance of the IB (and therefore desirably reduces the effective resistance of the corresponding TC). It is therefore generally desirable that the height direction of the IB's be parallel to the primary viewing direction for such applications. [0266]
  • Most commonly, this means that the height direction of the IB's should be transverse to the plane of the substrates of the device. But for some devices such as, for example, an automotive windshield, the primary viewing direction might be at some angle to the approximate plane of the windshield. In such applications it would be preferable to implement the IB's such that their height direction is parallel to such slanted viewing direction. As shown in FIG. 23, [0267] device 2301 has internal busbars 2302 embedded in substrate 2303 at an angle parallel to the viewing direction 2305.
  • Another consideration is the need to provide a contiguous channel within the device that allows the electrolyte fluid to flow throughout the gap during filling in order to minimize manufacturing difficulties. Referring to FIG. 31A, a [0268] device 3101 has internal busbars 3102 disposed such that no internal busbar blocks a contiguous channel. Internal busbars 3102 are in contact with only one device edge and extend only to the other device edge, thereby forming a contiguous channel 3103. If the device is filled with the electrolyte after edge sealing (such as by vacuum back-filling), only one fill hole is required to perform the filling task.
  • Similarly, FIG. 31B shows a [0269] device 3110 where internal busbars can extend from one device edge to the other device edge. The internal busbars are arranged in a staggered configuration. Consequently, although internal busbars 3102′ might extend from one device edge to the other device edge, and each internal busbar 3102′ might be thicker than one half the gap distance, their staggered arrangement forms a contiguous channel 3103′ which allows easy filling of device 3110, with electrolyte fluid, without interruption.
  • FIG. 31C shows a [0270] device 3120 which has internal busbars 3102″ that can extend from one device edge to the other device edge, and that can be in an overlapping relation. Internal busbars 3102″ are, however, in alternate ramped geometries which form a contiguous channel 3102″ which allows easy filling of device 3120, with electrolyte fluid, without interruption.
  • FIGS. 31B and 31C show embodiments of the present invention in which the sum of the thicknesses of the internal busbars is larger than the cell gap distance. Yet, the innovative geometries of the present invention allows such internal busbars' use without any problems of electrical shorting or interrupted electrolyte fluid continuity. As described above, the width of the internal busbars should be small so that the active area of the overall EC device can be maximized. The resistance of internal busbars with narrow width can be nonetheless low because the height (thickness) of the internal busbars can be made effectively thick. As described above, geometries and patterns that form IB's having thicknesses greater than about 1 μm are preferred, and most preferred are thicknesses greater than about 10 μm. FIGS. 31B and 31C show how such thicker dimensions can be used without causing the gap distance to be disadvantageously thick. [0271]
  • Auxiliary Uses for IB's [0272]
  • The IB's included in devices under the present invention may be used for additional purposes, and these may or may not require modification of the IB design. For example, the IB's may be used as Joule heating elements for purposes such as de-fogging. For this purpose, it is desirable to pass current through the IB's independently of current being used to color or bleach the device. [0273]
  • One means for implementing this purpose according to the present invention includes providing for separate addressing of the two ends of a set of IB strips. FIG. 24 shows a [0274] device 2410 with an EC assembly 2401 having two internal busbars 2402 over the layers of TC 2403. Applying a voltage V1 and V2 of equal values across the two ends will induce a current flow along each of the internal busbars 2402 but will not result in EC activity in device 2410 because, with equal voltage potentials at each end, there is no current path or potential drop transverse to the device. If it is desired that EC activity and heating occur contemporaneously, the signals can be adjusted accordingly to provide for a current path and a potential drop transverse to the device by changing V1 and V2 to be unequal. For most EC devices the voltage difference needed between V1 and V2 is less than 2 volts.
  • If IB's are implemented on both TC's of a window-type device, separate heating of both TC's without inducing EC activity requires balancing of the lateral voltage potentials so that there is no transverse potential. If simultaneous coloring is desired, the potentials can be adjusted accordingly. [0275]
  • The IB's may also be used as antennae for electromagnetic signals. For example, one can use a strip IB as a monopole antenna, letting one end float electrically and connecting the other end to the appropriate signal processing electronics such as, for example, a radio receiver. To obtain a larger signal, the signals from a set of strip IB's forming well known antennae geometries may be combined and the combined signal appropriately processed. Other patterns of IB's forming well known antennae geometries may be used to optimize the antenna functionality. If desired, IB's may also be used as transmitters following well known transmitter grid geometries. [0276]
  • IB's may also be used to provide or enhance the effective shielding from unwanted electromagnetic waves or interference. The penetration depth (or “skin depth”) of electromagnetic waves into the devices may be decreased by increasing the effective conductivity of the TC layers. In addition, specific IB patterns may be employed such as, for example, forming a part of a Faraday cage to provide optimal shielding for a particular class of electromagnetic waves. [0277]
  • Separately-Addressable IB's [0278]
  • In an embodiment of the present invention, IB's form a single addressable array. FIG. 25A shows a [0279] device 2501 with internal busbars 2505 arranged at an angle to and proximate to a busbar 2507 with proximate gaps 2508 between busbar 2507 and each internal busbar 2505. Proximate gaps 2508 are bridged by conductive layer 2509 on substrate 2510. Busbar 2507 can be an internal busbar or an edge busbar. Busbar 2507 and internal busbars 2505 form a single addressable array 2503 powered by a conductor 2504. Optionally, each internal busbar 2505 is directly connected to busbar 2507.
  • In another embodiment of the present invention, the IB's are made to be separately addressable. FIG. 25B shows a [0280] device 2502 with separately addressable internal busbars 2506, each separately powered by separate conductors 2504.
  • One can use the separately addressable IB's to obtain an added measure of control over the spatial distribution of the coloring and/or bleaching of an EC device. Whether one needs to be able to address separately the IB's on one of the TC's or on both of the TC's depends upon the degree of control required. [0281]
  • One can utilize the separately addressable busbars (or separately addressable busbar groups) to have an EC device (e.g., a sunroof or windshield) that has differential coloration from one side to the other, or from top to bottom, etc. Such individual control can produce a number of effects such as, for example, a gradient effect, a shade effect, or a geometric pattern effect. [0282]
  • One can employ light sensors and use the signals from the sensors to determine the appropriate signals to apply to the separately addressable IB's to obtain the desired spatial distribution of coloring or bleaching. For example, for an automotive sunroof, one can use light sensors to effectively track the position and intensity of the sun and then color more deeply the appropriate regions of the sunroof. In addition, information (obtained either automatically or manually) regarding the presence and positions of occupants of the automobile may be combined with the signals from the light sensors to determine the appropriate signals to apply to the separately addressable IB's to obtain an appropriate coloring or bleaching pattern. The light sensors should be situated such that they provide effective indications of the light intensity from a variety of directions. The presence and positions of occupants of the automobile may, for example, be sensed via transducers in the seats and/or by detecting the status of the seatbelts. [0283]
  • Under the present invention, a variety of “Smart Devices” can be made by using the signals derived from a system of sensors to determine the appropriate drive signals to be applied to the individually-addressable IB's and edge busbars in EC devices. [0284]
  • Conductive frits are usually pastes and liquids (also termed inks) of a conductive material in a carrier. The carrier typically cures or typically is eliminated during a post-application process such as subjecting to elevated temperatures. Conductive frits for IB can be deposited by any convenient method such as, for example, X-Y Motor Painting/Screening, Doctor Blading/Silk Screening/Circuit Printing, Chemical Vapor Deposition and Physical Vapor Deposition (CVD and PVD): [0285]
  • 1. X-Y Motor Painting/Screening: For certain conductive materials, which are applied in the form of viscous liquids, a programmable X-Y table with a fluid dispenser may be utilized to apply the desired pattern to the substrate. The thickness and width of the conductive line is determined by factors such as the size of the dispenser tip opening, the viscosity of the fluid, the dispenser line pressure and the lateral speed of the dispensing tip relative to the substrate, and the distance between the dispensing tip and the substrate. Low viscosity molten metals may also be used for the busbars. These could be sprayed or processed by soldering or welding. These methods could be assisted by ultrasound or other energy imparting means to promote uniformity and/or better adhesion to the substrate. [0286]
  • 2. Doctor Blading/Silk Screening/Circuit Printing: This method involves the forcing of a viscous liquid through narrow openings in an appropriate mask, to be deposited on a substrate in a pattern determined by the mask design. This mask may consist of any type of tape, film, or other mask material, such as a silk-screen-like item, placed on top of the substrate, with channels or isolated voids in a desired pattern. An excess of the fluid is then placed at one end of the mask, then a uniform, flat tool (such as a “squeegee” or similar implement) is dragged across the mask, forcing the fluid through the pattern troughs onto the substrate. [0287]
  • Another alternative is to silkscreen, or otherwise use a doctor blade to deposit uniform layers of photoprintable thick film compositions. The internal busbar pattern is then formed by exposing the deposited film to certain wavelengths of light through masks and followed by chemical processing. The passivation materials for internal busbars such as certain dielectric materials can be similarly processed. The advantage of this over conventional silkscreening is to get finer resolution and/or higher densities of conductive lines. [0288]
  • 3. Chemical Vapor Deposition and Physical Vapor Deposition (CVD and PVD): CVD is a known process which deposits a coating by decomposing a chemical vapor to provide the depositing material. PVD is a known process which deposits a coating by vaporizing a material and then redepositing this in a substrate in a vacuum chamber. CVD and PVD may be assisted by energy imparting sources such as plasma, ionized beams, microwave, etc. [0289]
  • In these methods, patterns are applied by placing either a shadow mask over the substrate and coating directly onto the surface, or by using photolithographic technology to apply a photoresist mask to the substrate, coating that assembly with metal, and then stripping the photoresist layer away, leaving the metal pattern. [0290]
  • Some exemplary frit, inks and conductive adhesives that may be employed in this invention include: [0291]
  • Frits [0292]
  • DuPont Electronic Materials, Wilmington, Del., Silver-Bearing Conductors: DuPont Silver Thick Film Composition, Nos. 1991, 1992, 1993, 1997; DuPont Silver Thick Film Composition, #7713; and DuPont Solamet Photovoltaic Compositions such as #E64885-52A. [0293]
  • DuPont Gold-Bearing Conductors. [0294]
  • DuPont Fodel Photoprintable Conductors DC201 and DC010. [0295]
  • Ferro Silver Paste FX 33-246 available from Ferro Inc., Santa Barbra, Calif. [0296]
  • Metal Inks [0297]
  • Engelhard Electronic Materials, East Newark, N.J., Metallo-Organic Inks: Platinum Inks such as #05X, Gold Inks such as #A3622, and Silver Inks such as #R2/321 and low temperature cured flexible materials such as #M5860. [0298]
  • Conductive Epoxies, Silicones, etc. [0299]
  • Grace Specialty Polymers, Emerson & Cuming Inc. (Woburn, Mass.), Minico M 4200 Flexible Silver Buss Bar; 4xxx series materials; Eccocoat CT 5030 A/B Flexible/Rigid Buss Bar; Minico M 6xxx series silver/copper materials. [0300]
  • When devices are fabricated that use two substrates, such as those described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,142,407, 5,241,411 and 4,761,061, one or both of the substrates may have added internal busbars according to the present invention. [0301]
  • FIGS. 26A and 26B show two configurations of various grid patterns according to the present invention that do not extend to the edges. FIG. 26A shows a [0302] device 2608 having a perimeter busbar 2602 on substrate 2601. Substrate 2601 has a conductive layer 2615 on its surface. A series of internal busbars 2603 form a crosshatch pattern. Internal busbars 2603 can be on, in, and/or below conductive layer 2615. The perimeters of each internal busbar 2603 are in contact with conductive layer 2615.
  • FIG. 26B shows a [0303] device 2609 having a series of internal busbars 2604 forming a parallel pattern. Neither series of internal busbars 2603 or 2604 touch perimeter busbar 2602. As a result, when an EC device is fabricated using two substrates, the grid pattern can be completely enclosed in the device. The internal busbars conduct a current that travels from the perimeter conductor through the conductive layer 2615 to the internal busbar. This may be advantageous, since the adhesive used to seal the edges of the two substrates need not be modified in composition and no change in processing parameters is needed for ensuring good adhesion to the internal busbars and for accommodating the change in substrate topography.
  • FIG. 26C shows a [0304] device 2610 having a coiling internal busbar 2605 which is in contact with conductive layer 2615 at the entire perimeter of internal busbar 2605. Coiling internal busbar 2605 has higher conductivity than conductive layer 2615, which serves to lower the overall resistance of conductive layer 2615, thereby making more homogeneous the applied signal to conductive layer 2615. Coiling internal busbar 2605 can stand alone as shown. Coiling internal busbar 2605 also can be formed in close proximity at its outer coil to a perimeter busbar (not shown). Alternatively, the coiling internal busbar can be attached directly to a signal power by leaving a portion of the coiling internal busbar exposed and attaching a signal wire to the exposed portion.
  • Since the current at the perimeter has to flow only through gaps of a short distance through the transparent conductors to the internal busbars of FIGS. 26A, 26B, and [0305] 26C, the resistance drop will be negligibly small across such gaps. This use of the transparent conductor to connect an internal busbar to the primary busbar has not been discussed or disclosed in any prior art described above.
  • A passivation layer may be deposited using similar techniques described previously. If certain materials and methods are used to deposit the grid pattern such as silk-screening of metal frits, then post-treatment such as curing or hardening with time, heat, radiation (UV, visible, IR, microwave) may be required. The passivation layer is typically deposited after the above post-treatment. Similar types of post-treatment procedures may be required to harden the passivation layer. [0306]
  • The post-treatment for the grid pattern may also result in an in-situ formation of a passivation layer on the surface. The in-situ formed surface may consist of a phase separated inert material, an oxidize portion, a nitride portion, etc. This will also depend on the atmosphere and temperature conditions under which such post-treatment is carried out. This passivation layer may be sufficiently passivating to be incorporated in these devices. Treatment where a part of the exposed grid pattern becomes passivated could also be done when the grid patterns are deposited by physical and chemical vapor deposition. The surface of these may be passivated using oxidation, nitriding, heat, laser, plasma, or ion bombardment assisted treatments. The passivation layer may consist of organics, inorganics or hybrid materials. Adhesives such as, for example, non-conducting epoxy adhesives, urethanes, acrylates, or polyesters could be deposited for passivation. These may be the same materials that are used for making device seals. The materials may be cured by heat and/or radiation, such as UV, IR or microwave. The viscosity and the application procedure can be adjusted so that the desired thickness is obtained. [0307]
  • The materials can be applied by any convenient method such as, for example, being screened, dispensed, sprayed, or painted. Sol-gel methods could also be used to deposit oxides and polyceramics as passivation layers. Examples of such materials are alcoholic or non-alcoholic based solutions of metal alkoxides, nitrides, halides, or mixtures thereof, or solutions of reactive metallic precursors with organic complexing agents. Further, these oxides may be inert such as silica or could be conducting such as indium tin oxide and doped tin oxide. Preferably the passivating materials should be non-conductive, both ionically and electronically. Electronically conducting materials which may be used as passivating materials are those which are used in making transparent ECE's such as doped tin oxide and indium tin oxide. They should not also be attacked, swelled, or interact with the layers that come in contact with such as electrochromic layers, ion storage layers, electrolytes, etc. Examples of some commercial encapsulants/passivation layers that could be silk-screened include #A3840, #A3560, and #A3563, made by Engelhard. An example of a photoprintable passivation layer is Fodel DG211 from DuPont Electronic Materials. [0308]
  • Electrochromic devices use several transparent conductors that are not reactive while the other components such as electrochromic layers, counterelectrodes, and redox materials in the electrolyte necessarily participate in the electrochemical activity required for electrochromic operation. Thus, non-reactive materials are defined as those that lie outside the electrochemical potential range that is utilized for operating the EC device. Also materials that are insulators and/or do not transmit or get intercalated with ions under the above operating conditions and will not change their physical properties in the cell (such as dissolution in the liquid electrolyte if used) can also be considered as non-active. Materials such as many polymers such as epoxies, polyimides, acrylics, urethanes, and inorganics such as dense silica, alumina, several other oxides, silicates, and organo-silicates can be also considered non-reactive. For some devices, metals such as gold and platinum may also be considered non-reactive. Thus these metals may be used for busbars without additional passivation layers. There may even be thick layers of transparent conductors such as ITO, in a thickness that is conductive enough for the busbar, but not transmissive enough to be called TC (transparent conductor). [0309]
  • For designs where the internal busbars extend to the perimeter edge of the substrate, the passivation layer may extend to the edge of the substrate, or stop short of the edge so as to only be in the interior of the device. In the latter case, the internal busbars can be electrically contacted with the edge busbars (for example by using wires, tapes, conductive adhesives, solders, or wire clips). The novel edge busbars of the present invention may also be used in conjunction with the novel internal busbars of the present invention. [0310]
  • The conductivity of the substrate can also be enhanced through the use of a wire pattern embedded in a substrate (the substrate may be constructed from glass, plastic, or some other material). This wire pattern substitutes for the grid pattern described above. If the substrate is essentially electrically insulating, and if the conductive pattern is entirely embedded in the insulating substrate, then it is generally necessary to connect electrically the conductive pattern and the transparent conductor. This may be done, for example, by drilling holes though the substrate up to the metal grid and then filling the holes with a conductive material. FIGS. 27A, 27B, [0311] 28, and 29 illustrate this concept, including different methods of ensuring transparent conductor/plug contact.
  • FIGS. 27A and 27B show a [0312] device 2710 with a substrate 2705 covered with a transparent conductor layer 2704. Internal busbar conductors 2702 are embedded in substrate 2705. Conductive plugs 2703 lead from the surface of device 2710 to electrically contact internal busbar conductors 2702. In this example, transparent conductor layer 2704 was applied after the holes for plugs 2703 were made but before plugs 2703 were formed.
  • FIG. 28 shows a [0313] device 2801 formed by attaching internal busbars 2802 to a surface 2807 of a substrate 2803. Holes 2805 are formed effective to extend from an opposite surface 2808 of substrate 2803 to internal busbars 2802. Conductive plugs 2804 are formed effective to extend from internal busbars 2802 to opposite surface 2808. Transparent conductive layer 2806 is then formed on opposite surface 2808, contacting conductive plugs 2804, thereby being in electrical contact with internal busbars 2802.
  • FIG. 29 shows a [0314] device 2901 where direct addressing of the internal busbar conductor was not necessary. Device 2901 has an internal busbar conductor 2902 embedded in substrate 2904. A conductive layer 2903 provides electrical contact between transparent layer 2905 and internal busbar conductor 2902. Inert filler plug 2906 fills the hole. Transparent conductor 2905 is applied after the hole that provide access to internal busbar conductor 2902 is made. Then conductive layer 2903 is formed in the hole. Finally, inert filler plug 2906 is formed.
  • If the conductive pattern is not entirely embedded in the substrate (i.e., if it contacts the transparent conductor) or if the substrate is sufficiently conductive, a separate conductor is generally not necessary. [0315]
  • Internal busbars can also be used to make devices with those substrates on which only low conductivity transparent ECE's can be deposited. Typically, transparent ECE's such as indium tin oxide and doped tin oxide are deposited at high temperatures (in excess of 200° C.) to get good conductivity. Most of those materials, when deposited on plastics, at lower temperatures, are less conductive. Thus, the use of EB's as described above in conjunction with lower conductivity transparent ECE's would result in high conductivity substrates which will be attractive for electrochromic devices. [0316]
  • The Examples which follow are intended as an illustration of certain preferred embodiments of the invention, and no limitation of the invention is implied. [0317]
  • Example 3
  • Strips of silver frit paste (DuPont # 7713) were deposited by silk-screening onto a 3 inch×3 inch (7.5 cm×7.5 cm) [0318] TEC 15 substrate. The substrate was then heated under ambient atmosphere according to the following four step procedure;
  • Step 1: Temperature raised from 25° C. to 100° C. at 10° C./min and held at 100° C. for 15 minutes. [0319]
  • Step 2: Temperature raised from 100° C. to 325° C. at 10° C./min and held at 325° C. for 10 minutes. [0320]
  • Step 3: Temperature raised from 325° C. to 600° C. at 10° C./min and held at 600° C. for 10 minutes. [0321]
  • Step 4: Temperature lowered from 600° C. to 25° C. at 10° C./min. [0322]
  • After firing the width and depth of the silver lines were measured using surface profilometry and found to be 0.2″ (5.1 mm) wide and 15 μm deep. The spacing between the lines was 1.0″ (25.4 mm). [0323]
  • Examples 4, 5, 6, 7, and Comparative Example 3C
  • The “TEC-Glass” products, commercially available from Libby-Owens-Ford Co. (Toledo, Ohio), are manufactured by an on-line chemical vapor deposition process. This process pyrolytically deposits onto clear float glass a multi-layer thin film structure, which includes a microscopically thin coating of fluorine-doped tin oxide (having a fine grain uniform structure) with additional undercoating thin film layers disposed between the fluorine-doped tin oxide layer and the underlying glass substrate. This structure inhibits reflected color and increases light transmittance. The resulting “TEC-Glass”product is a non-iridescent glass structure having a haze within the range of from about 0.1% to about 5%; a sheet resistance within the range of from about 7 to about 1000 ohms per square or greater; a daylight transmission within the range of from about 77% to about 87%; a solar transmission within the range of from about 64% to about 80%; and an infrared reflectance at a wavelength of about 10 μm within the range of from about 30% to about 87%. [0324]
  • A [0325] TEC 15 substrate (3 inch×3 inch; 7.5 cm×7.5 cm) was silk-screened with silver paste as described in Example 1, where the length of the silver strip was incrementally varied in such a manner as to leave an equal distance between edges, at right angles to the strips, of the glass substrate as shown in FIG. 26B. The distances of the silver strip from the edge for Examples 4, 5, 6, and 7 are 0.0 mm, 1.0 mm, 3.0 mm, and 7.0 mm respectively. The resistance of the substrate was measured by soldering a metal strip 2 mm wide at both edges of the substrate which were at right angles to the internal silver strips to serve as a representative portion of a perimeter busbar. By applying a voltage across the soldered strips the resistance was measured for different increments of distance of the silver strip from the perimeter busbar. The results are listed in the following Table 3.
    TABLE 3
    Distance of
    Silver Strip Resistance of
    From Edge Substrate
    Example (mm) (Ω)
    4 0.0 0.1
    5 1.0 1.2
    6 3.0 1.9
    7 7.0 3.2
  • The Comparative Example 3C, a [0326] TEC 15 substrate with no internal silver busbars had a resistance of 15 Ω. By comparison, as shown in the table, Example 4, the substrate with internal silver strips extended fully to the perimeter busbars had a resistance of 0.1Ω. Even in Example 7, with the silver busbars as far as 7 mm from the perimeter busbar, the resistance is decreased to 3.2 Ω from the Comparative Example's 15Ω.
  • Example 8
  • Internal silver busbars were prepared as described in example 3, except that after the four step firing procedure the metal strips were over-coated with an epoxy based polymer for passivation and cured at 120° C. for one hour. [0327]
  • Comparative Example 4C
  • A 3″×3″ (7.5 cm×7.5 cm) [0328] TEC 15 substrate coated with 380 nanometers of WO3 according to the method set forth in U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,252,354, 5,457,218 and 5,277,986 and a counter electrode of TEC 15 of similar size was made into a cell using an epoxy seal containing 210μm spacers. The two electrodes were positioned so that they were slightly off-center exposing a region at either end for application of a metallic busbar. Prior to assembly the counter electrode had two holes drilled in it for application of the electrolyte. The cell was filled with electrolyte containing 0.01M LiClO4 and 0.05M ferrocene in a 60:40 volume % mixture of propylene carbonate and tetramethylene sulfone and the fill holes plugged with epoxy. The conductive surfaces which protruded from either side of the cell were ultrasonically soldered with lead-tin-cadmium-based solder. Wires were then attached to these contacts. The electrochromic performance of the device was determined by placing the cell in a spectrometer and following the color kinetics at 550 nm while applying a coloring potential of 1.3 volts followed by a bleaching potential of −0.3 volts. In the transmissive (bleached) state the cell had a transmission of 77% and in the fully colored state a transmission of 10% T. At a coloring potential of 1.3 volts the cell took 46 seconds to color from 70% T to 10% T and 47 seconds to bleach back to 70% T.
  • Examples 9, 10, 11 and Comparative Example 4C
  • Four electrochromic cells were prepared as described in comparative Example 4C where the composition of the electrodes were varied as follows; [0329]
  • Cell A, Comparative Example 4C, had conductive electrodes with no internal busbars. [0330]
  • Cell B, Example 9, had internal busbars on the working electrode (WO[0331] 3) only.
  • Cell C, Example 10, had internal busbars on the counter electrode only. [0332]
  • Cell D, Example 11, had internal busbars on the both electrodes. [0333]
  • In all cases, Examples 9, 10, and 11, the internal busbars were deposited as described in Example 8. The cells were colored at 1.3 volts for 90 seconds and bleached at −0.3 volts for 90 seconds. The color kinetic data for the cells is shown in the following Table 4: [0334]
    TABLE 4
    Time to color from Time to bleach from
    70% T to 10% T 10% T to 70% T
    Cell Seconds Seconds
    Cell A 89 89
    Cell B 74 65
    Cell C 89 89
    Cell D 56 58
  • Comparative Example 5C
  • An electrochromic cell was prepared as described in Example 8 with conductive electrodes which contained internal busbars without a passivation layer. The cell was cycled at 70° C. at a color potential of 1.3 volts for 15 seconds, long enough to colorize, followed by being bleached for 45 seconds at −0.3 volts. After 5,000 such cycles the cell showed visible reaction of the silver strips within the cell. This resulted in a degradation in the cell's optical properties. [0335]
  • Example 12
  • An electrochromic cell was prepared as described in Example 8, containing internal silver busbars, on both electrodes, with a protective epoxy overcoat. At a coloring potential of 1.3 volts the cell colored from 70% T to 10% T in 8 seconds. The cell was cycled at 70° C. under a coloring potential of 1.3 volts for 15 seconds and a bleach potential of −0.3 volts for 45 seconds. After 5,000 cycles the cell showed no visible reaction of the internal busbars in the cell nor degradation of the cell's electrochromic performance. [0336]
  • Example 13
  • Silver strips were deposited onto [0337] TEC 15 as described in example 3, and overcoated with a layer of indium tin oxide (ITO). The ITO was deposited by electron beam (E-beam) evaporation and deposited directly on top of the TEC 15 and the silver strip lines through the use of a mask. The E-beam target was an indium tin oxide composite and the thickness of the ITO layer thus formed was 500 nm. Two of these TEC 15 substrates having the described electrodes were used to make an electrochromic cell as described in example 9. Under a coloring potential of 1.3 volts the transmission at 550 nm changed from 76% T to 8% T. It took 14 seconds to modulate from 70% T to 10% T at 1.3 volts, while it took 23 seconds to bleach back to 70% T at −0.3 volts.
  • Example 13B
  • Silver strips were deposited onto [0338] TEC 15 as described in example 3, and overcoated with a layer of Sol-Gel derived antimony doped tin oxide (ADT). The ADT precursor was prepared as described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,525,624 and 5,457,218. The electrodes were made into an electrochromic cell as described in example 9. At a coloring potential of 1.3 volts the cell colored from 70% T to 10% T in 19 seconds. At a potential of −0.3 volts it bleached back to 70% T in 20 seconds.
  • Example 14
  • Fodel materials and processes (from DuPont) and the like can be used to deposit busbars which are less than 100 μm in width. These lines are practically invisible to the eye, depending on the distance between the eye and the substrate on which the lines are deposited. For example, a normal eye subtends a small enough angle with lines of widths of 100 μm from a distance of 19 inches that the line is not discernible (about 0.01 degrees). Thus, any angle equal to or smaller than 0.01 degrees can be considered as invisible. Such busbar widths that form these angles, depending upon the distance of the substrate from the observer, can be utilized with little or no interference with vision. For example, 50 μm wide lines (6 μm thick) spaced at a distance of 0.75 cm are expected to give the same overall conductivity to the substrates as lines which are 100 μm wide (6 μm thick) and spaced 1.5 cm. Both of these widths and line spacings are expected to give photopic transmissions in excess of 70% when deposited on conductive glass (such as TEC glass from LOF) with a resistance of 8 or more ohms/square. [0339]
  • Although the above description is for chromogenic windows, these principles can also be utilized to develop non-chromogenic windows which can be defrosted by applying an electrical voltage at the edges but without any visible obstruction from conductors in the center of the window. These windows can be used in various applications where frost-free characteristics are desired. Examples of such application are in aircraft and automotive windows and mirrors. For an automotive windshield, these can be deposited on glass before lamination. After lamination, preferably these lines reside inside of the laminated area so that they are not scratched. They can also be used for other windows and mirrors which are not laminated, and to further enhance their scratch resistance they may be coated with hard transparent materials (for example, see U.S. patent application No. 09/099,035, filed Jun. 18, 1998, which is incorporated herein by reference). Since high temperatures (typically 500 to 800° C.) are required to fire these lines, this could be accomplished simultaneously while the glass is being bent and/or strengthened (or tempered) which may be necessary for these products. As described above, based on the angular calculations, widths of these lines can be wider for rear automotive windows as compared to the windshields, since the latter are closer to the observer. Further, the material in these widths can also be used to deposit antennas on glass (such as automotive windows) which are invisible, i.e., the window appears transparent although a patterned antenna is printed using these conductors and processes. [0340]
  • Example 15 and Comparative Example 6C
  • Two 6″×3″ (15 cm×7.5 cm) sized electrochromic cells were prepared. [0341] TEC 15 was used as the transparent conductor in each cell. Example 15 had an internal busbar while Comparative Example 6C did not. The cell without the busbar, Comparative Example 6C, was assembled similarly to the assembly described in Comparative Example 4C. The spacing between the substrates, however, was 88 micrometers. The two electrodes were positioned with an offset so that about 0.25 inch (0.63 cm) of each electrode strip, at either of the 3″ (7.5 cm) ends of the substrates, was exposed. To these exposed edges, a solder was applied by a heated ultrasonic soldering system (Sunbonder from Sanwa Components USA, San Diego, Calif.). The solder used was Cerasolzer 186 (obtained from Sanwa Components US), and had an average thickness of about 20 micrometers.
  • The second cell, Example 15, also had a gap 88 micrometers thick and was made with both internal busbars and edge busbars as taught in this invention. In Example 15, edge busbars and an internal silver frit busbar were applied to three contiguous edges, via an x-y dispensing technique, similar to that shown in FIG. 33A. [0342]
  • The frit layers were fired with the four-step procedure as in Example 3 and then passivated as in Example 8 using a black colored bisphenol A based epoxy adhesive. This frit/passivation pattern was applied to both the substrates. The width of the frit line was about 0.7 mm and thickness of the frit line was between 10 and 15 micrometers. The thickness of the passivation layer was about 30 to 40 micrometers with a width of about 1.5 mm so as to completely cover the frit to form an encapsulation around the frit. One of the substrates was then coated with tungsten oxide, assembled, and filled as described in the Comparative Example 4C. The frit pattern was identical on both the substrates except that the frit line pattern was lightly offset so that the frit lines on the two substrates were next to each other rather than opposed or on top of each other. This was done to ensure that any local bumps would not lead to any electrical shorting and that the cell gap is maintained at 88 micrometers. [0343]
  • Similar to that geometry shown in FIG. 33B, the internal busbar was formed by one of the frit lines, while the other three frits formed an edge busbar since they were outside the cell seal area. Further, the soldered busbar which was applied in addition to the frit busbar on the edge, reinforced the conductivity on that edge, while providing a means to attach a soldered electrical lead. The silver frit and the soldered busbar were touching each other in this Example. [0344]
  • Example 15 and Comparative Example 6C were colored at 1.3 volts for 60 seconds and bleached at −0.3 volts for 60 seconds. The plots of transmission versus time are shown in FIG. 34A, and the concomitant current flow through the devices is shown in FIG. 34B. In FIG. 33B, DuPont Frit type 7713 was used to form the frit layers. It can be seen that in Comparative Example 6C, the cell without the internal busbar, the coloring reaction is slow and the depth of color is small. By contrast, in the cell with the internal busbar, Example 15, the coloring and bleaching reactions are faster and the depth of coloration is much higher because the internal busbars are able to supply much higher levels of current when needed during coloration and bleaching. Thus, devices that demand high currents any time during coloration or bleaching will particularly benefit from this invention. Typically, EC devices requiring currents in excess of 0.1 mA during coloration or bleaching will benefit most. [0345]
  • Intermittent Potential Circuitry [0346]
  • As described previously, the coloring voltage only needs to be applied intermittently, depending on the length of the color state memory, after sufficient coloration has been achieved. For example, if the memory of the device was longer than the color duration required for the particular application to be colored, then the coloring potential effectively could be applied just once and then turned off (i.e., the device is left in non-powered open circuit mode). The potential can then be applied again when the device's light transmission needs to change, e.g., while bleaching or changing its transmission to a different desired level. However, under certain circumstances, it might be necessary to keep the device in a desired state of transmission for periods that are longer than their color state memory. [0347]
  • In the present invention, consider for example the case where a coloring potential is initially applied which is removed after the device attains the desired color, i.e., the device is kept in an open circuit. The device is thus allowed to gradually bleach with time, for a period t[0348] 1, as a result of its limited color state memory. Before the device completely bleaches, the coloration potential is reapplied for a duration of time t2. This process can be continued indefinitely for as long as the device needs to be kept in the particular colored state before a different voltage is required to be applied to change the device's light transmission (e.g. bleach potential).
  • The period t[0349] 1, after which the coloration voltage is re-applied, depends in part on the extent of color change that is allowed before it might become obvious to the user that the device light transmission is changing. This allowable change in photopic transmission, all measured at 550 nm, for a window in a building or a car (e.g., a sunroof) is preferably in the range of from about (the difference (Tc1%-Tc2%), as in FIG. 35) 0.1% to about 20%, more preferably from about 1% to about 15%, and most preferably from about 5% to about 10% from the desired colored state. The above transmission criteria can also be used where the devices only color in the near infrared region, about 0.7 μm to about 2.5 μm. The change in light transmission can be solar transmission instead of photopic transmission. Furthermore, the light transmission wavelength can be selected in any conveniently selected range.
  • The process of this invention is explained referring to FIG. 35, where transmission vs. time and applied voltage vs. time is plotted for a typical EC device controlled by the present invention. A voltage V[0350] c is first applied to colored the window (as shown by the transmission T % falling, indicating that the light transmission is low). The voltage is then removed, as shown by a break in the voltage line, for a period of t1. During this time t1, the cell starts to bleach, as shown by the transmission T % rising. The time ti is related to the length of the color state memory for a particular EC device. To keep a window colored (after initial coloration), the coloring potential is reapplied for a period of t2 followed by the removal of power (holding period) for a period of t1. This alternating sequence is continued indefinitely, for as long as it is desired to keep the device in that desired state of transmission. The desired state is a range of transmission defined by Tc1% and Tc2 %. In this case, the total time tC is the overall time of coloration.
  • FIG. 35 also shows that the initial coloring voltage can be applied as an increasing linear ramp to a maximum potential V[0351] c. Alternatively, a step potential Vc can be applied. Another way to apply the potential is by imposing a maximum curent limitation. Either of these two modes, or a non-linear ramp, could be conveniently used. With increasing device area, it may be preferred to ramp the coloring and bleach potential so that the current densities at the edges can be lower. This also promotes a spatial uniformity in color change during coloration and bleaching. This is particularly noticeable as the device area increases. Also during the interval t2, the coloration potential (Vc) could be applied as a step potential (as shown), or it may be ramped from the open circuit potential of the device to Vc. It must be noted that Vc or Vb referes to the potential which the power supply attempts to apply to the EC cell and is also the limiting potential on the EC cell. Hence the EC cell has charateristics of an (RC) circuit, the potential of the cell (Vcell) only changes slowly as shown by the dashed line in FIG. 35.
  • One of the more important variables that affects t[0352] 1 and t2 is the device temperature. As an example, depending on the EC device and the components used, t1 at −20° C. could range from a few hours to several days or even months, while t1 at 70° C. could change to range from about 1 to about 15 minutes. Similarly, t2 at −20° C. could range from about 1 to about 60 minutes, while changing to range at 70° C. from a fraction of a minute to about 10 minutes. Further, the change in these times might not be linear with temperature.
  • It is understood that for certain situations, t[0353] 1 and t2 can be fixed as in the prior art; but in this invention these time intervals can be allowed to change as discussed above, unlike the prior art.
  • FIG. 35 also shows that even the bleach time (tB) could depend on the device temperature or/and on the total time the device was kept in the colored state (t[0354] c) prior to initiating the bleach.
  • Typically both t[0355] 1 and t2 decrease with increasing temperature. Thus, incorporation of a temperature sensor which provides a feedback into the control circuit could be used for this purpose. The temperature sensor may be any convenient sensor such as, for example, a thermistor, a RTD thermocouple, a transistor, or a diode, the output from which can be used to determine t1 and t2.
  • For example, referring to FIG. 36A, in the case where a timer is used to provide the t[0356] 1 and t2 circuit functions, the thermistor would preferably be a negative thermal coefficient (NTC) thermistor. When the temperature increases, the resistance of the NTC thermistor would decrease and the resulting RC product (R is resistance, and C is capacitance) connected to the LM 556 (National Semiconductor, Santa Barbra, Calif.) timer would also decrease leading to smaller t1 and t2. The drop in resistance in the NTC thermistor with temperature would be correlated with the transmission changes during t1 and t2 periods of the EC device.
  • Preferably, the temperature coefficient of the thermistor and the capacitor in the circuit should be chosen so that the change in RC would naturally mimic the desired change trends needed for t[0357] 1 and t2. One may even employ two thermistors in conjunction with two capacitors respectively, where the parameters of one set of resistors/capacitors are tailored to correspond with the changes in t1 and the other set of resistors/capacitors corresponds with the changes in t2.
  • In a variable coloration device, t[0358] 1 and t2 will depend on the depth of coloration. For example, in the open circuit mode the transmission change for a deeper colored state may be faster (thus requiring a shorter t1) than for a shallower colored state. Similarly, it may take more time to achieve a darker state (thus requiring a longer t2) Since the depth of coloration is typically related to the potential used for coloration, one could define and store in the control circuit a profile of t1 and t2 values that are calibrated with the applied coloration voltage.
  • As the device ages, t[0359] 1 and t2 may also shift. Account could be kept of the number of cycles, time spent in a particular state of transmission or any other convenient method which keeps a track of the age and usage of the cell. An aging profile with varying t1 and t2 could be used to drive the cell and if needed, the potential can also be varied and controlled to keep the initial level of coloration. Such control can be by any convenient method such as, for example, the use of monitoring sensors and feedback processes.
  • In another aspect of this invention, no prescribed periods are used but rather the actual level of coloration is sensed through the EC cell. In this case where one or more photosensors are used, the degree of color change can be detected by the photosensor and once the coloration has changed to a predetermined level, the necessary voltage can be applied to recolor the EC cell back to its original depth. Use of the photosensor can also eliminate any need to pre-program values of or factors to calculate t[0360] 1 and t2 with aging, temperature or coloration voltage.
  • Photosensors, e.g., CdS photoconductors on Si photodiodes, can be used to provide feedback signals for controlling t[0361] 1 and t2 instead of presetting fixed values for t1 and t2. In this case, the photosensor(s) would monitor the transmission of the EC cell and actively signal the circuitry as to the appropriate times to remove and to apply the voltage. As coloration rates and bleach rates change with temperature, aging, and other factors, t1 and t2 are adjusted accordingly. Preferably a pair of photosensors are used. One photosensor is placed on top of the cell to obtain the baseline for incoming light while another is placed underneath the cell to collect the transmitted light. The electrical signals from these two photosensors are then connected to a differential amplifier, the output of which is proportional to the relative transmission through the cell. Depending on the sensed output, the cell will be subjected to open circuit (holding period t1) or voltage application (period t2).
  • Further, as the cell ages thereby affecting its coloring and bleaching kinetics, the depth of coloration can still be maintained since t[0362] 1 and t2 will change due to the feedback provided by the photosensors. For example if the coloration rate of the cell slows down, both t1 and t2 will increase to maintain a pre-determined differential output from the photosensors for identical illumination conditions. Also, if t1 and t2 become longer than pre-determined “acceptable periods”, then the circuit may be configured to increase the coloration potential (subject to a maximum safe-potential for the devices) to increase the coloration speed.
  • Another method monitors the current (I) or the rate of change in current injected with time (t), i.e. dI/dt. Once dI/dt reaches a prescribed low value, the coloring potential is removed. [0363]
  • The transmission change during the holding period (t[0364] 1) can also be correlated to the open circuit potential change between the two cell electrodes. During the holding period (tl), the potential between the two opposing electrodes of the EC cell (Vcell) will also decrease. Once a predetermined change in this voltage (ΔV) is reached, a coloring voltage can be then applied to recolor the EC device. The time period t2 can be determined by checking the current being injected into the cell. For example, as shown in FIG. 34B, for a constant voltage the rate of change of the current decreases with time and reaches a limiting value. Thus, when the change in the current with time becomes smaller than a predetermined level, the coloring voltage can be removed.
  • Alternatively instead of monitoring dI/dt, just the current (I) could be measured. Once the absolute value of the current is below a predetermined limit the coloring voltage is removed. As described earlier, this method also self compensates for any changes in cell kinetics, caused by aging, by increasing time periods t[0365] 1 and t2 during the coloration period. When these time periods become longer than pre-determined “acceptable periods”, the circuit if desired may be configured to increase the coloration potential (subject to a maximum safe potential for the devices) in order to increase the coloration speed.
  • Alternatively, the charge injected during coloration can be monitored by a charge integration circuit. Once a predetermined charge has been injected, the coloration voltage can be removed. For many EC devices, the charge passed into the device for a desired level of coloration may depend on temperature. One method to take into account where this charge will increase with temperature is to have a comparator with a thermistor-containing reference. All of the control parameters which determine t[0366] 1 and t2 such as Tc1%, (Tc1%-Tc2%), ΔV, I, and dI/dt may be fixed and/or varied with temperature and/or aging of the device. One may also determined t1 or t1 by measuring the voltage at the EC cell Vcell and comparing this with the VC or VB. During coloration Vcell asymptotically approaches Vc. When Vcell is within 5% (preferable 1%) of Vc, the coloring potential Vc is removed to let the cell rest in open circuit conditions. Alternatively, Vc could be continued to be applied for an additional fixed time after the above condition is met to allow the cell to reach equilibrium. The total coloration time (t1 or t2) are obtained by adding the time for coloration during which Vcell approaches Vc and the fixed duration described above. During the open circuit mode (e.g., in coloration) the potential of the cell (Vcell) is measured and when it drops to about 3 to 30% of Vc (preferably 10 to 15% of vc) the coloring voltage Vc is re-applied. Schematically an electric circuit showing Vcell and Vc (or VB) is shown in FIG. 45.
  • In addition to varying t[0367] 1 and t2 with temperature, the coloring and bleaching voltages may also be varied with temperature if desired. For example, depending on the devices, higher voltages may be used at lower temperature or vice-versa. Additionally, with temperature feedback to the control circuities, both the duration (i.e., t1 and t2) and the voltage can be varied simultaneously to further mitigate electrical or electrochemical stress on the EC cell.
  • The voltage can be made temperature dependent by having a thermistor-containing voltage reference in the power supply. This thermistor can be a NTC (negative thermal coefficient) or a PTC (positive thermal coefficient) type. As the temperature rises the resistance will be lower in NTC thermistors. Consequently, when incorporated with suitably-biased series resistors and an operational amplifier (op amp), the reference voltage to the error-sensing op amp will be lower as temperature increases, resulting in a lower voltage applied to the EC cell at higher temperatures. [0368]
  • An example of a circuit incorporating an NTC thermistor TM[0369] 1 and an op amp OP1 is shown in FIG. 39. As the temperature increases, the resistance of the TM1 will be lower, resulting in a reference voltage from PS2 to OP1 to be lower. Thus, output voltage VOUT will be lower. Accordingly, a properly designed resistor stack with a combination of series and/or parallel resistors incorporating such thermistors would cause the voltage needed (VOUT) to track with operating temperature. In a particular example, the values of each component were: PS1 was 12 VDC, R1 and R2 were 10K Ω each, C1 was 10 μF, PS2 was 2.5 VDC, OP1 was a LM324 op amp available from National Semiconductor, Santa Clara, Calif., TM1 was an NTC Thermistor having a resistance of 1.76 kg at 50° C., and the output voltage was 1.35 V.
  • A PTC thermistor TM[0370] 2 can also be used in a circuit to change the output voltage with temperature, an example of which is shown in FIG. 40. In a particular example, the values of each component were similar to that example above, PS3 was 12 VDC, R3 and R4 were 10K Ω each, C2 was 10 μF, PS4 was 2.5 VDC, OP2 was a LM324 op amp, TM1 was an PTC Thermistor having a resistance of 1.76k Ω at 5° C. , and the output voltage was 1.15 volts.
  • Additionally, the thermistor can also be used in a comparator circuit to trigger the microprocessor to use different t[0371] 1, and t2 periods, for example, as shown in FIG. 41. In the example, the thermistor TM3 used was a NTC Digikey part # PNT 117-ND available from Panasonic, Cupertino, Calif., with a resistance of 1.76K Ω at 50° C. The potentiometer resistor R5 in series with the thermistor was adjusted to match the thermistor's set value, i.e. 1.76K Ω. PS5 was 12 VDC, R6 and R7 were each 15K Ω, and the op amp was an LM324 op amp available from National Semiconductor. As a result, the voltage drop across R6 and R7 (Vcc) is 5.0 V. The positive input of the op amp is fixed at 2.5 V by the two 15K Ω series resistors R6 and R7. At temperatures lower than 50° C., the TM3 resistance is higher than 1.76K Ω resulting in a voltage of higher than ½ of Vcc (that is, 2.5 V) to the negative input of the LM324 op amp. Since the negative input is higher than the positive input there is no output from the op amp at such lower temperatures. When the temperature climbs to 50° C. and above, the resistance in the thermistor drops below 1.76K Ω, thereby lowering the voltage below 2.5 V and resulting in a positive output signal from the op amp that can be routed to a microprocessor input port. The microprocessor can then change the t1, and t2 periods in response to the positive output signal.
  • Based on this circuit, the output of the op amp will be turned on at the threshold temperature; however near the region of this threshold there may be thermal fluctuations which may cause the output to erratically turn on and off. In order to eliminate such erratic behavior, a positive hysteresis can be added to the op amp comparator using positive feedback. As shown in FIG. 42, a feedback loop can be formed by resistor R[0372] 12, resulting in a Schmitt trigger. In the example, the values of the components were those of the corresponding components in FIG. 41, with the added resistors R11 being 10K Ω and R12 being 1K Ω.
  • With such a Schmitt trigger in the circuit, the low trigger threshold is different from the high trigger threshold (the difference being the hysteresis intentionally induced in the comparator, rather than a single threshold value as in a conventional comparator). Such Schmitt triggers can also be used in photosensors to detect daylight—it is well known that around the region of daylight threshold, e.g., during dusk and dawn, photocells can behave erratically. Having positive hysteresis in the op amp comparator will aid in obtaining a smooth output. Furthermore, Schmitt triggers can be used in EC skylight circuits where both photosensors and temperature sensors are employed. [0373]
  • FIG. 43 shows an example of an implementation of an adjustable voltage power supply where the output voltage supplied to the electrochromic panel ECU[0374] 1 can be tuned to give two different output voltages depending on the transistor switch T4 which will be activated when there is a predefined temperature change. In a particular example, PS7 was 12 VDC, PS8 was 2.5 VDC, R14 and R13 were each 10K Ω, R15 and R16 were each 1K Ω, R17 was 4K Ω, and C3 was 10 μF. The transistors T3 and T4, and the op amp were those described above. The trigger to the base of T4 can come from either a microprocessor port as shown in FIG. 43, or the comparator output from a circuit as shown in FIG. 41 or 42. Upon turning on of transistor T4, the resistor R15 will be in parallel with the reference resistor R14 resulting in a lower overall resistance and hence lower reference voltage to the error-sensing op amp. The output voltage will also be lower. Alternatively, such output voltage can change to vary the EC color voltage below full coloration, e.g., during half color.
  • The EC power supply can also incorporate current limitation, e.g., using simple transistor switching or current holdback techniques. The addition of a sensing resistor in series with the power output, together with another transistor as shown in FIG. 44, can limit the maximum current flowing in the circuit by the judicious choice of the sensing resistor R[0375] 20 value. This sensing resistor can be fixed for constant maximum current or made variable for variable current limiting in the circuit. In a particular example, PS9 was 12 VDC, PS10 was 2.5 VDC, R18 and R19 were 10K Ω, TM4 was an NTC thermistor having a resistance of 1.76K Ω at 50° C., Op Amp OP6 was an LM324, T5 and T6 were 2N3904 transistors described above, and C4 was 10 μF. With sensing resistor R20 having a resistance of 1K Ω (VBE of T6 is 0.7 volts), the voltage output VOUT was 1.35 volts, and was limited to a current IOUT of 0.7 mA.
  • A particular benefit of this current limiting is in the case of an electrical short—the circuit will allow only the maximum limited current to flow through rather than a potentially damaging high current, thus offering protection. [0376]
  • In some devices, the variation in t[0377] 1 may be much more strongly dependent on temperature than t2 (e.g., see device # 1 and 2 in Table 5 below). In such cases the powering circuit could be simplified so that only t1 varies with temperature and t2 is fixed in duration.
  • In all the examples above it is assumed that the coloration and bleaching are controlled by applying a pre-specified maximum potential and that this potential can be a step, ramp, non-linear, etc. In another method the power supply can be configured so that it applies a pre-specified current for coloring and bleaching, subject to a maximum safe-potential. This means that the applied potential from the power supply will vary with time (to compensate for changes in impedance, for example). [0378]
  • In coloration, as an example, a controlled current source could be used. The current is reduced, or the current source is removed, as the maximum safe-potential is reached. Thus, when a pre-specified potential between the cell electrodes is reached, the power source is removed. A current limit for coloring (or bleaching) for non-internal busbar cells is typically chosen between 50 to 5000 μA/cm[0379] 2 of active area of the EC cell, more preferably between 100 and 1000 μA/cm2. For cells with internal busbars current limit (if imposed) can exceed the upper limit of this range to insure that time to color and bleach is rapid.
  • In all cases where the temperature is being measured, it is important that the temperature measuring or sensing elements such as thermistors, ferroelectric capacitors, thermocouples, or other such temperature measuring means, are mounted in such a way that they sense or measure temperatures that are similar to the temperature of the EC cells. That is, the measured temperature must have a corresponding relation to the temperature of the EC cell. For example, the measuring means could be mounted on a cell surface, on a cell edge, or at a position proximate to the cell so that the temperature of the cell and the temperature of the sensing element are similar. In some cases it may be preferred to mount the thermistor so that it is hidden from the direct view of the user. Adhesives with high thermal conductivity may be used for mounting so that the sensing elements are close in temperatures to the substrates they are mounted on. [0380]
  • In other examples where the EC cell is large, or where the sensing element controls multiple EC cells, it is apparent that the sensing element should measure a temperature that is relevant to the temperature of the large EC cell or of the multiple EC cells. Such relevant temperature would be, for example, an average temperature across the large EC cell or the multiple EC cells. In other cases, the peak or low temperature might be relevant. Accordingly, the sensing element should be positioned so that such a relevant temperature is sensed or measured. [0381]
  • The above descriptions of determining t[0382] 2 may also be used for determining and/or controlling t1. The time period tb may be fixed or could be varied.
  • The Examples which follow are intended as an illustration of certain preferred embodiments of the invention, and no limitation of the invention is implied. [0383]
  • Example 16 With Thermistor and/or Ferroelectric Capacitor
  • Referring to FIG. 36A, the EC control circuit was designed to incorporate the intermittent powering of the EC cell E[0384] 1, as described above. In this example, the coloring and bleach potentials were fixed at 1.2 V and −0.3 V respectively, while t1 and t2 were allowed to vary with temperature.
  • The system can utilize any convenient voltage as would be apparent to one of ordinary skill in the art. In this case, for example, 12 V DC is used. The voltage can be supplied from any convenient source such as, for example, from a car battery or from a transformer that steps down 110 V AC to 12 V DC. The circuit uses a LM 556 dual timer (National Semiconductor, Santa Clara, Calif.), which includes an astable timer U[0385] 1/A and a monostable single shot timer U1/B, to control the timed cycles for the EC device.
  • Astable timer U[0386] 1/A includes an RC circuit comprised of resistors R2, R3, and capacitor C1. This astable timer provides the holding and voltage application periods. The periods for t1 and t2 are obtained by using the formula t1=0.693(R3+R2)C1 and t2=0.693(R2)C1. The output of timer U1/A drives a transistor Q1 which then further drives a transistor Q2. Transistor Q2 activates the relay K1:A which upon closing applies the coloring potential from the 1.2 V voltage source.
  • A pair of diodes D[0387] 1 and D2 isolate the outputs of U1/A and U1/B from each other. Astable timer U1/A is cycling constantly but its output is only applied to electrochromic cell E1 when switch S3 is in the color position after an initial time period, for example, 200 sec from U1/B.
  • Resistors R[0388] 2 and R3 may each be replaced with a NTC thermistors, e.g., model DC95-& 104Z available from Thermometrics, Edison, N.J., to allow for t1 and t2 compensation at electrochromic cell E1. For example, the cycling conditions of a particular EC device at 25° C. are t1=138 sec, t2=69 sec. These times are obtained with thermistor R2 and R3 values of 100K Ω and C1 of 1 mF. Using the thermistors described, the resistance increases to 1 M Ω at −25° C. and decreases to 23K Ω at 65° C., resulting in t1=1444 sec and t2=722 sec at −25° C., and t1=32 sec and t2=16 sec at 65° C., respectively.
  • Monostable single shot timer U[0389] 1/B provides the initial duration—in this case, for example, 200 sec, of coloring or bleaching potential. The duration for the initial color (t1) or bleach (tb) is calculated according to the formula t=R3*C4. The values are calculated, in this example, to yield the 200 sec duration to initially color or bleach the cell and is triggered by switch S1. The output from switch S1 drives transistors Q2 and Q3. Resistor R6 can be replaced with an NTC thermistor to obtain longer and shorter initial bleaching (or coloring) periods, respectively.
  • The potential which is applied to electrochromic cell E[0390] 1 depends on the position of switch S3, which the user selects. If switch S3 is in the coloring position, astable timer U1/A takes over after the initial 200 sec coloring cycle and then electrochromic cell E1 is cycled intermittently by astable timer U1/A to maintain coloration. Astable timer U1/A is never applied while switch S3 is in the bleaching position.
  • Alternatively, ferroelectric-capacitors having a Curie point, T[0391] c, for example, below −45° C., based on SrTiO3— containing compositions, can also be used in the timer circuit to provide temperature sensitive capacitors. In these capacitors, the capacitance declines with increasing temperature. Accordingly, such capacitors can be used to cause the periods of t1 and t2 to be changed along non-linearly with temperature changes, such as to cause even longer periods at lower temperatures and shorter periods at higher temperatures. Furthermore, a combination of thermistors and ferroelectric capacitors can be used simultaneously to obtain the RC product necessary to change t1 and t2 according to temperature.
  • A microcontroller can also be used to obtain t[0392] 1 and t2 functionalities in the control circuities using built-in timer modes thus negating the use of any external timer chips such as LM555 or LM556. Examples of such microcontrollers are PIC16F84 from Microchip (Chandler, Ariz.), MC68HC11E9 from Motorola (Tempe, Ariz.), and Z-80 from Zilog (Campbell, Calif.). Temperature sensors can be connected to the microcontroller to change t1 and t2 accordingly. Flash memory or EEPROM can further be utilized in conjunction with the microcontroller to store information on the temperature dependence, electrical history and aging properties of the EC cell. This information will then be used as feedback to optimize the cell bleaching and coloring characteristics. These may include changes to Vc, Vb, Tcl%, Tc2%, t1, t1, t2 and tb.
  • In a particular example, a Microchip microcontroller PIC16F84 as shown in FIG. 36B was used (in place of the LM556 dual timers of FIG. 36A) in a circuit similar to that shown in FIG. 36A. The EC cell was configured so that it could only be colored during the day time by using a CdS photocell sensor to determine whether it is daytime or nighttime. At night, the EC coloring function was disabled. Upon coloring, a coloring potential of 1.2 V from the power supply would be applied to the cell for 3 minutes. Following this initial coloring potential, the specific t[0393] 1 and t2 intermittence functionality (for example, 45 sec turn off and 15 sec turn on of the coloring potential) was also written into the program. Upon bleaching, a −0.3 V would be applied to the cell for 3 minutes. During the coloring or bleaching process, the output pin would be enabled turning on the relay or semiconductor switches to power the EC cell directly from the coloring or bleaching power supplies. The firmware was programmed into the microcontroller using a PicStart Plus Programmer. A thermistor suitably mounted on the EC cell can also be connected to one of the I/O ports in the P1C16F84. The change in resistance of the thermistor is then correlated to temperature of the EC cell. Depending on the temperature measured, the coloring and bleaching potentials, t1 and t2 characteristics can then be controlled. Microcontrollers can also be used to control the powering method of the EC cells during coloring and bleaching. This includes specific potential ramps, constant current control, or potential increases and decreases in multiple discrete steps.
  • Example 17 Change in t1 and t2 With Temperature of Electrochromic Devices
  • Various electrochromic devices, 3 in×3 in, were fabricated using 12 ohms/square ITO as the conductive substrates. The tungsten oxide coating deposition methods and device fabrication processes used in these EC devices were similar to the methods and processes described in copending U.S. patent application Ser. No. 09/155,601 (incorporated by reference herein) which also describes the use of and methods to fabricate Selective Ion Transport Layers (SITL). The EC devices were made both with SITL layers and without SITL layers. The electrolyte consisted of at least one solvent, one dissociable salt and at least one redox promoter. Polymeric viscosity modifiers and UV stabilizers and water were also added. [0394]
  • Although any of the solvents described in copending U.S. patent application Ser. No. 09/155,601, could be used, although carbonates, sulfolanes, glymes, and their mixtures are preferred. Examples of suitable carbonates are propylene carbonate, ethylene carbonate, ethyl propyl carbonate, isopropyl ethyl carbonate, diethyl carbonate, methyl propyl carbonate, isopropyl methyl carbonate, ethyl methyl carbonate, dimethyl carbonate, butylene carbonate and other alkyl carbonates. Examples of some other suitable solvents are alkyl sulfones, tetraglyme, toluene, xylene, decaline and other aliphatic and aromatic alkyls with or without substituted polar groups. [0395]
  • Dissociable salts were typically based on alkali metal cations, such as lithium, sodium, and potassium. Some examples of suitable anions are perchlorate, tetrafluoroborate, triflate, etc., as described in copending U.S. patent application Ser. No. 09/155,601, which lists other suitable salts. [0396]
  • When tungsten oxide, molybdenum oxide and other cathodic oxides and their mixtures were used as chromogenic layers, the redox promoters used in the devices were typically based on ferrocene and its derivatives. Substituted ferrocenes with electron donating groups attached on the cyclopentadiene rings of the ferrocenes are a preferred sub-class in ferrocenes. These groups can be substituted to any of the cyclopentadiene rings. Further, the substituted groups may be the same or different on each of the rings. Such groups include methyl, propyl, n-butyl, tertiary butyl, etc. Examples of such ferrocenes include decamethyl ferrocene, octamethyl ferrocene, tertiary butyl ferrocene, interannual substituted ferrocenes such as 1-1′-(propane-1,3-diyl) ferrocene, 1,1′:3,3′-bis(propane-1,3-diyl) ferrocene, 1,1′:2,2′:4,4′-tri(propane-1,3-diyl) ferrocene. Another preferred sub-class of ferrocenes are biferrocenes and bridge ferrocenes, where in the latter, the cyclopentadiene rings of different ferrocene molecules are chemically bonded to each other. Examples of these include 2,2-bis(tert-butylferrocenyl)propane, 2,2-bis(ethyl ferrocenyl)propane, etc. Further, the selection of the ferrocene will also influence the extent of the back reaction with other ingredients, components and device construction details remaining the same. [0397]
  • Typically, inclusion of polymers that are soluble in the electrolyte will result in increased viscosity and accordingly such polymers can be used as viscosity modifiers. [0398]
  • The size of such crystals should typically be smaller than about 0.5 μm, preferably less than 0.2 μm so that they do not create haziness in optically clear systems. Some preferred polymers are polymethyl methacrylate, polyvinyl chloride, polyvinyl chloride and polyvinyl acetate copolymers, polyvinyl butyral, polyacrylonitrile and its copolymers, polyvinylidene fluoride, copolymers of polyvinylidene fluoride and hexafluoropropylene. The last two are available from Elf Atochem North American (Philadelphia, Pa.) under the trade names of Kynar and Kynar flex respectively. [0399]
  • In one of the samples the electrolyte was processed using a sol-gel technique to form a solid. The solid resulted from the formation of “Si—O—Si” cross-linkages in-situ after filling the EC cell with a electrolyte precursor. This is also described below. [0400]
  • The selection and the concentration of the ingredients described above will influence the extent of the back reaction while other components and device construction details remain the same. The back reaction will change with temperature and this will cause change in t[0401] 1 and t2.
  • As shown in Table 5 below, the presence and absence of a SITL layer, the type of SITL layer, and any changes in the electrolyte have considerable influence on t[0402] 1 and t2. Polyceram SITL layer formation by sol-gel processing is described below. Polystyrene-sodium-sulfonate (PSSNa) SITL layer was processed by dip-coating the tungsten oxide coated substrates with a 540,000 mol. wt. PSSNa solution (5% by weight/vol) in a 50/50 mixture (by volume) of distilled water and reagent grade ethanol and 0.01% of a surfactant, Triton X-100 available from Aldrich Chemical Co. (Milwaukee, Wis.).
  • The devices were colored by applying 1.2 V. The values of T[0403] c1% and Tc2% (FIG. 35) were 10% and 15% respectively. The leakage current was measured as the current consumed after applying the coloring potential for 15 minutes. The table also shows that when ferrocene has bulky constituents, such as in the compound 2,2-bis(ethyl ferrocyl)propane, a lower leakage current is obtained. For example, compare the leakage current of device 1 to that of device 2, and the leakage current of device 5 to that of device 6.
  • The various electrolyte compositions were: [0404]
  • electrolyte A: 85% Propylene carbonate, 0.8% 2,2-bis(ethyl ferrocenyl)propane, 0.4% LiClO[0405] 4, 9.4% PMMA, 3.6% UV400, and 0.1% water (all percenntages by weight).
  • Elecrolyte B: 85.2% Propylene carboate, 0.7% ferrocene, 0.4% LiClO[0406] 4, 9.5% PMMA, 3.6% UV400 and 0.7% water (all percentages by weight).
  • Electrolyte C: 53.6% Propylene Carbonate, 35.7% Sulfolane, 8.4% Poly(methy methacrylate), 1.0% Deionized water, 0.8% Ferrocene, 0.5% Lithium perchlorate (all percentages by weight). [0407]
    TABLE 5
    De- Type of Leakage
    vice Electrolyte SITL SITL Temp. t2 current
    # composition Layer layer ° C. t1 (s) (s) (μA/cm2)
    1 Electrolyte C No 25 30 20 210
    50 20 20 370
    70 15 20 530
    2 Electrolyte A No 25 61 6 126
    50 31 4 268
    70 24 4 392
    3 See forma- No 25a 7 31 29
    tion of sol-
    gel electro-
    lyte below
    this table
    50b 5 15 87
    70c 2 12 151
    4 Electrolyte B Yes Poly- 25 1079 14.4 6.4
    ceram-2 50 431 7.2 31.5
    70 184 5.8 90.0
    5 Electrolyte B Yes Poly- 25 590 24 10
    ceram-1 50 145 8 47
    70 64 6 136
    6 Electrolyte A Yes Poly- 25 2749 10.2 4.8
    ceram-1 50 1272 6 13
    70 785 4 26.7
    7 Electrolyte C Yes PSSNa 25 3600 25 3.3
    70 900 7 14.5
  • Example: Formation and processing of Polyceram-1 SITL Layer (CH[0408] 3(OCH2CH2)nOCONH(CH2)3Si(OC2H5)3/Si(OCH3)4, overcoated on WO3 electrode)
  • Polyceram layer was processed as described in the examples given below. Polyceram layer was made in the same way but the ratio of ingredients was modified. The weight ratio of (CH[0409] 3(OCH2CH2)nOCONH(CH2)3Si(OC2H5)3 to Si(OCH3)4 was 1:0.51 in the case of Polyceram-1 but 1:1.02 in the case of Polyceram-2.
  • 75.00 g of poly(ethylene glycol) methyl ether, CH[0410] 3(OCH2CH2)nOH (number average MW=ca. 350, obtained from Aldrich Chemical Co., Milwaukee, Wis.), 58.31 g of 3-(triethoxysilyl) propylisocyanate, (C2H5O)3Si(CH2)3NCO, and 0.15 ml of dibutyltin dilaurate were heated at approximately 50° C. under nitrogen, with stirring, for 2 hrs to give a silylated derivative with the nominal formula: CH3(OCH2CH2)nOCONH(CH2)3Si(OC2H5)3.
  • 24.30 g of CH[0411] 3(OCH2CH2)nOCONH(CH2)3Si(OC2H5)3, 49.59 g of C2H5OH and 2.20 g of H2O (acidified to 0.15 M HCl) were combined and refluxed for 30 mins. The solution was then cooled and 12.38 g of Si(OCH3)4 added and the resulting solution refluxed for 60 mins. The solution was then cooled and 5.86 g of H2O (acidified to 0.15 M HCl) was added and the resulting solution refluxed for 60 mins. The solution was then cooled and 3.00 g of Amberlyst® A-21 ion-exchange resin (Rohm & Haas Co.) added, followed by gentle stirring. After 30 mins the solution was filtered through a fritted glass disc Buchner funnel. 45.00 g of the filtrate was taken and 0.21 g of 3-aminopropyltriethoxysilane was added. The resulting solution was diluted 1:1 (by weight) with ethanol and filtered through a 1 μm syringe filter. It was then spin-coated on a transparent WO3 ITO coated glass substrate. The coating was cured at 135° C. for 1 hr under humid atmosphere, after this treatment it has a thickness of about 0.6 μm . A device was then assembled as described in Comparative Example 1.
  • Example: Formation and processing of Polyceram-2 SITL layer (CH[0412] 3(OCH2CH2)nOCONH(CH2)3Si(OC2H5)3/Si(OCH3)4 overcoated on WO3 electrode)
  • 6.08 g of (CH[0413] 3(OCH2CH2)nOCONH(CH2)3Si(OC2H5)3, 12.40 g of C2H5OH and 0.55 g of H2O (acidified to 0.15 M HCl) were combined and refluxed for 30 mins. The solution was then cooled and 6.19 g of Si(OCH3)4 added and the resulting solution refluxed for 60 mins. The solution was then cooled and 2.93 g of H2O (acidified to 0.15 M HCl) was added and the resulting solution refluxed for 60 mins. the solution was then cooled and 1.30 g of Amberlyst® A-21 ion-exchange resin (Rohm & Haas Co.) added, followed by gentle stirring. After 30 mins the solution was filtered through a fritted glass disc Buchner funnel. The filtrate was diluted 1:2 (by weight) with ethanol and filtered through a 1 μm syringe filter. It was then spin-coated on a transparent WO3 ITO coated glass substrate. The coating was cured at 135° C. for 1 hr under a humid atmosphere, after this treatment it had a thickness of 0.3 μm. A device was then assembled as described in Comparative Example 1.
  • Example: Formation of sol-gel electrolyte [0414]
  • This describes a crosslinkable electrolyte which can be substituted for the electrolyte in cells such as those given in Comparative Example 1a or in other examples with SITL overlayers described earlier. The electrolyte was prepared in the following way: 12.00 g of poly(ethylene glycol). HO(CH[0415] 2CH2O)nOH (number average molecular weight=ca. 400, obtained from Aldrich Chemical Company), 15.58 g of 3-(triethoxysilyl) propyl isocyanate, (C2H5O)3Si (CH2)3NCO (obtained from Aldrich Chemical Company), and 0.03 g dibutyltin dilaurate, (CH3(CH2)3)2Sn(O2C(CH2)10CH3)2, were heated to approximately 70° C. under nitrogen, with stirring, for 15 minutes to yield a silylated derivative with the nominal formula: (H5C2O)3S1 (CH2)3HNOC(OCH2CH2)nOCONH(CH2)3Si (OC2H5)3.
  • 2 g of CH[0416] 3 (OCH2CH2)nOCONH(CH2)3Si (OC2H5)3, 1.50 g (H5C2O)3Si(CH2)3HNOC (OCH2CH2)nOCONH(CH2)3Si(OC2H5)3 (prepared as above), 1.75 g γ-butyrolactone, 0.0326 g ferrocene, and 0.4107 g LiClO4 are stirred until a clear solution is formed. Then 0.3636 g H2O (acidified to 0.15 M HCl) is added. The solution is stirred until homogeneous. A cell fabricated as in comparative Example 1 utilizing an ITO electrode and a transparent WO3 ITO coated glass substrate is then filled with the solution obtained above. The cell thickness in this example was 53 μm rather than 210 μm as given in the earlier example. After filling the cell, the solution forms a rigid gel (net work) within 10 hours. The gel time can be controlled, e.g., by changing the type and amount of catalyst (e.g., HCl is used above) as known in the art, temperature of cell after filling and using appropriate functionality of the ingredients. Functionalised ferrocenes also could be used which will attached chemically to the electrolyte network. Some exemplary ferrocenes are:
    Figure US20020044331A1-20020418-C00001
  • These ferrocenes could be used by themselves or in conjunction with non-functionalized ferrocenes (the ones which will not chemically attach to the network). Depending on the cell characteristics if non-ferrocene redox materials are used, the same can be implemented for non-ferrocene redox materials. The cell may also consist of ferrocene and non-ferrocene based redox materials. [0417]
  • Power consumption reduction in EC devices by using switching power supplies: [0418]
  • The power consumption of these devices can be further reduced by incorporating such elements in the circuit that would efficiently step down the voltages from the incoming power supply to the desired coloration or bleaching voltages. For example, a typical car battery has an output of about 12 V, while an EC device might only need 1 to 2 volts for coloration, for example 1.2 V. Thus, if the EC device needs a current of 10 mA in the colored state at a voltage of 1.2 V, then a power conserving circuit would allow only a 1 mA drainage from the battery at 12 V assuming that the power is converted at 100% efficiency. [0419]
  • Typical power supplies for powering EC devices in automotive mirrors use linear regulators or linear regulation for the voltage conversion process. Although widely used for such applications, the power conversion efficiencies of linear regulators are usually very low, typically 10-30%. The conversion efficiency, however, is typically not a major concern. Since the EC mirror is normally operated when the car in turned on, the current or power draw is not a significant drain on the car's alternator and linear regulation can be utilized. Examples of such circuits are described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,148,014, 5,193,029, and 5,220,317, each incorporated herein by reference. [0420]
  • However, the switching regulator can be used for EC devices as taught in the present invention and can offer up to 95% efficiency. In the prior art power supplies, the current draw is usually maintained when the voltage is switched from high to low potential. For example, for linear regulators, in going from 12 V at 1 mA, to 1.2 volts, the output current will still be 1 mA, which reflects a power conversion efficiency of only 10%. In this invention, use of circuits that regulates the power supply voltage by a switching function to control the electrochromic products increases the power conversion efficiency by at least two fold over linearly regulated power supplies. [0421]
  • In aircraft, boats, eyewear and automotive EC windows, such as automotive EC sunroofs, where the coloration needs to be maintained even when the vehicle is in a mode such as when parked, where the engine is off, the current drain from the battery becomes a critical issue. In cars, the current draw is usually preferably 2 mA or less at 12 V in order not to drain the battery excessively. During this coloration state, the present invention subjects the cell to an intermittent voltage rather than a continuous voltage, thereby enhancing device durability. During initial coloration and intermittent coloration periods (t[0422] 2) the switching power supply of the present invention is used to convert the power efficiently to reduce the battery drain. During the holding period when no current is flowing, the regulator should preferably have a low or no quiescent current.
  • An example of a switching regulator circuit used in this invention is shown in FIG. 37A. The circuit is able to regulate even low voltages below about 1.2 V. As described earlier, the switching regulator circuit of this invention has a low or no quiescent current in order not to drain the battery excessively. Switching regulators, as used here, have lower current drains than linear regulators. The switching regulator of the present invention preferably should have a quiescent current drain of lower than 100 mA. It is more preferred that the switching regulator of the present invention have a quiescent current drain of lower than 25 mA and most preferably lower than 5 mA. Such low current drains minimize drawdown of the battery in situations where the battery is not being charged such as while the vehicle is parked with ignition off. [0423]
  • Comparative Example: Linear Regulator [0424]
  • During operation of a prior art well known linear regulator such as, for example, National LM317 (National Semiconductor, Santa Clara, Calif.) series pass transistor is turned on continuously and the output voltage is determined through a voltage divider and a feedback circuit. There is a significant heat dissipation load for the transistor. Furthermore, as a result of the continuous “on” state of the transistor, there is a constant background current draw regardless of the load. When a load is connected, the conversion efficiency is typically not more than 30% for a ten fold change in voltage down conversion. [0425]
  • Example of Switching Regulator [0426]
  • In a switching regulator (e.g. National LM78S40), pulse width modulation (PWM) is used to switch the input voltage through a high speed transistor at an adjustable duty cycle. In contrast to a linear regulator where the series pass transistor is always on, in a switching regulator the series pass transistor is turned on and off at a convenient predetermined frequency (usually in the range of about 25-250 kHz). The output voltage is the average of the rectangular pulses resulting from such switching. Switching regulation results in higher efficiency, such as over 30% and can be as high as about 95%. In addition, the quiescent current draw is also very low, typically less than imA thus keeping overall heat dissipation low. Additionally in some switching regulators, e.g., Maxim MAX 1627 (Maxim Company, Sunnyvale, Calif.), the quiescent current draw can be further lowered to 1 μA. [0427]
  • As shown in FIG. 37A, a switching regulator circuit used in this invention can be based on a National LM78S40 switching regulator chip U[0428] 1. It accepts a 12 V pre-regulated input voltage. A peak current of 1.5 A is assumed for this regulator. A sense resistor calculated as 0.33/peak current according to the manufacturer, R4 detects the peak incoming current. Based on the value of input and output voltage expected, a duty cycle of 23% is obtained. Assuming a switching frequency of 25 kHz, a turn-on time of 33 μs is calculated. Based on the turn off time, the timing capacitor C2 of 0.15 μF is then used to set the switching frequency to 25 kHz. An inductor, L1 was used to couple the switching pulses while the capacitor C1 reduces the ripples in the pulses to an average voltage output. The combination of peak current and turn-on time results in an inductance of 50 μH. Voltage ripple of 1% is tolerated resulting in the capacitor C1 of about 1mF. The chip contains a built-in PWM module, Darlington series pass transistor and reference voltage. Trimmer resistor, R5, in conjunction with series resistor R3, then sets the output voltage. The built-in reference voltage is set at 1.3 V which is the lower limit for the regulated voltage. In the circuit the reference voltage is reduced by using a voltage divider via series resistors, R1 and R2 of 1 M Ω each to further lower the minimum voltage regulated to 0.65 V.
  • To change the applied potential to an EC device with temperature, an NTC thermistor can also be used in place of trimmer resistor R[0429] 5. At higher temperatures, the resistance decreases, leading to lower coloring and bleaching voltages while at lower temperatures, the resistance is higher resulting in higher voltages.
  • Switching regulator radiates EMI due to the switching transistor. Adequate shielding, e.g. Faradaic shield, must be provided to mitigate such EMI to reduce electromagnetic interference with other subsystems including communications such as a cellular phone. For example the shielding aspect could be useful for powering of EC components in a car or any other transportation vehicle. It is also novel to use switching and linear regulator with the former working when the car is in a parked state while the latter being used while the car is parked (ignition off), the degree of interference to other electronic systems is lower. [0430]
  • Example of a Switching Regulator With Ultra Low Quiescent Switching Current [0431]
  • A switching regulator used in this invention employing a MAXIM Max 1627 yielding very low quiescent current of 0.001 mA is shown in FIG. 37C. The switching efficiency is a high as 85% at 1 A current draw. Without modification using the manufacturers' specification, this chip outputs voltage at a lower limit of 1.27 V. In this particular example, the circuit is modified, to allow output voltages lower than 1.27 V, by having feedback resistors R[0432] 2 and R1 connected through a high speed comparator MAXIM Max 987. The p-MOSFET used in the circuit was International Rectifier (El Segundo, Calif.) IRF7416.
  • Example of Ramped Voltage Application [0433]
  • The voltage applied to the EC cell may consist of a non-linear ramp. The ramp only refers to the time period when the voltage is changing before the voltage settles at the hold potential (e.g., V[0434] cis holding potential in FIG. 38B). Such non-linearity can be obtained, e.g., by having some amount of internal resistance in the power supply. This internal resistance can be intentionally designed into the power supply itself or by inserting an external resistor between the voltage terminal and the EC cell. This is shown in FIG. 38A where resistor R7 is placed in series with the power supply output and EC cell. FIG. 38C describes the various shapes that the voltage vs. time curves can follow depending on the circuit parameters. The applied voltage is across the EC cell and the resistor. During bleaching or coloring times, there will be a large initial surge of current resulting in a sizable ohmic drop in R7 which then limits the voltage applied to the EC cell. At saturation, only a very low amount of current flows, and the voltage drop across R7 becomes negligible and hence the EC cell sees the full potential again. The overall voltage applied to the EC cell during coloring and bleaching processes appears similar to a capacitor charging curve. The sharpness of the curves depends on the value of resistor used; larger resistance results in more gradual and slower saturation.
  • Switching Power Supply Where Output Voltage Varies With Temperature [0435]
  • A switching regulator circuit was constructed similar to the one described previously except that a thermistor was located in place of fixed resistor R[0436] 5-see FIG. 37B. An example of the thermistor used is KE D331BZ from Thermometrics (Edison, N.J.). It exhibits resistance values of 4000 Ω and 60 Ωat −25° C. and 65° C. respectively. By having another fixed resistor R6 with a value of 3.6 kg in series with thermistor R5 and fixed resistor R3 with a value of 5.6 k Ω, the voltage was automatically tuned to 1.3 V and 1 V at −25° C. and 65° C. respectively.
  • Other variations and modifications of this invention will be obvious to those skilled in the art. This invention is not limited except as set forth in the following claims. [0437]

Claims (50)

What is claimed is:
1. An edge busbar having a shape effective to be peripherally disposed about a substantial perimeter of an edge, between a first surface and an opposite second surface, of an electrical device, wherein said edge busbar comprises:
at least one electrically conductive connector portion effective to form an electrically conductive path from said first surface, wrapping transversely around a portion of said edge, to said opposite second surface; and
an electrically conductive perimeter portion in electrical contact with said connector portion, wherein said perimeter portion is peripherally on said substantial perimeter.
2. An edge busbar according to claim 1, wherein said connector portion includes a plurality of said electrically conductive paths; and wherein said perimeter portion is in electrical contact with said plurality of electrically conductive paths.
3. An edge busbar according to claim 1, further including a conductive layer formed on said first surface; and wherein said connector portion has at least one separating portion electrically bridged by said conductive layer.
4. An edge busbar according to claim 1, wherein said connector portion and said perimeter portion are composed of aluminum, copper, gold, silver, tungsten, stainless steel, tin, copper/beryllium alloy, indium, nickel, rhodium, nichrome, solder, or a conductive metal oxide.
5. An edge busbar according to claim 1, wherein said edge busbar is composed of a metal in substantially a sheet configuration, wherein said sheet includes a ribbon having a plurality of first finger portions extending from a side of said ribbon, said ribbon forming said perimeter portion and said first finger portions forming said connector portions.
6. An edge busbar according to claim 5, wherein said sheet further includes a second plurality of finger portions extending from an opposite second side of said ribbon, said ribbon forming said perimeter portion and said first and second finger portions forming said connector portions.
7. An edge busbar according to claim 1, wherein said at least one connector portion is made from a cured metallic frit, conductive ink, or conductive adhesive.
8. An edge busbar according to claim 1, wherein said at least one connector portion is composed of indium tin oxide or doped tin oxide.
9. An edge busbar pair comprising a first edge busbar and a second edge busbar, each edge busbar of said pair having a shape to be peripherally disposed about a respective substantial perimeter edge of a first substrate and a second substrate respectively of an electrical device, said edge busbar pair further including:
said first busbar comprising a first connector portion and a first perimeter portion, said first connector portion effective to form an electrically conductive first path from a first front surface of said first substrate, wrapping around a portion of said edge of said first substrate, to an opposite first back surface of said first substrate, said first perimeter portion being in electrical contact with said first connector portion, and wherein said first perimeter portion is peripherally on said first substantial perimeter of said first substrate;
a second busbar comprising a second connector portion and a second perimeter portion, said second connector portion effective to form an electrically conductive second path from a second front surface of said second substrate, wrapping around a portion of an edge of said second substrate, to an opposite second back surface of said second substrate, said second perimeter portion being in electrical contact with said second connector portion, and wherein said second perimeter portion is peripherally on said second substantial perimeter of said second substrate; and
wherein said first front surface and said second front surface proximately face each other.
10. An edge busbar pair according to claim 9, wherein said first substantial perimeter is correspondingly opposite said second substantial perimeter.
11. An edge busbar pair according to claim 9, wherein said first and second connector portions each includes a plurality of said electrically conductive respective first and second paths; and wherein said first and second perimeter portions are in electrical contact with said respective plurality of electrically conductive first and second paths.
12. An edge busbar pair according to claim 11, wherein said plurality of first paths and said plurality of second paths are in an alternating relation.
13. An edge busbar pair according to claim 12, wherein said first and second connector portions have a thickness in the range of from more than one half of a gap distance to less than said gap distance; and wherein said gap distance is the distance separating said first front surface and said second front surface.
14. An edge busbar pair according to claim 9 or 11, further including an insulator disposed between said first substrate and said second substrate effective to prevent electrical shorting of said first connector portion to said second connector portion.
15. An edge busbar pair according to claim 9, wherein said first and second connector portions and said first and second connector perimeter portions are composed of aluminum, copper, gold, silver, tungsten, stainless steel, tin, copper/beryllium alloy, indium, nickel, rhodium, nichrome, solder, or a conductive metal oxide.
16. An electrochromic device comprising a first substrate; a second substrate; and an edge busbar pair, wherein said edge busbar pair comprising a first edge busbar and a second edge busbar, each edge busbar of said pair peripherally disposed about a respective substantial perimeter edge of said first substrate and said second substrate respectively, said edge busbar pair further including:
said first busbar comprising a first connector portion and a first perimeter portion, said first connector portion effective to form an electrically conductive first path from a first front surface of said first substrate, wrapping around a portion of said edge of said first substrate, to an opposite first back surface of said first substrate, said first perimeter portion being in electrical contact with said first connector portion, and wherein said first perimeter portion is peripherally on said first substantial perimeter of said first substrate;
a second busbar comprising a second connector portion and a second perimeter portion, said second connector portion effective to form an electrically conductive second path from a second front surface of said second substrate, wrapping around a portion of an edge of said second substrate, to an opposite second back surface of said second substrate, said second perimeter portion being in electrical contact with said second connector portion, and wherein said second perimeter portion is peripherally on said second substantial perimeter of said second substrate; and
wherein said first front surface and said second front surface face each other.
17. An electrochromic device according to claim 16, wherein said plurality of first paths and said plurality of second paths are in an alternating relation.
18. An electrochromic device according to claim 16, wherein said first and second connector portions have a thickness in the range of from more than one half of a gap distance to less than said gap distance; and wherein said gap distance is the distance separating said first substrate and said second substrate.
19. An internal busbar for a substrate having a conductive layer and a reactive layer on a first surface, said internal busbar comprising:
at least one conductive strip, isolated from chemical reaction with said reactive layer; and
at least one conductive connecting portion, each connecting portion electrically connecting a non-peripheral portion of said conductive layer to a segment of said conductive strip.
20. An internal busbar according to claim 19, wherein said conductive layer is isolated from chemical reaction with said reactive layer by a passivation layer.
21. An internal busbar according to claim 19, wherein said at least one conductive strip is substantially embedded in the substrate.
22. An internal busbar according to claim 19, wherein said at least one conductive strip is on an opposite second surface of said substrate, and said at least one connecting portion extends through said substrate from said first surface to said at least one conductive strip.
23. An internal busbar for a substrate having a conductive layer on a surface of the substrate, said internal busbar comprising:
at least one conductive strip having increased electrical conductance per unit length from the conductive layer in a longitudinal direction of said conductive strip, and said conductive strip having a perimeter in contact with the conductive layer.
24. An internal busbar according to claim 23, wherein said conductive strip is substantially embedded in the substrate.
25. An internal busbar according to claim 23, wherein said conductive strip is embedded in the substrate, and wherein said conductive strip has a longitudinal surface coextensive with a surface of the conductive surface layer.
26. An internal busbar according to claim 23, comprising a plurality of said conductive strips; and further comprising:
at least one sublayer conductive strip under the conductive layer, said sublayer conductive strip having increased electrical conductance per unit length from the conductive layer.
27. An internal busbar according to claim 23, wherein said at least one conductive strip has a transverse axis at an angle to the axis perpendicular to the surface of the substrate.
28. An internal busbar according to claim 27, wherein said transverse axis is parallel to a viewing direction of the substrate.
29. An internal busbar according to claim 28, wherein the substrate is a part of a window, a windshield, a sunroof, a light filter, or a mirror.
30. An internal busbar according to claim 23, wherein said at least one conductive strip is composed of a cured metallic frit, conductive ink, conductive epoxy, a metal rod, or a metal bar.
31. A transparent conducting sheet comprising:
a transparent substrate sheet;
a transparent electrically conducting layer on a substantial surface of said substrate sheet; and
at least one conductive strip interior to a perimeter edge of said conducting layer; said at least on e conductive strip effective to lower an effective conductivity of said conducting layer.
32. A transparent conducting sheet according to claim 31, further including at least one edge conductor electrically connected to said transparent conducting layer on a portion of a peripheral edge of said substrate sheet.
33. A transparent conducting sheet according to claim 31, wherein an end of said conductive strip is proximate to said edge conductor, separated by a proximate distance from said edge conductor, and wherein said proximate distance is electrically bridged by said conducting layer.
34. An electrical device comprising:
a conductive layer;
an edge conductor on a perimeter portion of said conductive layer; and
at least one conductive strip having increased electrical conductance per unit length from said conductive layer, and said conductive strip having a perimeter in contact with said conductive layer.
35. An electrical device according to claim 36, wherein said at least one conductive strip has an end proximate to said edge conductor.
36. An electrical device according to claim 37, wherein said end and said edge conductor form a gap bridged by said conductive layer.
37. A chromogenic device comprising:
a plurality of layers responsive to a first signal applied transversely effective to cause a change in a first property of said chromogenic device, and responsive to a second signal applied in a laminar direction effective to cause a change in a second property of said chromogenic device;
at least one conductor strip arranged in said laminar direction, said conductor strip interior of a perimeter of said layers;
a first edge conductor at a first perimeter portion of a first layer of said layers;
a second edge conductor at a second perimeter portion of a second layer of said layers;
wherein application of said first signal transversely from said first edge conductor to said second edge conductor, without application of a potential difference longitudinally along said at least one conductor strip, causes a responsive change in said first property without a change in said second property; and
wherein application of said second signal as a longitudinal signal along said at least one conductor strip, without a transverse potential difference between said first and second edge conductors, causes a responsive change in said second property without a change in said first property.
38. A chromogenic device according to claim 37, wherein said first property is optical transmittance.
39. A chromogenic device according to claim 37, wherein said second property is temperature.
40. A method to form an interior busbar comprising the steps of:
forming at least one channel on a surface of a substrate interior to the perimeter;
applying a conductive material to said at least one channel;
applying a conductive layer over said surface effective to completely cover said applied conductive material.
41. A method to control an electrochromic device having a light transmission property that responds to a physical or chemical effect, wherein the light transmission property changes in response to an electrical signal, wherein said method comprises the step of:
intermittently applying the electrical signal by controlling the on duration t1 and the off duration t2 of the electrical signal individually, in response to the physical or chemical effect, effective to maintain the light transmission property within a range of about 1% to about 10% of a predetermined value of said light transmission property.
42. A method according to claim 41, wherein said t1 and t2 are controlled in response to the physical effect of temperature.
43. A method according to claim 41, wherein at least one of (i) the current, and (ii) the change of current with time, (iii) output from photosensors, (iv) charge passed through the device, (v) cell potential, to said electrochromic device is used to respond to the change caused in the device by the change in temperature; by changing said t1 and t2.
44. A method according to claim 41, wherein the temperature of the electrochromic cell is used to influence the control circuit so as to adjust t1 and t2.
45. An electrochromic device having a light transmission property that responds to a physical or chemical property, wherein the light transmission property changes in response to an electrical signal, wherein said electrochromic device includes:
a means to intermittently apply the electrical signal by controlling the on duration t1 and the off duration t2 of the electrical signal individually, in response to the physical or chemical property, effective to maintain the light transmission property within a range of about 1% to about 10% of a predetermined value of the light transmission property.
46. An electrochromic device according to claim 45, wherein the means to intermittently apply the electrical signal is a control circuit which includes:
an astable timer that supplies an input to a first RC timing circuit; and
a monostable timer that supplies an input to a second RC timing circuit; wherein a first output from the first RC timing circuit and a second output from the second RC timing circuit is applied to the electrochromic device.
47. An electrochromic device according to claim 46, wherein a microcontroller provides t1 and t2.
48. An electrochromic device according to claim 45 or 46, wherein the voltage of the electrical signal is supplied from a regulated power supply that is regulated by a switching voltage regulator.
49. A method to control an electrochromic device having a light transmission property that responds to a physical or chemical property, wherein the light transmission property changes in response to an electrical signal, wherein said method comprises the step of:
intermittently applying the electrical signal by controlling the on duration t1 and the off duration t2 of the electrical signal individually, in response to the physical or chemical property, effective to maintain the light transmission property within a range of about 1% to about 10% of a predetermined value of said light transmission property; wherein the voltage of the applied electrical signal is supplied from a regulated power supply that is regulated by a switching voltage regulator.
50. An electronic circuit to power a chromogenic device wherein the voltage reduction is carried out using a switching voltage regulator.
US09/956,341 1998-07-02 2001-09-20 Busbars for electrically powered cells Expired - Fee Related US6449082B1 (en)

Priority Applications (1)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US09/956,341 US6449082B1 (en) 1998-07-02 2001-09-20 Busbars for electrically powered cells

Applications Claiming Priority (3)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US9167898P 1998-07-02 1998-07-02
US09/347,807 US6317248B1 (en) 1998-07-02 1999-07-02 Busbars for electrically powered cells
US09/956,341 US6449082B1 (en) 1998-07-02 2001-09-20 Busbars for electrically powered cells

Related Parent Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US09/347,807 Division US6317248B1 (en) 1998-07-02 1999-07-02 Busbars for electrically powered cells

Publications (2)

Publication Number Publication Date
US20020044331A1 true US20020044331A1 (en) 2002-04-18
US6449082B1 US6449082B1 (en) 2002-09-10

Family

ID=26784223

Family Applications (2)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US09/347,807 Expired - Fee Related US6317248B1 (en) 1998-07-02 1999-07-02 Busbars for electrically powered cells
US09/956,341 Expired - Fee Related US6449082B1 (en) 1998-07-02 2001-09-20 Busbars for electrically powered cells

Family Applications Before (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US09/347,807 Expired - Fee Related US6317248B1 (en) 1998-07-02 1999-07-02 Busbars for electrically powered cells

Country Status (1)

Country Link
US (2) US6317248B1 (en)

Cited By (37)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US20050174092A1 (en) * 2003-10-28 2005-08-11 Johnson Controls Technology Company Battery system
US20050200934A1 (en) * 2004-03-12 2005-09-15 The Boeing Company Dimming control system for an array of electrochromic devices
US20050200937A1 (en) * 2004-03-12 2005-09-15 The Boeing Company Multi-color electrochromic apparatus and methods
US20050224109A1 (en) * 2004-04-09 2005-10-13 Posbic Jean P Enhanced function photovoltaic modules
US20070000689A1 (en) * 2005-07-04 2007-01-04 Nitto Denko Corporation Printed circuit board
US7355161B2 (en) 2005-12-15 2008-04-08 The Boeing Company Systems and methods for controlling windows with variable light transmission
US20080198584A1 (en) * 2005-05-17 2008-08-21 Nervecorp Limited Building Structures Having Electrically Functional Architectural Surfaces
WO2010093703A1 (en) * 2009-02-10 2010-08-19 Applied Nanotech Holdings, Inc. Electrochromic device
WO2011035090A1 (en) * 2009-09-17 2011-03-24 Tetrasun, Inc. Selective transformation in functional films, and solar cell applications thereof
US8064120B2 (en) 2004-03-12 2011-11-22 The Boeing Company Aircraft cabin services system including zone controllers for lighting control modules and dimmable windows
US20110301771A1 (en) * 2010-06-04 2011-12-08 Alcatel-Lucent Canada, Inc. High-voltage step-charge control for use in network-powered applications
US8237535B2 (en) 2010-04-16 2012-08-07 World Properties, Inc. Integral planar transformer and busbar
US20130061904A1 (en) * 2011-09-14 2013-03-14 Au Optronics Corporation Solar cell module
JP2015508189A (en) * 2012-02-28 2015-03-16 セイジ・エレクトロクロミクス,インコーポレイテッド Multi-zone electrochromic device
JP2016133648A (en) * 2015-01-20 2016-07-25 株式会社リコー Electrochromic device and manufacturing method thereof
JP2017504057A (en) * 2013-12-19 2017-02-02 スイッチ マテリアルズ インコーポレイテッドSwitch Materials Inc. Switchable object and manufacturing method
WO2017070628A1 (en) * 2015-10-23 2017-04-27 Abominable Labs, Llc Electrical interconnection system for heating eye-shield
JP2017194599A (en) * 2016-04-21 2017-10-26 大日本印刷株式会社 Light control film and method for driving light control film
US20180138344A1 (en) * 2016-11-17 2018-05-17 Ubiquitous Energy, Inc. Single cell photovoltaic module
US10111780B2 (en) 2015-10-23 2018-10-30 Abominable Labs, Llc Goggle lens and face gasket engagement system
US10268097B2 (en) * 2012-02-28 2019-04-23 Sage Electrochromics, Inc. Multi-zone electrochromic device
US10392096B2 (en) * 2015-05-12 2019-08-27 Airbus Operations S.A.S. Access device provided with a folding door enabling secure communication between at least two zones of an enclosure
US20200001550A1 (en) * 2017-02-02 2020-01-02 Toray Industries, Inc. Method for producing fiber-reinforced plastic
WO2020083562A1 (en) 2018-10-26 2020-04-30 Saint-Gobain Glass France Composite panel with functional element which can be switched in segments and has electrically controllable optical properties
WO2020083563A1 (en) 2018-10-26 2020-04-30 Saint-Gobain Glass France Composite pane, having a functional element that can be switched in segments and that has electrically controllable optical properties
CN111247693A (en) * 2017-10-19 2020-06-05 韦弗有限责任公司 Phase modulator device for polymer dispersion/shear orientation
US20200331084A1 (en) * 2019-04-17 2020-10-22 Mahle International Gmbh Resistance soldering method and soldering device
US11086184B1 (en) * 2016-04-20 2021-08-10 Kinestral Technologies, Inc Electrochromic devices having optimized visual characteristics
CN113257127A (en) * 2020-08-14 2021-08-13 友达光电股份有限公司 Display device
RU2758579C2 (en) * 2020-02-17 2021-10-29 Сергей Олегович Лебедев Method and software and hardware complex for controlling electrochromic devices
JP2021529715A (en) * 2018-07-06 2021-11-04 ガーディアン・グラス・エルエルシーGuardian Glass, Llc A potential-driven shade including a shutter that supports a surface-modified conductive coating, a method for manufacturing the shade, and a method for operating the shade.
TWI751020B (en) * 2020-08-14 2021-12-21 友達光電股份有限公司 Electronic device and manufacturing method of electronic device
US11500258B2 (en) 2016-12-22 2022-11-15 Sage Electrochromics, Inc. Apparatus including an electrochromic device configured to maintain a continuously graded transmission state
US11624963B2 (en) 2013-03-07 2023-04-11 Solutia Canada Inc. Seal and seal system for a layered device
WO2023109922A1 (en) * 2021-12-17 2023-06-22 光羿智能科技(苏州)有限公司 Electrochromic device
US11835833B2 (en) * 2017-04-27 2023-12-05 Lg Chem, Ltd. Electrochromic device
US11951695B2 (en) * 2017-02-02 2024-04-09 Toray Industries, Inc. Method for producing fiber-reinforced plastic

Families Citing this family (264)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US5910854A (en) 1993-02-26 1999-06-08 Donnelly Corporation Electrochromic polymeric solid films, manufacturing electrochromic devices using such solid films, and processes for making such solid films and devices
US5668663A (en) 1994-05-05 1997-09-16 Donnelly Corporation Electrochromic mirrors and devices
US6891563B2 (en) 1996-05-22 2005-05-10 Donnelly Corporation Vehicular vision system
US6124886A (en) 1997-08-25 2000-09-26 Donnelly Corporation Modular rearview mirror assembly
US6326613B1 (en) 1998-01-07 2001-12-04 Donnelly Corporation Vehicle interior mirror assembly adapted for containing a rain sensor
US6172613B1 (en) 1998-02-18 2001-01-09 Donnelly Corporation Rearview mirror assembly incorporating vehicle information display
US8294975B2 (en) 1997-08-25 2012-10-23 Donnelly Corporation Automotive rearview mirror assembly
US8288711B2 (en) 1998-01-07 2012-10-16 Donnelly Corporation Interior rearview mirror system with forwardly-viewing camera and a control
US6445287B1 (en) 2000-02-28 2002-09-03 Donnelly Corporation Tire inflation assistance monitoring system
US7663607B2 (en) 2004-05-06 2010-02-16 Apple Inc. Multipoint touchscreen
DE19804314A1 (en) * 1998-02-04 1999-08-12 Bayer Ag Electrochromic display
US6553308B1 (en) 1999-04-29 2003-04-22 Donnelly Corporation Vehicle-based navigation system with smart map filtering, portable unit home-base registration and multiple navigation system preferential use
US6329925B1 (en) 1999-11-24 2001-12-11 Donnelly Corporation Rearview mirror assembly with added feature modular display
US6477464B2 (en) 2000-03-09 2002-11-05 Donnelly Corporation Complete mirror-based global-positioning system (GPS) navigation solution
US6693517B2 (en) 2000-04-21 2004-02-17 Donnelly Corporation Vehicle mirror assembly communicating wirelessly with vehicle accessories and occupants
US6130448A (en) * 1998-08-21 2000-10-10 Gentex Corporation Optical sensor package and method of making same
FR2791147B1 (en) * 1999-03-19 2002-08-30 Saint Gobain Vitrage ELECTROCHEMICAL DEVICE OF THE ELECTROCOMMANDABLE DEVICE TYPE WITH VARIABLE OPTICAL AND / OR ENERGY PROPERTIES
US7064882B2 (en) * 2002-09-30 2006-06-20 Gentex Corporation Electrochromic devices having no positional offset between substrates
US7324261B2 (en) * 1999-07-09 2008-01-29 Gentex Corporation Electrochromic devices with thin bezel-covered edge
US6262831B1 (en) * 1999-10-22 2001-07-17 Gentex Corporation Power supply for electrochromic mirrors in high voltage automotive power systems
US7167796B2 (en) 2000-03-09 2007-01-23 Donnelly Corporation Vehicle navigation system for use with a telematics system
US7855755B2 (en) 2005-11-01 2010-12-21 Donnelly Corporation Interior rearview mirror assembly with display
US7370983B2 (en) 2000-03-02 2008-05-13 Donnelly Corporation Interior mirror assembly with display
WO2001064481A2 (en) 2000-03-02 2001-09-07 Donnelly Corporation Video mirror systems incorporating an accessory module
DE60136703D1 (en) * 2000-05-04 2009-01-08 Schott Donnelly Llc Process for producing an electrochromic panel
US7231418B2 (en) * 2000-05-24 2007-06-12 Canon Kabushiki Kaisha Information providing method, information providing system, terminal apparatus, and storage medium storing information providing program
DE60134553D1 (en) * 2000-05-24 2008-08-07 Magna Donnelly Corp Electrode for electrochromic devices
US6407847B1 (en) * 2000-07-25 2002-06-18 Gentex Corporation Electrochromic medium having a color stability
SG125891A1 (en) * 2000-09-08 2006-10-30 Semiconductor Energy Lab Light emitting device, method of manufacturing thesame, and thin film forming apparatus
US6620342B1 (en) * 2000-10-23 2003-09-16 Atofina Chemicals, Inc. Narrow composition distribution polyvinylidene fluoride RECLT films, processes, articles of manufacture and compositions
US7581859B2 (en) 2005-09-14 2009-09-01 Donnelly Corp. Display device for exterior rearview mirror
ES2287266T3 (en) 2001-01-23 2007-12-16 Donnelly Corporation IMPROVED VEHICLE LIGHTING SYSTEM.
WO2006124682A2 (en) 2005-05-16 2006-11-23 Donnelly Corporation Vehicle mirror assembly with indicia at reflective element
US7255451B2 (en) * 2002-09-20 2007-08-14 Donnelly Corporation Electro-optic mirror cell
US6639708B2 (en) 2001-04-24 2003-10-28 Schott North America, Inc Electrochromic safety glazing
US6918674B2 (en) 2002-05-03 2005-07-19 Donnelly Corporation Vehicle rearview mirror system
US7329013B2 (en) 2002-06-06 2008-02-12 Donnelly Corporation Interior rearview mirror system with compass
WO2003105099A1 (en) 2002-06-06 2003-12-18 Donnelly Corporation Interior rearview mirror system with compass
US6853472B2 (en) * 2002-06-21 2005-02-08 The Regents Of The University Of California Electrolytes for electrooptic devices comprising ionic liquids
US7450292B1 (en) * 2003-06-20 2008-11-11 Los Alamos National Security, Llc Durable electrooptic devices comprising ionic liquids
US6961168B2 (en) * 2002-06-21 2005-11-01 The Regents Of The University Of California Durable electrooptic devices comprising ionic liquids
TWI300157B (en) * 2002-09-10 2008-08-21 Sipix Imaging Inc Electrochromic or electrodeposition display and process for their preparation
US7360932B2 (en) 2004-06-01 2008-04-22 Donnelly Corporation Mirror assembly for vehicle
US7310177B2 (en) * 2002-09-20 2007-12-18 Donnelly Corporation Electro-optic reflective element assembly
WO2004026633A2 (en) 2002-09-20 2004-04-01 Donnelly Corporation Mirror reflective element assembly
WO2004103772A2 (en) 2003-05-19 2004-12-02 Donnelly Corporation Mirror assembly for vehicle
US7184190B2 (en) * 2002-09-20 2007-02-27 Donnelly Corporation Electro-optic reflective element assembly
US7477439B2 (en) * 2002-09-30 2009-01-13 Gentex Corporation Vehicular rear view mirror elements and assemblies incorporating these elements
US9134585B2 (en) 2002-09-30 2015-09-15 Gentex Corporation Automotive rearview mirror with capacitive switches
US8169684B2 (en) 2002-09-30 2012-05-01 Gentex Corporation Vehicular rearview mirror elements and assemblies incorporating these elements
US9346402B2 (en) 2002-09-30 2016-05-24 Gentex Corporation Vehicular rearview mirror elements and assemblies incorporating these elements
US8004741B2 (en) * 2004-02-27 2011-08-23 Gentex Corporation Vehicular rearview mirror elements and assemblies incorporating these elements
US7372611B2 (en) * 2002-09-30 2008-05-13 Gentex Corporation Vehicular rearview mirror elements and assemblies incorporating these elements
ES2550534T3 (en) 2002-11-05 2015-11-10 Magna Mirrors Of America, Inc. Electro-optic reflector element set
CN100566480C (en) * 2002-12-20 2009-12-02 伊菲雷知识产权公司 The barrier layer that is used for thick film dielectric electroluminescent display
US7300166B2 (en) * 2003-03-05 2007-11-27 Electrochromix, Inc. Electrochromic mirrors and other electrooptic devices
EP1618573A2 (en) * 2003-04-25 2006-01-25 Key Safety Systems, Inc. Thick film thermistor
US7420756B2 (en) 2003-05-20 2008-09-02 Donnelly Corporation Mirror reflective element
US7446924B2 (en) 2003-10-02 2008-11-04 Donnelly Corporation Mirror reflective element assembly including electronic component
US7308341B2 (en) 2003-10-14 2007-12-11 Donnelly Corporation Vehicle communication system
US7005732B2 (en) * 2003-10-21 2006-02-28 Honeywell International Inc. Methods and systems for providing MEMS devices with a top cap and upper sense plate
US20050086797A1 (en) * 2003-10-24 2005-04-28 Eugen Popescu Aluminum heat sink for a solid state relay having ultrasonically welded copper foil
CA2554607C (en) 2004-02-27 2011-04-26 Gentex Corporation Vehicular rearview mirror elements and assemblies incorporating these elements
US7088970B2 (en) * 2004-05-26 2006-08-08 Halliburton Energy Services, Inc. Amplification apparatus, systems, and methods
US7864398B2 (en) 2004-06-08 2011-01-04 Gentex Corporation Electro-optical element including metallic films and methods for applying the same
US20060033676A1 (en) * 2004-08-10 2006-02-16 Kenneth Faase Display device
US7754091B2 (en) * 2004-08-31 2010-07-13 World Properties, Inc. Custom lamp from finished EL panel
US7400435B2 (en) 2005-01-19 2008-07-15 Donnelly Corporation Mirror assembly with heater element
US8085256B2 (en) * 2005-04-28 2011-12-27 Sharp Kabushiki Kaisha Electronic device
JP4621734B2 (en) * 2005-04-28 2011-01-26 シャープ株式会社 Display device and electronic apparatus equipped with the same
DE102005020129A1 (en) * 2005-04-29 2006-11-09 Tyco Electronics Amp Gmbh Solar module for generating electrical energy
US11498487B2 (en) 2005-07-06 2022-11-15 Magna Mirrors Of America, Inc. Vehicular exterior mirror system with blind spot indicator
WO2008051910A2 (en) 2006-10-24 2008-05-02 Donnelly Corporation Display device for exterior mirror
US11242009B2 (en) 2005-07-06 2022-02-08 Donnelly Corporation Vehicular exterior mirror system with blind spot indicator
US8590142B2 (en) * 2005-12-09 2013-11-26 Arata Tanaka Process for producing PTC device
US20110017725A1 (en) * 2006-02-10 2011-01-27 Radiant Glass Industries, Llc Heated laminated glass panels
US7688495B2 (en) 2006-03-03 2010-03-30 Gentex Corporation Thin-film coatings, electro-optic elements and assemblies incorporating these elements
US8274729B2 (en) 2006-03-03 2012-09-25 Gentex Corporation Thin-film coatings, electro-optic elements and assemblies incorporating these elements
EP2426552A1 (en) 2006-03-03 2012-03-07 Gentex Corporation Electro-optic elements incorporating improved thin-film coatings
US8368992B2 (en) 2006-03-03 2013-02-05 Gentex Corporation Electro-optical element including IMI coatings
US8169681B2 (en) 2006-03-03 2012-05-01 Gentex Corporation Thin-film coatings, electro-optic elements and assemblies incorporating these elements
US7746534B2 (en) 2006-12-07 2010-06-29 Gentex Corporation Thin-film coatings, electro-optic elements and assemblies incorporating these elements
KR101529840B1 (en) 2006-06-09 2015-06-17 애플 인크. Touch screen liquid crystal display
CA2697958A1 (en) 2006-08-31 2008-03-06 Antaya Technologies Corporation Buss bar strip
US7944371B2 (en) 2007-11-05 2011-05-17 Magna Mirrors Of America, Inc. Exterior mirror with indicator
US11890991B2 (en) 2006-10-24 2024-02-06 Magna Mirrors Of America, Inc. Vehicular exterior rearview mirror assembly with blind spot indicator element
FR2908229B1 (en) * 2006-11-03 2023-04-28 Saint Gobain TRANSPARENT LAYER WITH HIGH ELECTRICAL CONDUCTIVITY WITH A METALLIC GRID WITH OPTIMIZED ELECTROCHEMICAL RESISTANCE SUITABLE FOR UNDERGOING A HEAT TREATMENT OF THE BOWING OR TEMPERING TYPE
US8317343B2 (en) * 2006-12-31 2012-11-27 Honda Motor Co., Ltd. Interior or exterior rearview mirror assembly
US8079722B2 (en) * 2006-12-31 2011-12-20 Honda Motor Co., Ltd. Mirror assembly
US9710095B2 (en) 2007-01-05 2017-07-18 Apple Inc. Touch screen stack-ups
US7893890B2 (en) * 2007-03-05 2011-02-22 The Boeing Company Electrically dimmable combiner optics for head-up display
US8649083B2 (en) 2007-03-05 2014-02-11 Gentex Corporation Multi-zone mirrors
US9274394B2 (en) 2007-03-05 2016-03-01 Gentex Corporation Multi-zone mirrors
US10017847B2 (en) 2007-03-05 2018-07-10 Gentex Corporation Method and apparatus for ion milling
US8035881B2 (en) 2007-03-05 2011-10-11 Gentex Corporation Multi-zone mirrors
WO2008117605A1 (en) * 2007-03-23 2008-10-02 Hamamatsu Foundation For Science And Technology Promotion Large-area transparent electroconductive film and process for producing the same
US7748856B2 (en) 2007-05-23 2010-07-06 Donnelly Corporation Exterior mirror element with integral wide angle portion
US8593714B2 (en) * 2008-05-19 2013-11-26 Ajjer, Llc Composite electrode and electrolytes comprising nanoparticles and resulting devices
US8115984B2 (en) * 2007-06-18 2012-02-14 Ajjer Llc Laminated electrochromic devices and processes for forming the same
KR20100056552A (en) * 2007-09-10 2010-05-27 다이솔 인더스트리즈 피티와이 엘티디 A method for manufacturing solar cells
EP2080648A1 (en) * 2008-01-21 2009-07-22 Visiocorp Patents S.à.r.l. Climate control system
US8988756B2 (en) * 2008-01-31 2015-03-24 Ajjer, Llc Conductive busbars and sealants for chromogenic devices
WO2009099900A2 (en) * 2008-01-31 2009-08-13 Electrochromix Inc. Environmentally safe electrochromic devices and assemblies
US8154418B2 (en) 2008-03-31 2012-04-10 Magna Mirrors Of America, Inc. Interior rearview mirror system
US7535614B1 (en) 2008-05-27 2009-05-19 Gentex Corporation Electrical window control system and method thereof
US7813023B2 (en) 2008-06-09 2010-10-12 Magna Mirrors Of America, Inc. Electro-optic mirror
US9487144B2 (en) 2008-10-16 2016-11-08 Magna Mirrors Of America, Inc. Interior mirror assembly with display
FR2939527B1 (en) * 2008-12-05 2011-10-21 Saint Gobain ELECTRO-CONTROLLABLE DEVICE HAVING IMPROVED DELIVERY OF ELECTRICAL LOADS OF THE ELECTROACTIVE ENVIRONMENT
US20100265078A1 (en) * 2009-04-20 2010-10-21 Integrated Sensors, Llc Plasma panel based ionizing-particle radiation detector
CN102460234B (en) 2009-04-23 2014-06-25 麦格纳镜片美国有限公司 Mirror assembly for vehicle
US11325533B2 (en) 2009-04-23 2022-05-10 Magna Mirrors Of America, Inc. Frameless interior rearview mirror assembly
US20110056924A1 (en) * 2009-09-10 2011-03-10 Benjamin Park Townsend Solar defrost panels
US9346403B2 (en) 2009-10-07 2016-05-24 Magna Mirrors Of America, Inc. Rearview mirror assembly
US11498486B2 (en) 2009-10-07 2022-11-15 Magna Mirrors Of America, Inc. Vehicular exterior rearview mirror assembly
EP2485921B1 (en) 2009-10-07 2016-06-15 Magna Mirrors Of America, Inc. Frameless interior rearview mirror assembly
US10261648B2 (en) 2009-10-07 2019-04-16 Magna Mirrors Of America, Inc. Exterior rearview mirror assembly
US10690540B2 (en) 2015-10-06 2020-06-23 View, Inc. Multi-sensor having a light diffusing element around a periphery of a ring of photosensors
US10303035B2 (en) 2009-12-22 2019-05-28 View, Inc. Self-contained EC IGU
US8213074B1 (en) 2011-03-16 2012-07-03 Soladigm, Inc. Onboard controller for multistate windows
US11314139B2 (en) 2009-12-22 2022-04-26 View, Inc. Self-contained EC IGU
US20130271813A1 (en) 2012-04-17 2013-10-17 View, Inc. Controller for optically-switchable windows
US11592723B2 (en) 2009-12-22 2023-02-28 View, Inc. Automated commissioning of controllers in a window network
US9205780B2 (en) 2010-02-04 2015-12-08 Magna Mirrors Of America, Inc. Electro-optic rearview mirror assembly for vehicle
US9969334B2 (en) 2010-02-10 2018-05-15 Magna Mirrors Of America, Inc. Exterior rearview mirror assembly
US9827913B2 (en) 2010-02-10 2017-11-28 Magna Mirrors Of America, Inc. Exterior rearview mirror assembly
JP5355515B2 (en) 2010-05-06 2013-11-27 株式会社村田製作所 Touch panel, touch input device, and control method thereof
US9481304B2 (en) 2010-05-24 2016-11-01 Magna Mirrors Of America, Inc. Automotive exterior mirror heater control
FR2961916B1 (en) * 2010-06-25 2013-04-12 Saint Gobain LIQUID CRYSTAL VARIABLE DIFFUSION SHEET, METHOD FOR MANUFACTURING SAME, AND DEVICE FOR MANUFACTURING THE SAME
US9056584B2 (en) 2010-07-08 2015-06-16 Gentex Corporation Rearview assembly for a vehicle
US8270059B2 (en) 2010-08-05 2012-09-18 Soladigm, Inc. Multi-pane electrochromic windows
WO2012079160A1 (en) 2010-12-15 2012-06-21 Switch Materials, Inc. Variable transmittance optical filter with substantially co- planar electrode system
US8804056B2 (en) 2010-12-22 2014-08-12 Apple Inc. Integrated touch screens
US10571772B2 (en) 2011-01-11 2020-02-25 Ajjer, Llc Added feature electrooptical devices and automotive components
US11054792B2 (en) 2012-04-13 2021-07-06 View, Inc. Monitoring sites containing switchable optical devices and controllers
US8705162B2 (en) 2012-04-17 2014-04-22 View, Inc. Controlling transitions in optically switchable devices
US9454055B2 (en) 2011-03-16 2016-09-27 View, Inc. Multipurpose controller for multistate windows
US11630367B2 (en) 2011-03-16 2023-04-18 View, Inc. Driving thin film switchable optical devices
US9030725B2 (en) 2012-04-17 2015-05-12 View, Inc. Driving thin film switchable optical devices
US9412290B2 (en) 2013-06-28 2016-08-09 View, Inc. Controlling transitions in optically switchable devices
US9778532B2 (en) 2011-03-16 2017-10-03 View, Inc. Controlling transitions in optically switchable devices
US9645465B2 (en) 2011-03-16 2017-05-09 View, Inc. Controlling transitions in optically switchable devices
US8254013B2 (en) 2011-03-16 2012-08-28 Soladigm, Inc. Controlling transitions in optically switchable devices
US10935865B2 (en) 2011-03-16 2021-03-02 View, Inc. Driving thin film switchable optical devices
US8988755B2 (en) 2011-05-13 2015-03-24 Magna Mirrors Of America, Inc. Mirror reflective element
US9375804B2 (en) * 2011-07-27 2016-06-28 GM Global Technology Operations LLC Low pressure electron beam welding of Li-ion battery connections
JP5876250B2 (en) * 2011-08-19 2016-03-02 富士電機機器制御株式会社 Electromagnetic coil drive device
US8736940B2 (en) 2011-09-30 2014-05-27 Magna Mirrors Of America, Inc. Exterior mirror with integral spotter mirror and method of making same
US9717862B2 (en) 2011-10-13 2017-08-01 Mequ Aps Infusion fluid warmer
WO2013059674A1 (en) 2011-10-21 2013-04-25 View, Inc. Mitigating thermal shock in tintable windows
US8801245B2 (en) 2011-11-14 2014-08-12 Magna Mirrors Of America, Inc. Illumination module for vehicle
US9316347B2 (en) 2012-01-24 2016-04-19 Gentex Corporation Rearview assembly with interchangeable rearward viewing device
US9302452B2 (en) 2012-03-02 2016-04-05 Ppg Industries Ohio, Inc. Transparent laminates comprising inkjet printed conductive lines and methods of forming the same
US9341912B2 (en) 2012-03-13 2016-05-17 View, Inc. Multi-zone EC windows
US11635666B2 (en) 2012-03-13 2023-04-25 View, Inc Methods of controlling multi-zone tintable windows
US11950340B2 (en) 2012-03-13 2024-04-02 View, Inc. Adjusting interior lighting based on dynamic glass tinting
US10048561B2 (en) 2013-02-21 2018-08-14 View, Inc. Control method for tintable windows
US10503039B2 (en) 2013-06-28 2019-12-10 View, Inc. Controlling transitions in optically switchable devices
ES2625003T3 (en) 2012-04-13 2017-07-18 View, Inc. Applications to optically control switchable devices
US11674843B2 (en) 2015-10-06 2023-06-13 View, Inc. Infrared cloud detector systems and methods
US9638978B2 (en) 2013-02-21 2017-05-02 View, Inc. Control method for tintable windows
US11300848B2 (en) 2015-10-06 2022-04-12 View, Inc. Controllers for optically-switchable devices
US10964320B2 (en) 2012-04-13 2021-03-30 View, Inc. Controlling optically-switchable devices
US8879139B2 (en) 2012-04-24 2014-11-04 Gentex Corporation Display mirror assembly
US9257886B2 (en) 2012-05-15 2016-02-09 Hamilton Sundstrand Corporation Rotating rectifier assembly bus bar
JP6088048B2 (en) 2012-06-12 2017-03-01 モナシュ ユニバーシティ Breathable electrode structure and method and system for water splitting
US8968916B2 (en) * 2012-06-29 2015-03-03 Intel Corporation Non-uniform battery cell
US8864322B2 (en) 2012-08-24 2014-10-21 Gentex Corporation Shaped rearview mirror assembly
CN102969805B (en) * 2012-12-07 2015-02-18 四川大学 Microwave energy switching device
US9327648B2 (en) 2013-01-04 2016-05-03 Gentex Corporation Rearview assembly with exposed carrier plate
US9488892B2 (en) 2013-01-09 2016-11-08 Gentex Corporation Printed appliqué and method thereof
US11719990B2 (en) 2013-02-21 2023-08-08 View, Inc. Control method for tintable windows
US9351400B1 (en) 2013-02-21 2016-05-24 Apple Inc. Electrical connections between conductive contacts
US9216691B2 (en) 2013-02-25 2015-12-22 Magna Mirrors Of America, Inc. Exterior mirror with spotter mirror
WO2014137378A1 (en) * 2013-03-08 2014-09-12 Sage Electrochromics, Inc. Electrochromic device with multiple independently controllable zones and internal busbars
WO2014164477A1 (en) * 2013-03-12 2014-10-09 Apple Inc. Lowering the sheet resistance of a conductive layer
US9174578B2 (en) 2013-04-22 2015-11-03 Magna Mirrors Of America, Inc. Interior rearview mirror assembly
US9885935B2 (en) 2013-06-28 2018-02-06 View, Inc. Controlling transitions in optically switchable devices
US10355283B2 (en) 2013-07-31 2019-07-16 Aquahydrez Pty Ltd Electro-synthetic or electro-energy cell with gas diffusion electrode(s)
KR20150031917A (en) 2013-09-17 2015-03-25 엘지이노텍 주식회사 Electrode Plate and Eletrochomic Plate, Electrochomic Mirror and Display Device Using the Same
AU2014326772B2 (en) 2013-09-24 2017-07-20 Gentex Corporation Display mirror assembly
EP3052985B1 (en) * 2013-10-04 2019-07-24 Gentex Corporation Variable transmittance window system
US9454054B2 (en) 2013-11-18 2016-09-27 Magna Mirrors Of America, Inc. Electro-optic mirror element and process of making same
US11906868B2 (en) 2013-12-24 2024-02-20 View, Inc. Obscuring bus bars in electrochromic glass structures
KR102108830B1 (en) * 2014-01-21 2020-05-11 엘지이노텍 주식회사 Electrochromic Device
US9337525B2 (en) * 2014-02-03 2016-05-10 Pittsburgh Glass Works, Llc Hidden window antenna
US10221612B2 (en) 2014-02-04 2019-03-05 View, Inc. Infill electrochromic windows
CA3156883A1 (en) 2014-03-05 2015-09-11 View, Inc. Monitoring sites containing switchable optical devices and controllers
DE102014205522B3 (en) * 2014-03-25 2015-08-27 Magna Steyr Battery Systems Gmbh & Co Og Method for connecting a plurality of galvanic cells to cell connectors
US9761144B2 (en) 2014-09-11 2017-09-12 Magna Mirrors Of America, Inc. Exterior mirror with blind zone indicator
GB201416175D0 (en) * 2014-09-12 2014-10-29 Pilkington Group Ltd Heated coated glazing
US9694751B2 (en) 2014-09-19 2017-07-04 Gentex Corporation Rearview assembly
US10025154B2 (en) * 2014-09-25 2018-07-17 Apple Inc. Camera lens filter
US10227046B2 (en) 2014-10-27 2019-03-12 Magna Mirrors Of America, Inc. Sun visor and vanity mirror assembly for vehicle
US9694752B2 (en) 2014-11-07 2017-07-04 Gentex Corporation Full display mirror actuator
EP3218227B1 (en) 2014-11-13 2018-10-24 Gentex Corporation Rearview mirror system with a display
JP6553186B2 (en) 2014-12-03 2019-07-31 ジェンテックス コーポレイション Display mirror assembly
USD746744S1 (en) 2014-12-05 2016-01-05 Gentex Corporation Rearview device
JP6720210B2 (en) * 2015-01-12 2020-07-08 キネストラル・テクノロジーズ・インコーポレイテッドKinestral Technologies,Inc. Driver for electrochromic glass unit
US9776569B2 (en) 2015-01-30 2017-10-03 Magna Mirrors Of America, Inc. Exterior mirror with heater pad
EP3286038A4 (en) 2015-04-20 2018-04-25 Gentex Corporation Rearview assembly with applique
CN107614324B (en) 2015-05-18 2020-11-27 金泰克斯公司 Complete display rearview device
TWI746446B (en) 2015-07-07 2021-11-21 美商唯景公司 Viewcontrol methods for tintable windows
WO2017027407A1 (en) * 2015-08-07 2017-02-16 Kinestral Technologies, Inc. Electrochromic device assemblies
WO2017029043A1 (en) * 2015-08-14 2017-02-23 Mequ A/S Infusion fluid warmer comprising printed circuit board heating elements
US9939703B1 (en) 2015-09-29 2018-04-10 Apple Inc. Electrochromic devices having reduced switching times and their methods of manufacture
CN108136962B (en) 2015-09-30 2021-06-29 金泰克斯公司 Full display mirror
US11255722B2 (en) 2015-10-06 2022-02-22 View, Inc. Infrared cloud detector systems and methods
CA3001233A1 (en) * 2015-10-09 2017-04-13 View, Inc. Controlling transitions in optically switchable devices
JP7024947B2 (en) 2015-10-29 2022-02-24 ビュー, インコーポレイテッド Controller for optically switchable devices
CN108349435B (en) 2015-10-30 2021-06-15 金泰克斯公司 Switching board
CN108349436B (en) 2015-10-30 2019-12-20 金泰克斯公司 Rear-view device
US9986669B2 (en) * 2015-11-25 2018-05-29 Ppg Industries Ohio, Inc. Transparency including conductive mesh including a closed shape having at least one curved side
US10214147B2 (en) 2015-12-04 2019-02-26 Gentex Corporation Tight bezel-to-glass fit mirror assembly
CN108463769B (en) * 2015-12-21 2023-01-06 唯景公司 Bus bar in a shielded electrochromic glass structure
USD845851S1 (en) 2016-03-31 2019-04-16 Gentex Corporation Rearview device
KR102619723B1 (en) * 2016-04-14 2023-12-28 삼성에스디아이 주식회사 Battery pack
USD817238S1 (en) 2016-04-29 2018-05-08 Gentex Corporation Rearview device
CN109275336A (en) 2016-04-29 2019-01-25 唯景公司 The calibration of electrical parameter in optical switchable fenestra
EP3458906B1 (en) * 2016-05-17 2022-10-26 Merck Patent GmbH Device for controlling transmission of radiation
US10543785B2 (en) 2016-06-03 2020-01-28 Magna Mirrors Of America, Inc. Rearview mirror assembly with rounded front substrate
US10025138B2 (en) 2016-06-06 2018-07-17 Gentex Corporation Illuminating display with light gathering structure
USD809984S1 (en) 2016-12-07 2018-02-13 Gentex Corporation Rearview assembly
USD854473S1 (en) 2016-12-16 2019-07-23 Gentex Corporation Rearview assembly
US10520780B2 (en) * 2016-12-21 2019-12-31 Southwall Technologies Inc. Electroactive device provided with a trilayer bus bar
WO2018195458A1 (en) 2017-04-20 2018-10-25 Cardinal Ig Company High performance privacy glazing structures
US11513412B2 (en) 2017-04-26 2022-11-29 View, Inc. Displays for tintable windows
US10575449B1 (en) * 2017-06-19 2020-02-25 Rockwell Collins, Inc. Combined high frequency EMI shield and substrate heater using a thin film
US10705363B2 (en) 2017-07-13 2020-07-07 Cardinal Ig Company Electrical connection configurations for privacy glazing structures
US11333810B2 (en) 2017-08-25 2022-05-17 Solutia Canada Inc. System of networked controllers, and method of operating a system of networked controllers
WO2019050158A1 (en) * 2017-09-11 2019-03-14 엘지전자 주식회사 Compound solar cell module and manufacturing method thereof
US10538203B2 (en) 2017-10-10 2020-01-21 Magna Mirrors Of America, Inc. Interior rearview mirror assembly with indicator
EP3707555A1 (en) 2017-11-06 2020-09-16 Cardinal Ig Company Privacy glazing system with discrete electrical driver
US11573473B2 (en) * 2017-11-27 2023-02-07 Canon Kabushiki Kaisha Electrochromic device
JP7277110B2 (en) * 2017-11-27 2023-05-18 キヤノン株式会社 electrochromic element
DE102018200659B4 (en) * 2018-01-16 2020-11-05 Continental Automotive Gmbh Multi-layer arrangement for a two-dimensional switchable glazing, glazing and vehicle
US11067868B2 (en) 2018-03-23 2021-07-20 Gentex Corporation Thin wire bus bar
WO2019217693A1 (en) 2018-05-09 2019-11-14 Cardinal Ig Company Electrically controllable privacy glazing with energy recapturing driver
CN112585529A (en) 2018-07-16 2021-03-30 波利斯德有限公司 Polymer composition for variable transmission and electrochemical devices
US20200026103A1 (en) * 2018-07-17 2020-01-23 Alan Logan Adjustable Window Transparency Control System
US11292388B2 (en) 2018-07-17 2022-04-05 Magna Mirrors Of America, Inc. Electro-optic drive system for vehicular mirror
US11422393B2 (en) * 2018-07-18 2022-08-23 Gentex Corporation Electro-optic device with wire embedded in an adhesive seal
KR102555984B1 (en) * 2018-07-27 2023-07-14 삼성디스플레이 주식회사 Display device with a force sensor
EP4234229A3 (en) 2018-08-17 2024-02-21 Cardinal Ig Company Privacy glazing structure with asymetrical pane offsets for electrical connection configurations
EP3614407B1 (en) * 2018-08-24 2020-08-05 Rogers BV Electrical energy storage device
US11839939B2 (en) * 2018-09-27 2023-12-12 Illinois Tool Works Inc. Systems, methods, and apparatus for pre-regulator control in welding-type power supplies
US10976633B2 (en) * 2018-10-09 2021-04-13 Gentex Corporation Conductive bus bar with dark or colored appearance
US11474385B1 (en) 2018-12-02 2022-10-18 Cardinal Ig Company Electrically controllable privacy glazing with ultralow power consumption comprising a liquid crystal material having a light transmittance that varies in response to application of an electric field
US11745702B2 (en) 2018-12-11 2023-09-05 Ppg Industries Ohio, Inc. Coating including electrically conductive lines directly on electrically conductive layer
EP3918112A4 (en) 2019-02-01 2022-10-26 Aquahydrex, Inc. Electrochemical system with confined electrolyte
CN113518712A (en) 2019-02-08 2021-10-19 卡迪纳尔Ig公司 Low power driver for privacy glazing
KR102590936B1 (en) * 2019-02-25 2023-10-18 주식회사 엘지화학 Optical Device
US11175523B2 (en) 2019-04-29 2021-11-16 Cardinal Ig Company Staggered driving electrical control of a plurality of electrically controllable privacy glazing structures
WO2020223297A1 (en) 2019-04-29 2020-11-05 Cardinal Ig Company Systems and methods for operating one or more electrically controllable privacy glazing structures
KR20220013371A (en) 2019-04-29 2022-02-04 카디날 아이지 컴퍼니 Leakage current detection and control for one or more electrically controllable privacy glass structures
WO2021016550A1 (en) * 2019-07-25 2021-01-28 Gentex Corporation Segmented variable controlled electro-optic element
US11938795B2 (en) 2019-10-18 2024-03-26 Magna Electronics Inc. Vehicular vision system with glare reducing windshield
US11318888B2 (en) 2019-10-30 2022-05-03 Magna Mirrors Of America, Inc. Interior rearview mirror assembly with battery charge level indicator
US11505127B2 (en) 2019-11-14 2022-11-22 Magna Mirrors Of America, Inc. System for automatically dispensing spacer beads for spacing substrates of a mirror reflective element
US11433814B2 (en) 2020-02-24 2022-09-06 Magna Mirrors Of America, Inc. Process for manufacturing a plurality of EC mirror cells using glass sheet for multiple front substrates
TW202206925A (en) 2020-03-26 2022-02-16 美商視野公司 Access and messaging in a multi client network
DE102021203783B4 (en) 2020-04-17 2022-04-28 Magna Mirrors Of America, Inc. INTERNAL REARVIEW MIRROR ARRANGEMENT WITH DRIVER MONITORING SYSTEM
US11631493B2 (en) 2020-05-27 2023-04-18 View Operating Corporation Systems and methods for managing building wellness
US11780372B2 (en) 2021-03-01 2023-10-10 Magna Mirrors Of America, Inc. Vehicular driver monitoring system with driver monitoring camera and near IR light emitter at interior rearview mirror assembly
BR112023017212A2 (en) 2021-03-01 2023-09-26 Magna Mirrors Of America Inc Interior rear view mirror assembly with driver monitoring system

Family Cites Families (55)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US3521941A (en) 1967-02-07 1970-07-28 American Cyanamid Co Electro-optical device having variable optical density
US4164365A (en) 1972-07-31 1979-08-14 Research Frontiers Incorporated Light valve for controlling the transmission of radiation comprising a cell and a stabilized liquid suspension
US3807832A (en) 1972-11-09 1974-04-30 American Cyanamid Co Electrochromic (ec) mirror which rapidly changes reflectivity
US3813142A (en) * 1972-12-04 1974-05-28 Gte Laboratories Inc Electro-optic variable phase diffraction grating and modulator
USRE30835E (en) 1973-12-26 1981-12-29 American Cyanamid Company Self-supporting pigment layers for electrochromic display
US4174152A (en) 1978-02-13 1979-11-13 American Cyanamid Company Electrochromic devices with polymeric electrolytes
US4298970A (en) 1979-08-10 1981-11-03 Sperry-Sun, Inc. Borehole acoustic telemetry system synchronous detector
JPS5662229A (en) 1979-10-25 1981-05-28 Asahi Glass Co Ltd Electro-optical dimming panel
JPS60216333A (en) 1984-04-12 1985-10-29 Asahi Glass Co Ltd Electrochromic display element
US4652090A (en) 1984-04-20 1987-03-24 Nippon Kogaku K. K. Dispersed iridium based complementary electrochromic device
US4671619A (en) 1984-07-24 1987-06-09 Asahi Glass Company, Ltd. Electro-optic device
US4761061A (en) 1985-09-19 1988-08-02 Asahi Glass Company Ltd. Method for fabrication of electrochromic device and the same fabricated by the method
US4902108A (en) 1986-03-31 1990-02-20 Gentex Corporation Single-compartment, self-erasing, solution-phase electrochromic devices, solutions for use therein, and uses thereof
US4712879A (en) 1986-04-02 1987-12-15 Donnelly Corporation Electrochromic mirror
US4793690A (en) 1986-07-18 1988-12-27 Donnelly Corporation Rearview mirror control circuit
JPS63106731A (en) 1986-10-24 1988-05-11 Asahi Glass Co Ltd Dimmer body
JPS63106730A (en) 1986-10-24 1988-05-11 Asahi Glass Co Ltd Dimmer body
US5007718A (en) 1987-04-02 1991-04-16 Kabushiki Kaisha Toyota Chuo Kenkyusho Electrochromic elements and methods of manufacturing and driving the same
US4799768A (en) 1987-04-27 1989-01-24 Donnelly Corporation Automatic rearview mirror with filtered light sensors
US4768865A (en) 1987-06-10 1988-09-06 Ppg Industries, Inc. Electrochromic window with metal grid counter electrode
US5241411A (en) 1987-07-02 1993-08-31 Saint-Gobain Vitrage Electrochromic variable transmission glazing
US5073012A (en) 1988-02-12 1991-12-17 Donnelly Corporation Anti-scatter, ultraviolet protected, anti-misting, electro-optical assemblies
US5239406A (en) 1988-02-12 1993-08-24 Donnelly Corporation Near-infrared reflecting, ultraviolet protected, safety protected, electrochromic vehicular glazing
US5187607A (en) 1989-03-13 1993-02-16 Nikon Corporation Electrochromic device with low resistance electrical connections
US5066111A (en) 1989-09-13 1991-11-19 Ppg Industries, Inc. Electrochromic window with integrated bus bars
US5140455A (en) 1989-11-29 1992-08-18 Donnelly Corporation High performance electrochemichromic solutions and devices thereof
US5066112A (en) 1989-12-21 1991-11-19 Donnelly Corporation Perimeter coated, electro-optic mirror
US5142407A (en) 1989-12-22 1992-08-25 Donnelly Corporation Method of reducing leakage current in electrochemichromic solutions and solutions based thereon
US5076674A (en) 1990-03-09 1991-12-31 Donnelly Corporation Reduced first surface reflectivity electrochromic/electrochemichromic rearview mirror assembly
US5148014A (en) 1990-08-10 1992-09-15 Donnelly Corporation Mirror system with remotely actuated continuously variable reflectant mirrors
US5076673A (en) 1990-08-10 1991-12-31 Donnelly Corporation Prolonged coloration electrochromic assembly
US5122647A (en) 1990-08-10 1992-06-16 Donnelly Corporation Vehicular mirror system with remotely actuated continuously variable reflectance mirrors
FR2666804B1 (en) 1990-09-14 1993-05-28 Saint Gobain Vitrage Int ELECTROCHROME GLAZING.
US5151824A (en) 1990-11-26 1992-09-29 Donnelly Corporation Vehicular outside mirror assembly
US5220317A (en) 1990-12-11 1993-06-15 Donnelly Corporation Electrochromic device capable of prolonged coloration
US5293546A (en) 1991-04-17 1994-03-08 Martin Marietta Corporation Oxide coated metal grid electrode structure in display devices
JPH04324842A (en) 1991-04-25 1992-11-13 Tonen Corp Electrochromic element
US5424898A (en) 1991-08-16 1995-06-13 Donnelly Corporation Fault tolerant drive circuit for electrochromic mirror system
US5193029A (en) 1991-11-19 1993-03-09 Donnelly Corporation Single sensor adaptive drive circuit for rearview mirror system
US5212583A (en) * 1992-01-08 1993-05-18 Hughes Aircraft Company Adaptive optics using the electrooptic effect
US5202787A (en) 1992-01-10 1993-04-13 Gentex Corporation Electro-optic device
FR2690763B1 (en) 1992-04-30 1995-06-09 Saint Gobain Vitrage Int METHOD AND DEVICE FOR SUPPLYING AN ELECTROCHROMIC SYSTEM.
FR2691550B1 (en) 1992-05-21 1995-04-21 Saint Gobain Vitrage Int Architectural electrochromic glazing.
GB2268595B (en) 1992-07-08 1995-11-15 Glaverbel Electrochromic cell
US5377037A (en) 1992-11-06 1994-12-27 Midwest Research Institute Electrochromic-photovoltaic film for light-sensitive control of optical transmittance
US5910854A (en) * 1993-02-26 1999-06-08 Donnelly Corporation Electrochromic polymeric solid films, manufacturing electrochromic devices using such solid films, and processes for making such solid films and devices
DE69426040T2 (en) 1993-02-26 2001-05-17 Donnelly Corp Electrochromic polymeric solid films, manufacture of electrochromic devices with such films, and processes for the manufacture of such solid films and devices
US5724176A (en) 1993-03-30 1998-03-03 Nippon Oil Co., Ltd. Counterelectrode for smart window and smart window
US5657150A (en) * 1993-09-10 1997-08-12 Eyeonics Corporation Electrochromic edge isolation-interconnect system, process, and device for its manufacture
US5668663A (en) * 1994-05-05 1997-09-16 Donnelly Corporation Electrochromic mirrors and devices
FR2719915B1 (en) * 1994-05-16 1996-06-14 Saint Gobain Vitrage Electrochromic system and its supply process.
US5744267A (en) 1994-10-12 1998-04-28 Arizona Board Of Regents Acting For And On Behalf Of University Of Arizona Azo-dye-doped photorefractive polymer composites for holographic testing and image processing
US5604626A (en) 1995-02-10 1997-02-18 Donnelly Corporation Photochromic devices
EP0898730A4 (en) 1996-04-10 2001-09-26 Donnelly Corp Electrochromic devices
US6124886A (en) * 1997-08-25 2000-09-26 Donnelly Corporation Modular rearview mirror assembly

Cited By (62)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US8632898B2 (en) 2003-10-28 2014-01-21 Johnson Controls Technology Company Battery system including batteries that have a plurality of positive terminals and a plurality of negative terminals
US20050174092A1 (en) * 2003-10-28 2005-08-11 Johnson Controls Technology Company Battery system
US7782519B2 (en) 2004-03-12 2010-08-24 The Boeing Company Multi-color electrochromic apparatus and methods
US20050200934A1 (en) * 2004-03-12 2005-09-15 The Boeing Company Dimming control system for an array of electrochromic devices
US20050200933A1 (en) * 2004-03-12 2005-09-15 The Boeing Company Low vapor pressure solvent for electrochromic devices
US20050200937A1 (en) * 2004-03-12 2005-09-15 The Boeing Company Multi-color electrochromic apparatus and methods
US20080259433A1 (en) * 2004-03-12 2008-10-23 The Boeing Company Multi-color electrochromic apparatus and methods
US7450294B2 (en) 2004-03-12 2008-11-11 Boeing Co Multi-color electrochromic apparatus and methods
US8988757B2 (en) 2004-03-12 2015-03-24 The Boeing Company Low vapor pressure solvent for electrochromic devices
US8064120B2 (en) 2004-03-12 2011-11-22 The Boeing Company Aircraft cabin services system including zone controllers for lighting control modules and dimmable windows
US20050224109A1 (en) * 2004-04-09 2005-10-13 Posbic Jean P Enhanced function photovoltaic modules
US20080198584A1 (en) * 2005-05-17 2008-08-21 Nervecorp Limited Building Structures Having Electrically Functional Architectural Surfaces
US7551452B2 (en) * 2005-07-04 2009-06-23 Nitto Denko Corporation Printed circuit board
US20070000689A1 (en) * 2005-07-04 2007-01-04 Nitto Denko Corporation Printed circuit board
US7355161B2 (en) 2005-12-15 2008-04-08 The Boeing Company Systems and methods for controlling windows with variable light transmission
WO2010093703A1 (en) * 2009-02-10 2010-08-19 Applied Nanotech Holdings, Inc. Electrochromic device
US20120147448A1 (en) * 2009-02-10 2012-06-14 Applied Nanotech Holdings, Inc, Electrochromic device
WO2011035090A1 (en) * 2009-09-17 2011-03-24 Tetrasun, Inc. Selective transformation in functional films, and solar cell applications thereof
US9564542B2 (en) 2009-09-17 2017-02-07 Tetrasun, Inc. Selective transformation in functional films, and solar cell applications thereof
US8237535B2 (en) 2010-04-16 2012-08-07 World Properties, Inc. Integral planar transformer and busbar
US20110301771A1 (en) * 2010-06-04 2011-12-08 Alcatel-Lucent Canada, Inc. High-voltage step-charge control for use in network-powered applications
US8560137B2 (en) * 2010-06-04 2013-10-15 Alcatel Lucent High-voltage step-charge control for use in network-powered applications
US20130061904A1 (en) * 2011-09-14 2013-03-14 Au Optronics Corporation Solar cell module
US8609976B2 (en) * 2011-09-14 2013-12-17 Au Optronics Corporation Solar cell module
US11181796B2 (en) 2012-02-28 2021-11-23 Sage Electrochromics, Inc. Multi-zone electrochromic device
US10268097B2 (en) * 2012-02-28 2019-04-23 Sage Electrochromics, Inc. Multi-zone electrochromic device
JP2015508189A (en) * 2012-02-28 2015-03-16 セイジ・エレクトロクロミクス,インコーポレイテッド Multi-zone electrochromic device
US11624963B2 (en) 2013-03-07 2023-04-11 Solutia Canada Inc. Seal and seal system for a layered device
US10254617B2 (en) 2013-12-19 2019-04-09 Switch Materials Inc. Switchable objects and methods of manufacture
JP2017504057A (en) * 2013-12-19 2017-02-02 スイッチ マテリアルズ インコーポレイテッドSwitch Materials Inc. Switchable object and manufacturing method
US11537021B2 (en) 2013-12-19 2022-12-27 Solutia Canada Inc. Switchable objects and methods of manufacture
JP2016133648A (en) * 2015-01-20 2016-07-25 株式会社リコー Electrochromic device and manufacturing method thereof
US10392096B2 (en) * 2015-05-12 2019-08-27 Airbus Operations S.A.S. Access device provided with a folding door enabling secure communication between at least two zones of an enclosure
US10111780B2 (en) 2015-10-23 2018-10-30 Abominable Labs, Llc Goggle lens and face gasket engagement system
WO2017070628A1 (en) * 2015-10-23 2017-04-27 Abominable Labs, Llc Electrical interconnection system for heating eye-shield
US10398601B2 (en) 2015-10-23 2019-09-03 Abominable Labs, Llc Immersive experience headset adapted to prevent fogging
US11086184B1 (en) * 2016-04-20 2021-08-10 Kinestral Technologies, Inc Electrochromic devices having optimized visual characteristics
JP2017194599A (en) * 2016-04-21 2017-10-26 大日本印刷株式会社 Light control film and method for driving light control film
US20180138344A1 (en) * 2016-11-17 2018-05-17 Ubiquitous Energy, Inc. Single cell photovoltaic module
KR20190107659A (en) * 2016-11-17 2019-09-20 유비쿼터스 에너지 인코포레이티드 Single cell photovoltaic module
WO2018094259A1 (en) * 2016-11-17 2018-05-24 Ubiquitous Energy, Inc. Single cell photovoltaic module
US11545589B2 (en) * 2016-11-17 2023-01-03 Ubiquitous Energy, Inc. Single cell photovoltaic module
CN110326118A (en) * 2016-11-17 2019-10-11 无处不在能量公司 Monocell photovoltaic module
KR102262823B1 (en) * 2016-11-17 2021-06-09 유비쿼터스 에너지 인코포레이티드 single cell photovoltaic module
US10741713B2 (en) * 2016-11-17 2020-08-11 Ubiquitous Energy, Inc. Single cell photovoltaic module
US11500258B2 (en) 2016-12-22 2022-11-15 Sage Electrochromics, Inc. Apparatus including an electrochromic device configured to maintain a continuously graded transmission state
US11951695B2 (en) * 2017-02-02 2024-04-09 Toray Industries, Inc. Method for producing fiber-reinforced plastic
US20200001550A1 (en) * 2017-02-02 2020-01-02 Toray Industries, Inc. Method for producing fiber-reinforced plastic
US11835833B2 (en) * 2017-04-27 2023-12-05 Lg Chem, Ltd. Electrochromic device
CN111247693A (en) * 2017-10-19 2020-06-05 韦弗有限责任公司 Phase modulator device for polymer dispersion/shear orientation
JP7277479B2 (en) 2018-07-06 2023-05-19 ガーディアン・グラス・エルエルシー Potential Driven Shade Including Shutters Supporting Surface Modified Conductive Coatings, Methods of Manufacture, and Methods of Operation
JP2021529715A (en) * 2018-07-06 2021-11-04 ガーディアン・グラス・エルエルシーGuardian Glass, Llc A potential-driven shade including a shutter that supports a surface-modified conductive coating, a method for manufacturing the shade, and a method for operating the shade.
CN111386193A (en) * 2018-10-26 2020-07-07 法国圣戈班玻璃厂 Composite glass pane comprising a functional element with electrically controllable optical properties which can be switched in a segment-like manner
WO2020083562A1 (en) 2018-10-26 2020-04-30 Saint-Gobain Glass France Composite panel with functional element which can be switched in segments and has electrically controllable optical properties
WO2020083563A1 (en) 2018-10-26 2020-04-30 Saint-Gobain Glass France Composite pane, having a functional element that can be switched in segments and that has electrically controllable optical properties
CN111386194A (en) * 2018-10-26 2020-07-07 法国圣戈班玻璃厂 Composite glass pane comprising a functional element with electrically controllable optical properties which can be switched in a segment-like manner
US20200331084A1 (en) * 2019-04-17 2020-10-22 Mahle International Gmbh Resistance soldering method and soldering device
US11731205B2 (en) * 2019-04-17 2023-08-22 Mahle International Gmbh Resistance soldering method and soldering device
RU2758579C2 (en) * 2020-02-17 2021-10-29 Сергей Олегович Лебедев Method and software and hardware complex for controlling electrochromic devices
TWI751020B (en) * 2020-08-14 2021-12-21 友達光電股份有限公司 Electronic device and manufacturing method of electronic device
CN113257127A (en) * 2020-08-14 2021-08-13 友达光电股份有限公司 Display device
WO2023109922A1 (en) * 2021-12-17 2023-06-22 光羿智能科技(苏州)有限公司 Electrochromic device

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
US6449082B1 (en) 2002-09-10
US6317248B1 (en) 2001-11-13

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
US6317248B1 (en) Busbars for electrically powered cells
US6178034B1 (en) Electrochromic devices
US5604626A (en) Photochromic devices
US10254616B2 (en) Variable transmittance optical filter with substantially co-planar electrode system
US7130101B2 (en) Switchable electrochromic devices with uniform switching and preferential area shading
KR100715331B1 (en) Electrochemical device such as an electrically controlled system with variable optical and/or energy properties
US4865428A (en) Electrooptical device
KR101613341B1 (en) Electrochromic multi-layer devices with spatially coordinated switching
RU2420772C2 (en) Electrochemical system on plastic substrate
RU2364905C1 (en) Electrochrome panel with several connecting devices
US7894120B2 (en) Electrochemical and/or electrocontrollable device, of the glazing type, having variable optical and/or energetic properties
US7248392B2 (en) Vision panel having a multi-layer primer
US5729379A (en) Electrochromic devices
US7791784B2 (en) Electrically-controllable device with variable optical and/or energy properties
JP2003163071A (en) Electric heating window glass
KR20130096276A (en) Transparent panel having a heatable coating
JP2004509374A (en) Condition monitoring of reversible electrochemical mirror (REM)
KR20110126125A (en) Electrically controllable device with uniform coloration/discoloration over the entire surface thereof
CN218547188U (en) Electrochromic rear-view mirror and vehicle
CN220040927U (en) Electrochromic device, electrochromic device and end product
RU2810917C1 (en) Electrochromic device
JPH0522919Y2 (en)

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
CC Certificate of correction
FPAY Fee payment

Year of fee payment: 4

REMI Maintenance fee reminder mailed
LAPS Lapse for failure to pay maintenance fees
STCH Information on status: patent discontinuation

Free format text: PATENT EXPIRED DUE TO NONPAYMENT OF MAINTENANCE FEES UNDER 37 CFR 1.362

FP Expired due to failure to pay maintenance fee

Effective date: 20100910